US20070225217A1 - Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of medical conditions - Google Patents

Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of medical conditions Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20070225217A1
US20070225217A1 US11/594,436 US59443606A US2007225217A1 US 20070225217 A1 US20070225217 A1 US 20070225217A1 US 59443606 A US59443606 A US 59443606A US 2007225217 A1 US2007225217 A1 US 2007225217A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
drug
patient
disease
disorder
administering
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US11/594,436
Inventor
Todd Chappell
Benjamin Auspitz
Edward Jost-Price
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
THERAOPTICS
Zalicus Inc
Original Assignee
CombinatoRx Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by CombinatoRx Inc filed Critical CombinatoRx Inc
Priority to US11/594,436 priority Critical patent/US20070225217A1/en
Publication of US20070225217A1 publication Critical patent/US20070225217A1/en
Assigned to ZALICUS INC. reassignment ZALICUS INC. ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: AUSPITZ, BENJAMIN A., MANIVASAKAM, PALANIYANDI, CHAPPELL, TODD W., SACHS, NOAH, JOST-PRICE, EDWARD ROYDON, GRAU, DANIEL S., SMITH, BRENDAN, NICHOLS, M. JAMES
Assigned to THERAOPTICS reassignment THERAOPTICS ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: ZALICUS INC.
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K38/00Medicinal preparations containing peptides
    • A61K38/04Peptides having up to 20 amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K38/12Cyclic peptides, e.g. bacitracins; Polymyxins; Gramicidins S, C; Tyrocidins A, B or C
    • A61K38/13Cyclosporins
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/21Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates
    • A61K31/215Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates of carboxylic acids
    • A61K31/22Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates of carboxylic acids of acyclic acids, e.g. pravastatin
    • A61K31/222Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates of carboxylic acids of acyclic acids, e.g. pravastatin with compounds having aromatic groups, e.g. dipivefrine, ibopamine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/40Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. sulpiride, succinimide, tolmetin, buflomedil
    • A61K31/4015Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. sulpiride, succinimide, tolmetin, buflomedil having oxo groups directly attached to the heterocyclic ring, e.g. piracetam, ethosuximide
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/44Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/445Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine
    • A61K31/451Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine having a carbocyclic group directly attached to the heterocyclic ring, e.g. glutethimide, meperidine, loperamide, phencyclidine, piminodine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/44Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/445Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine
    • A61K31/4523Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine containing further heterocyclic ring systems
    • A61K31/4545Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine containing further heterocyclic ring systems containing a six-membered ring with nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. pipamperone, anabasine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/47Quinolines; Isoquinolines
    • A61K31/4738Quinolines; Isoquinolines ortho- or peri-condensed with heterocyclic ring systems
    • A61K31/4745Quinolines; Isoquinolines ortho- or peri-condensed with heterocyclic ring systems condensed with ring systems having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. phenantrolines
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/505Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim
    • A61K31/519Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim ortho- or peri-condensed with heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/55Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having seven-membered rings, e.g. azelastine, pentylenetetrazole
    • A61K31/553Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having seven-membered rings, e.g. azelastine, pentylenetetrazole having at least one nitrogen and one oxygen as ring hetero atoms, e.g. loxapine, staurosporine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/557Eicosanoids, e.g. leukotrienes or prostaglandins
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/557Eicosanoids, e.g. leukotrienes or prostaglandins
    • A61K31/5575Eicosanoids, e.g. leukotrienes or prostaglandins having a cyclopentane, e.g. prostaglandin E2, prostaglandin F2-alpha
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/56Compounds containing cyclopenta[a]hydrophenanthrene ring systems; Derivatives thereof, e.g. steroids
    • A61K31/57Compounds containing cyclopenta[a]hydrophenanthrene ring systems; Derivatives thereof, e.g. steroids substituted in position 17 beta by a chain of two carbon atoms, e.g. pregnane or progesterone
    • A61K31/573Compounds containing cyclopenta[a]hydrophenanthrene ring systems; Derivatives thereof, e.g. steroids substituted in position 17 beta by a chain of two carbon atoms, e.g. pregnane or progesterone substituted in position 21, e.g. cortisone, dexamethasone, prednisone or aldosterone
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K45/00Medicinal preparations containing active ingredients not provided for in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • A61K45/06Mixtures of active ingredients without chemical characterisation, e.g. antiphlogistics and cardiaca
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/02Stomatological preparations, e.g. drugs for caries, aphtae, periodontitis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/04Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system for ulcers, gastritis or reflux esophagitis, e.g. antacids, inhibitors of acid secretion, mucosal protectants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/18Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system for pancreatic disorders, e.g. pancreatic enzymes
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/06Antiasthmatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • A61P17/02Drugs for dermatological disorders for treating wounds, ulcers, burns, scars, keloids, or the like
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • A61P17/06Antipsoriatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P19/00Drugs for skeletal disorders
    • A61P19/02Drugs for skeletal disorders for joint disorders, e.g. arthritis, arthrosis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P19/00Drugs for skeletal disorders
    • A61P19/04Drugs for skeletal disorders for non-specific disorders of the connective tissue
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P21/00Drugs for disorders of the muscular or neuromuscular system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P21/00Drugs for disorders of the muscular or neuromuscular system
    • A61P21/04Drugs for disorders of the muscular or neuromuscular system for myasthenia gravis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/04Centrally acting analgesics, e.g. opioids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P27/00Drugs for disorders of the senses
    • A61P27/02Ophthalmic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P27/00Drugs for disorders of the senses
    • A61P27/02Ophthalmic agents
    • A61P27/06Antiglaucoma agents or miotics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P27/00Drugs for disorders of the senses
    • A61P27/02Ophthalmic agents
    • A61P27/08Mydriatics or cycloplegics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P27/00Drugs for disorders of the senses
    • A61P27/02Ophthalmic agents
    • A61P27/12Ophthalmic agents for cataracts
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P27/00Drugs for disorders of the senses
    • A61P27/02Ophthalmic agents
    • A61P27/14Decongestants or antiallergics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • A61P35/02Antineoplastic agents specific for leukemia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • A61P37/06Immunosuppressants, e.g. drugs for graft rejection
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/08Antiallergic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P7/00Drugs for disorders of the blood or the extracellular fluid
    • A61P7/10Antioedematous agents; Diuretics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/10Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system for treating ischaemic or atherosclerotic diseases, e.g. antianginal drugs, coronary vasodilators, drugs for myocardial infarction, retinopathy, cerebrovascula insufficiency, renal arteriosclerosis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/12Antihypertensives
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/14Vasoprotectives; Antihaemorrhoidals; Drugs for varicose therapy; Capillary stabilisers
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K9/00Medicinal preparations characterised by special physical form
    • A61K9/0012Galenical forms characterised by the site of application
    • A61K9/0014Skin, i.e. galenical aspects of topical compositions
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K9/00Medicinal preparations characterised by special physical form
    • A61K9/0012Galenical forms characterised by the site of application
    • A61K9/0048Eye, e.g. artificial tears
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K9/00Medicinal preparations characterised by special physical form
    • A61K9/0012Galenical forms characterised by the site of application
    • A61K9/0048Eye, e.g. artificial tears
    • A61K9/0051Ocular inserts, ocular implants
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y02TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02ATECHNOLOGIES FOR ADAPTATION TO CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02A50/00TECHNOLOGIES FOR ADAPTATION TO CLIMATE CHANGE in human health protection, e.g. against extreme weather
    • Y02A50/30Against vector-borne diseases, e.g. mosquito-borne, fly-borne, tick-borne or waterborne diseases whose impact is exacerbated by climate change

Definitions

  • the invention relates to the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders and ophthalmic disorders.
  • Immunoinflammatory disorders are characterized by the inappropriate activation of the body's immune defenses. Rather than targeting infectious invaders, the immune response targets and damages the body's own tissues or transplanted tissues.
  • the tissue targeted by the immune system varies with the disorder. For example, in multiple sclerosis, the immune response is directed against the neuronal tissue, while in Crohn's disease the digestive tract is targeted.
  • Immunoinflammatory disorders affect millions of individuals and include conditions such as asthma, allergic intraocular inflammatory diseases, arthritis, atopic dermatitis, atopic eczema, diabetes, hemolytic anaemia, inflammatory dermatoses, inflammatory bowel or gastrointestinal disorders (e.g., Crohn's disease and ulcerative colitis), multiple sclerosis, myasthenia gravis, pruritis/inflammation, psoriasis, rheumatoid arthritis, cirrhosis, and systemic lupus erythematosus.
  • conditions such as asthma, allergic intraocular inflammatory diseases, arthritis, atopic dermatitis, atopic eczema, diabetes, hemolytic anaemia, inflammatory dermatoses, inflammatory bowel or gastrointestinal disorders (e.g., Crohn's disease and ulcerative colitis), multiple sclerosis, myasthenia gravis, pruritis/inflammation, psoriasis, rheuma
  • OA osteoarthritis
  • RA rheumatoid arthritis
  • gout gout
  • OA affects the hands, lower back, neck, and weight-bearing joints such as the knees, hips, and foot joints.
  • the yearly incidence of OA of the hand is about 50 new cases per 1,000 for persons under age 40, rising to 65 per 1,000 for ages 40-59 and 110 per 1000 for ages 60 and greater.
  • OA has been characterized as a slowly evolving degenerative disease with a multifactorial etiology that may differ depending on the joint site.
  • OA occurs when cartilage, the tissue that cushions the ends of the bones within the joints, begins to break down and wear away. In some cases, all of the cartilage may wear away, leaving bones that rub against each other.
  • CRP C-reactive protein
  • CRP is an acute phase response protein whose production is stimulated by cytokines, particularly interleukin-6 (IL-6). The relationship between inflammatory processes and elevation in plasma CRP and pro-inflammatory cytokines is well known.
  • CRP has also been related to the inflammatory activity of rheumatoid arthritis.
  • Symptoms of OA range from stiffness and intermittent mild pain to severe joint pain and impaired biomechanical function. Although there is no cure for most forms of OA, various therapies can help patients manage symptoms and improve their overall quality of life. Symptomatic treatment of OA traditionally involves administration of non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs (NSAIDs), local analgesic therapies, intra-articular corticosteroid injection, and surgery.
  • NSAIDs non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs
  • local analgesic therapies intra-articular corticosteroid injection, and surgery.
  • NSAIDs such as indomethacin, ketoprofen, ibuprofen, acetylsalicylic acid (ASA), and flurbiprofen
  • ASA acetylsalicylic acid
  • flurbiprofen can relieve pain by reducing local inflammation and attenuating levels of proinflammatory agents.
  • long-term NSAID use is compromised by significant gastrointestinal (GI) toxicity.
  • GI gastrointestinal
  • Steroids are known powerful anti-inflammatory agents that have been used in treating OA.
  • chronic administration of anti-inflammatory doses of steroids is also limited by well-known toxicities.
  • prolonged use of steroids has been associated with osteoporosis, high blood pressure, neurological complications, suboptimal immune response, and ocular disturbances, limiting their utility in therapeutic situations.
  • a therapeutic agent that, for example, retained the potent anti-inflammatory effects of steroids, or the therapeutic effects of another class of drugs, while limiting the associated toxicities, would be of great benefit to patients with OA or other musculoskeletal disorders.
  • Periodontal disease refers to diseases of tissues that surround and support teeth, including the gingiva, cementum, periodontal ligament, alveolar process bone, and dental supporting bone. The most common forms of periodontal disease are periodontitis and gingivitis.
  • Periodontal disease involves the inflammation, destruction and degeneration of periodontal tissues that surround and support mammalian teeth. These periodontal tissues include the crevicular epithelium, junctional epithelium, external marginal epithelium, gingiva, alveolar bone, periodontal ligament, and cementum. The loss of supporting bone in periodontitis is the latest stage of this progressive disorder and is the major cause of tooth loss in adults.
  • Periodontal disease is typically classified as gingivitis and periodontitis according to the progress of disease.
  • gingivitis refers to a condition in which inflammation is localized within the gingiva and no lesion occurs in the bone and periodontal ligament, and a pocket is relative pocket.
  • Periodontalis refers to a condition in which the inflammation of gingiva reaches the periodontal ligament and alveolar bone, the pocket becomes a periodontal pocket, and the attachment level (the position of attachment) is on the root apex side downward from the cementum-enamel junction. The inflammation prolongs and proceeds toward deep parts with a deepening periodontal pocket.
  • CRP plasma C-reactive protein
  • proinflammatory cytokines proinflammatory cytokines
  • atherosclerotic heart disease where elevated plasma CRP levels are a known risk factor, a correlation with the incidence of periodontitis has also been reported.
  • agents that can modify levels of inflammation in periodontitis would be expected to be active across such inflammatory diseases.
  • treatment of periodontitis with NSAIDs such as indomethacin, ketoprofen, ibuprofen, ASA and flurbiprofen, can reduce local inflammation and attenuate levels of pro-inflammatory agents.
  • the invention features compositions, methods, and kits for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders and ophthalmic disorders.
  • the invention features a composition that includes a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A and Table 3.
  • a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A and Table 3.
  • one or both drugs are present in amounts that together are sufficient to treat an immunoinflammatory disorder, ophthalmic disorder, or musculoskeletal disorder, or pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling associated therewith in a patient in need thereof.
  • Exemplary drug pairs are: antihistamine and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; antihistamine and SSRI; antihistamine and tricyclic compound; antinfective and anticoccidial compound; corticosteroid and antihistamine; corticosteroid and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; corticosteroid and prostaglandin; NsIDI and alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonist; NsIDI and antihistamine; NsIDI and NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic; NsIDI and prostaglandin; NsIDI and sympathomimetic; prostaglandin and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; prostaglandin and tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine; sympathomimetic and NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic; sympathomimetic and prostaglandin; sympathomimetic and tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine; sympathomimetic and NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic;
  • One or both drugs in said pair may be present in the composition in a low dosage or in a high dosage.
  • the composition is formulated for topical or systemic administration.
  • the composition is formulated for ophthalmic administration.
  • the invention features a method for treating a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder by administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3.
  • the first and second drug of said drug pair are administered simultaneously or within 14 days of each other and in amounts that together are sufficient to treat the patient.
  • the patient may also be administered one or more additional drugs (e.g., an NSAID, corticosteroid, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor agonist, bronchodilator, NsIDI, vitamin D analog, psoralen, retinoid, or 5-amino salicylic acid).
  • additional drugs e.g., an NSAID, corticosteroid, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor agonist, bronchodilator, NsIDI, vitamin D analog, psoralen, reti
  • the invention features a method of modulating an immune response (e.g., by decreasing proinflammatory cytokine secretion or production, or by modulating adhesion, gene expression, chemokine secretion, presentation of MHC complex, presentation of costimulation signals, or cell surface expression of other mediators) in a patient by administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A simultaneously or within 14 days of each other in amounts sufficient to modulate the immune response in the patient.
  • an immune response e.g., by decreasing proinflammatory cytokine secretion or production, or by modulating adhesion, gene expression, chemokine secretion, presentation of MHC complex, presentation of costimulation signals, or cell surface expression of other mediators
  • the invention features a method for treating a patient diagnosed with an ophthalmic disorder by administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3.
  • the first and second drug of said drug pair are administered simultaneously or within 14 days of each other in amounts that together are sufficient to treat the patient.
  • the patient may also be administered one or more additional drugs (e.g., an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, or antimycotic agent) or receive photodynamic therapy.
  • additional drugs e.g., an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, or antimycotic agent
  • one or both drugs in said pair are administered in a low dosage or in a high dosage.
  • the drugs may be administered within 10 days of each other, within five days of each other, within twenty-four hours of each other, or simultaneously.
  • the invention features a method for treating an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level in a patient in need thereof by concomitantly administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A in amounts that together are more effective in treating the immunoinflammatory disorder than the administration of either drug alone.
  • the invention features a method for treating an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level in a patient in need thereof by administering a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A to the patient; wherein: (i) the two drugs are concomitantly administered and (ii) the respective amounts of the two drugs administered to the patient are more effective in treating the immunoinflammatory disorder compared to the administration of the either drug alone.
  • the invention features a composition that includes (i) drug listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) a second compound selected from the group consisting of an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, antimycotic agent, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor agonist, bronchodilator, NsIDI, vitamin D analog, psoralen, retinoid, or 5-amino salicylic acid.
  • a second compound selected from the group consisting of an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, antimycotic agent, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor
  • the invention features a kit having (i) a composition that includes a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) instructions for administering the composition to a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
  • the invention features a kit having (i) a first drug from a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3; (ii) a second drug from the same drug pair; and (iii) instructions for administering said the two drugs to a patient diagnosed an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
  • the invention features a kit having (i) a first drug from a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) instructions for administering this drug and a second drug from the same drug pair to a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
  • the invention features a kit having (i) a first drug listed on Table 1A or Table 3; (ii) a second drug selected from an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, antimycotic agent, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor agonist, bronchodilator, NsIDI, vitamin D analog, psoralen, retinoid, or 5-amino salicylic acid; and (iii) instructions for administering said first drug and said second drug to a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
  • a second drug selected from an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic
  • the invention features a kit having (i) a first drug listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) instructions for administering this first drug and a second drug selected from an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, antimycotic agent, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor agonist, bronchodilator, NsIDI, vitamin D analog, psoralen, retinoid, or 5-amino salicylic acid to a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder or an ophthalmic disorder.
  • a second drug selected from an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, antimycotic agent, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immuno
  • the invention also features methods, compositions, and kits for treating a musculoskeletal disorder, or pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling associated with a musculoskeletal disorder, in a patient by administering to the patient in need thereof a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A, optionally in combination with any of a number of companion compounds, including a corticosteroid, a non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drug (NSAID) (e.g., naproxen sodium, diclofenac sodium, diclofenac potassium, aspirin, sulindac, diflunisal, piroxicam, indomethacin, ibuprofen, nabumetone, choline magnesium trisalicylate, sodium salicylate, salicylsalicylic acid, fenoprofen, flurbiprofen, ketoprofen, meclofenamate sodium, meloxicam, oxaprozin, sulindac, or tol
  • the invention features, in one instance, a method for treating pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling associated with a musculoskeletal disorder, e.g., osteoarthritis, by administering to a patient diagnosed with or at risk of developing such pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A, such that the two drugs are administered simultaneously or within fourteen days, ten days, five days, or even 24 hours of each other in amounts sufficient to treat the patient.
  • the patient experiences a reduction in pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling subsequent to treatment, e.g., within fifty days of treatment.
  • the reduction in pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling can be measured using any method known in the art, e.g., a 10 cm visual analog scale, a Likert scale, the Lequesne index, or the WOMAC index.
  • a 10 cm visual analog scale e.g., a 10 cm visual analog scale, a Likert scale, the Lequesne index, or the WOMAC index.
  • an AUSCAN index that utilizes a 10 cm visual analog scale may be used.
  • the invention also features a method for treating a musculoskeletal disorder, e.g., osteoarthritis, by administering to a patient diagnosed with or at risk of developing such a disorder a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A, such that the two drugs are administered simultaneously or within fourteen days, ten days, five days, or even 24 hours of each other in amounts sufficient to treat the patient.
  • a musculoskeletal disorder e.g., osteoarthritis
  • the two drugs may be administered in the same or different pharmaceutical formulations.
  • Compounds used in the methods of the invention may be formulated for, e.g., topical or systemic administration, and may be formulated in high, moderate, or low dosages.
  • a third drug e.g., a corticosteroid, an NSAID, a COX-2 inhibitor, a biologic, a small molecule immunomodulator, a DMARD, a xanthine, an NsIDI, a vitamin D analog, a psoralen, a retinoid, 5-amino salicylic acid, hydroxychloroquine sulfate, or penicillamine may be administered to the patient such that the first drug, the second drug, and the third drug are administered simultaneously or within fourteen days, ten days, five days, or even 24 hours of each other in amounts sufficient to treat the patient.
  • a third drug e.g., a corticosteroid, an NSAID, a COX-2 inhibitor, a biologic, a small molecule immunomodulator, a DMARD, a xanthine, an NsIDI, a vitamin D analog, a psoralen, a retinoid, 5-amino salicylic
  • the drugs of the drug combination of Table 1A or Table 3 are the only two active ingredients (although excipients will generally also be present).
  • the invention features a method of treating an ophthalmic disorder in a patient by administering to the patient a corticosteroid and a non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant (NsIDI).
  • the corticosteroid and/or the NsIDI can be administered at a low concentration.
  • the concentration of the NsIDI does not cause eye irritation, such as burning, and the compositions of the invention are administered in an amount sufficient to alleviate the symptoms of the ophthalmic disorder.
  • the concentration of the corticosteroid does not cause steroid toxicity.
  • the invention features a method of treating an ophthalmic disorder in a patient by administering to the patient a substance selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents in combination with a corticosteroid and/or an NsIDI.
  • a substance selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents in combination with a corticosteroid and/or an NsIDI.
  • the corticosteroid and/or the NsIDI can be administered at a low concentration.
  • the invention features a composition (e.g., a solution, gel, ointment, suspension, emulsion, or solid insert) including a corticosteroid and a NsIDI.
  • a composition e.g., a solution, gel, ointment, suspension, emulsion, or solid insert
  • the corticosteroid and/or the NsIDI can be administered at a low concentration.
  • the invention features a composition (e.g., a solution, gel, ointment, suspension, emulsion, or solid insert) including a substance selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents in combination with a corticosteroid and/or an NsIDI.
  • the corticosteroid and/or the NsIDI can be administered at a low concentration.
  • the invention also features a kit that includes (i) a corticosteroid; and (ii) instructions for administering a corticosteroid and an NsIDI to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • the invention also features a kit that includes (i) an NsIDI; and (ii) instructions for administering a corticosteroid and an NsIDI to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • the invention also features a kit that includes (i) a composition containing a corticosteroid and an NsIDI; and (ii) instructions for administering the composition to a patient having or at risk of having a metabolic disorder.
  • the invention also features a kit that includes (i) a corticosteroid; (ii) an NsIDI; and (iii) instructions for administering a corticosteroid and an NsIDI to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • kits can also include instructions for administering a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents.
  • a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents.
  • kits can also include a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents.
  • the NsIDI and/or corticosteroid can optionally be formulated in a single composition with a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents.
  • the invention also features a kit that includes (i) a corticosteroid; and (ii) instructions for administering a corticosteroid and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents, to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • a corticosteroid and instructions for administering a corticosteroid and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents, to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • the invention also features a kit that includes (i) an NsIDI; and (ii) instructions for administering an NsIDI and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents, to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • the invention also features a kit that includes (i) a composition containing a corticosteroid and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents; and (ii) instructions for administering the composition to a patient having or at risk of having a metabolic disorder.
  • a composition containing a corticosteroid and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents and instructions for administering the composition to a patient having or at risk of having a metabolic disorder.
  • the invention also features a kit that includes (i) a composition containing an NsIDI and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents; and (ii) instructions for administering the composition to a patient having or at risk of having a metabolic disorder.
  • a composition containing an NsIDI and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents and instructions for administering the composition to a patient having or at risk of having a metabolic disorder.
  • the invention also features a kit that includes (i) a corticosteroid; (ii) a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents (iii) instructions for administering a corticosteroid and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents, to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • a corticosteroid includes (i) a corticosteroid; (ii) a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, gla
  • the invention also features a kit that includes (i) a NsIDI; (ii) a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents (iii) instructions for administering a NsIDI and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents, to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • a NsIDI a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents,
  • the corticosteroid can be selected from SEGRAs (selective glucocorticosteroid receptor agonists), fluocinolone acetonide, fluorometholone, dexamethasone, hydrocortisone, loteprednol, medrysone, methylprednisolone, prednisolone, rimexolone, or triamcinolone.
  • SEGRAs selective glucocorticosteroid receptor agonists
  • fluocinolone acetonide fluorometholone
  • dexamethasone hydrocortisone
  • loteprednol medrysone
  • medrysone methylprednisolone
  • prednisolone prednisolone
  • rimexolone or triamcinolone.
  • the NsIDI can be selected from cyclosporine A, ABT-281, ISAtx247, tacrolimus, ascomycin, pimecrolimus, rapamycin, or everolimus.
  • the concentration of the corticosteroid can be equivalent to a concentration of prednisolone of between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, or 0.01%) and the concentration of the non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant can be equivalent to a concentration of cyclosporine A between 0.001% and 0.049% (e.g., 0.04%, 0.03%, 0.02%, 0.01%, 0.009%, 0.008%, 0.007%, 0.006%, 0.005%, or 0.001%).
  • the corticosteroid is prednisolone and the concentration of prednisolone is between 0.01% and 0.12% (e.g., 0.12%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • the corticosteroid is clocortolone pivalate and the concentration of clocortolone pivalate is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • the corticosteroid is hydrocortisone and the concentration of hydrocortisone is between 0.01% and 1.0% (e.g., 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • the corticosteroid is dexamethasone and the concentration of dexamethasone is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • the corticosteroid is fluorometholone and the concentration of fluorometholone is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • the corticosteroid is loteprednol etabonate and the concentration of loteprednol etabonate is between 0.01% and 0.2% (e.g., 0.2%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • the corticosteroid is medrysone and the concentration of medrysone is between 0.01% and 1.0% (e.g., 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • the corticosteroid is rimexolone and the concentration of rimexolone is between 0.01% and 1.0% (e.g., 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • the NsIDI can be cyclosporine A and the concentration of cyclosporine A is between 0.001% and 0.049% (e.g., 0.04%, 0.03%, 0.02%, 0.01%, 0.009%, 0.008%, 0.007%, 0.006%, 0.005%, and 0.001%).
  • compositions, kits, and methods of the invention the only pharmacologically active agents in the composition or kit, or used in the method, are those recited.
  • pharmacologically inactive excipients may also be present in the composition or kit, or used in the practice of the method.
  • the invention features the treatment of an ophthalmic disorder, for example age related macular degeneration, alkaline erosive keratoconjunctivitis, allergic conjunctivitis, allergic keratitis, anterior uveitis, Behcet's disease, blepharitis, blood-aqueous barrier disruption, chorioiditis, chronic uveitis, conjunctivitis, contact lens-induced keratoconjunctivitis, corneal abrasion, corneal trauma, corneal ulcer, crystalline retinopathy, cystoid macular edema, dacryocystitis, diabetic keratophathy, diabetic macular edema, diabetic retinopathy, dry eye disease, dry age-related macular degeneration, eosinophilic granuloma, episcleritis, exudative macular edema, Fuchs' Dystrophy, giant cell arteritis, giant papillary
  • Compounds useful in the invention include those described herein in any of their pharmaceutically acceptable forms, including isomers such as diastereomers and enantiomers, salts, esters, solvates, and polymorphs thereof, as well as racemic mixtures and pure isomers of the compounds described herein.
  • corticosteroid any naturally occurring or synthetic compound characterized by a hydrogenated cyclopentanoperhydro-phenanthrene ring system and having immunosuppressive and/or anti-inflammatory activity.
  • Naturally occurring corticosteroids are generally produced by the adrenal cortex.
  • Synthetic corticosteroids may be halogenated. Examples corticosteroids are provided herein.
  • non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant or “NsIDI” is meant any non-steroidal agent that decreases proinflammatory cytokine production or secretion, binds an immunophilin, or causes a down regulation of the proinflammatory reaction.
  • NsIDIs include calcineurin inhibitors, such as cyclosporine A, ABT-281, ISAtx247, tacrolimus, ascomycin, pimecrolimus, as well as other agents (peptides, peptide fragments, chemically modified peptides, or peptide mimetics) that inhibit the phosphatase activity of calcineurin.
  • NsIDIs also include rapamycin (sirolimus) and everolimus, which bind to an FK506-binding protein, FKBP-12, and block antigen-induced proliferation of white blood cells and cytokine secretion.
  • small molecule immunomodulator is meant a non-steroidal, non-NsIDI compound that decreases proinflammatory cytokine production or secretion, causes a down regulation of the proinflammatory reaction, or otherwise modulates the immune system in an immunophilin-independent manner.
  • Exemplary small molecule immunomodulators are p38 MAP kinase inhibitors such as VX 702 (Vertex Pharmaceuticals), SCIO 469 (Scios), doramapimod (Boehringer Ingelheim), RO 30201195 (Roche), and SCIO 323 (Scios), TACE inhibitors such as DPC 333 (Bristol Myers Squibb), ICE inhibitors such as pranalcasan (Vertex Pharmaceuticals), and IMPDH inhibitors such as mycophenolate (Roche) and merimepodib (Vertex Pharmaceuticals).
  • tricyclic compound is meant a compound having one the formulas (I), (II), (III), (IV), or (V): wherein each X is, independently, H, Cl, F, Br, I, CH 3 , CF 3 , OH, OCH 3 , CH 2 CH 3 , or OCH 2 CH 3 ; Y is CH 2 , O, NH, S(O) 0-2 , (CH 2 ) 2 , (CH) 2 , CH 2 O, CH 2 NH, CHN, or CH 2 S; Z is C or S; A is a branched or unbranched, saturated or monounsaturated hydrocarbon chain having between 3 and 6 carbons, inclusive; each B is, independently, H, Cl, F, Br, I, CX 3 , CH 2 CH 3 , OCX 3 , or OCX 2 CX 3 ; and D is CH 2 , O, NH, or S(O) 0-2 .
  • Other tricyclic compounds are described below.
  • Tricyclic compounds include tricyclic antidepressants such as amoxapine, 8-hydroxyamoxapine, 7-hydroxyamoxapine, loxapine (e.g., loxapine succinate, loxapine hydrochloride), 8-hydroxyloxapine, amitriptyline, clomipramine, doxepin, imipramine, trimipramine, desipramine, nortriptyline, and protriptyline, although compounds need not have antidepressant activities to be considered tricyclic compounds of the invention.
  • tricyclic antidepressants such as amoxapine, 8-hydroxyamoxapine, 7-hydroxyamoxapine, loxapine (e.g., loxapine succinate, loxapine hydrochloride), 8-hydroxyloxapine, amitriptyline, clomipramine, doxepin, imipramine, trimipramine, desipramine, nortript
  • tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine is meant a compound having the formula (V): wherein each Z and each Z′ is, independently, N, O, C,
  • each R 1 is, independently, X, OH, N-alkyl (wherein the alkyl group has 1 to 20, more preferably 1-5, carbon atoms); a branched or unbranched alkyl group having 1 to 20, more preferably 1-5, carbon atoms; or a heterocycle, preferably as defined in formula (V).
  • two R 1 groups from a common Z or Z′ atom, in combination with each other may represent —(CY 2 ) k — in which k is an integer between 4 and 6, inclusive.
  • Each Y is, independently, H, F, Cl, Br, or I.
  • each Z is the same moiety, each Z′ is the same moiety, and Z and Z′ are different moieties.
  • prostaglandin is meant a member of the lipid class of biochemicals that belongs to a subclass of lipids known as the eicosanoids, because of their structural similarities to the C-20 polyunsaturated fatty acids, the eicosaenoic acids.
  • Prostaglandins include alprostidil, dinoprostone, limaprost, misoprostil, prostaglandin E2, prostaglandin A1, prostaglandin A2, prostaglandin B1, prostaglandin B2, prostaglandin D2, prostaglandin F1 ⁇ , prostaglandin F2 ⁇ , prostaglandin 11, prostaglandin-ici 74205, prostaglandin F2 ⁇ , 6-keto-prostaglandin F1 ⁇ , prostaglandin E1 ethyl ester, prostaglandin E1 methyl ester, prostaglandin F2 methyl ester, arbaprostil, ornoprostil, 13,14-dihydroprostaglandin F2 ⁇ , and prostaglandin J.
  • bufexamac is meant a compound having the structure: or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug thereof.
  • bufexamac analog is meant a compound having the formula (VI): or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug thereof, wherein R 1 is wherein R 1A is and R 1B is H, halo, CF 3 , optionally substituted C 1-6 alkyl, optionally substituted C 2-6 alkenyl, optionally substituted C 2-6 alkynyl, optionally substituted C 3-8 cycloalkyl, optionally substituted C 1-6 alkoxy, or optionally substituted C 1-6 thioalkoxy; each of R 2 and R 3 is, independently, H, C 1-4 alkyl, or CF 3 ; and R 4 is optionally substituted C 1-6 alkyl or optionally substituted C 3-8 cycloalkyl.
  • a “low dosage” or “low concentration” is meant at least 5% less (e.g., at least 10%, 20%, 50%, 80%, 90%, or even 95%) than the lowest standard recommended dosage or lowest standard recommended concentration of a particular compound formulated for a given route of administration for treatment of any human disease or condition.
  • a low dosage of corticosteroid formulated for administration by inhalation will differ from a low dosage of corticosteroid formulated for oral administration.
  • a “high dosage” is meant at least 5% (e.g., at least 10%, 20%, 50%, 100%, 200%, or even 300%) more than the highest standard recommended dosage of a particular compound for treatment of any human disease or condition.
  • a “moderate dosage” is meant the dosage between the low dosage and the high dosage.
  • a “dosage equivalent to a prednisolone dosage” is meant a dosage of a corticosteroid that, in combination with a given dosage of a second drug produces the same anti-inflammatory effect in a patient as a dosage of prednisolone in combination with that dosage.
  • SSRI selective serotonin reuptake inhibitor
  • SSRI any member of the class of compounds that (i) inhibit the uptake of serotonin by neurons of the central nervous system, (ii) have an inhibition constant (Ki) of 10 nM or less, and (iii) a selectivity for serotonin over norepinephrine (i.e., the ratio of Ki(norepinephrine) over Ki(serotonin)) of greater than 100.
  • Ki inhibition constant
  • Ki the ratio of Ki(norepinephrine
  • Ki(serotonin) the ratio of Ki(serotonin)
  • SSRIs are administered in dosages of greater than 10 mg per day when used as antidepressants.
  • Exemplary SSRIs for use in the invention are fluoxetine, fluvoxamine, paroxetine, sertraline, citalopram, and venlafaxine.
  • treating is meant administering or prescribing a pharmaceutical composition for the treatment or prevention of an immunoinflammatory disease.
  • patient any animal (e.g., a human).
  • Other animals that can be treated using the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include horses, dogs, cats, pigs, goats, rabbits, hamsters, monkeys, guinea pigs, rats, mice, lizards, snakes, sheep, cattle, fish, and birds.
  • steroid toxicity is meant a substantial detrimental increase in intraocular pressure resulting from steroid administration.
  • an amount sufficient is meant the amount of a compound, in a combination of the invention, required to treat or prevent an immunoinflammatory disease in a clinically relevant manner.
  • a sufficient amount of an active compound used to practice the present invention for therapeutic treatment of conditions caused by or contributing to an immunoinflammatory disease varies depending upon the manner of administration, the age, body weight, and general health of the patient. Ultimately, the prescribers will decide the appropriate amount and dosage regimen.
  • Efficacy may be measured by a skilled practitioner using any standard method that is appropriate for a given indication.
  • immunoinflammatory disorder encompasses a variety of conditions, including autoimmune diseases, proliferative skin diseases, and inflammatory dermatoses. Immunoinflammatory disorders result in the destruction of healthy tissue by an inflammatory process, dysregulation of the immune system, and unwanted proliferation of cells.
  • immunoinflammatory disorders are acne vulgaris; acute respiratory distress syndrome; Addison's disease; adrenocortical insufficiency; adrenogenital ayndrome; allergic conjunctivitis; allergic rhinitis; allergic intraocular inflammatory diseases, ANCA-associated small-vessel vasculitis; angioedema; ankylosing spondylitis; aphthous stomatitis; arthritis, asthma; atherosclerosis; atopic dermatitis; autoimmune disease; autoimmune hemolytic anemia; autoimmune hepatitis; Behcet's disease; Bell's palsy; berylliosis; bronchial asthma; bullous herpetiformis dermatitis; bullous pemphigoid; carditis; celiac disease; cerebral ischaemia; chronic obstructive pulmonary disease; cirrhosis; Cogan's syndrome; contact dermatitis; COPD; Crohn's disease; Cushing's
  • Non-dermal inflammatory disorders include rheumatoid arthritis, inflammatory bowel disease, asthma, and chronic obstructive pulmonary disease.
  • dermal inflammatory disorders or “inflammatory dermatoses” is meant an inflammatory disorder selected from psoriasis, guttate psoriasis, inverse psoriasis, pustular psoriasis, erythrodermic psoriasis, acute febrile neutrophilic dermatosis, eczema, histotic eczema, dyshidrotic eczema, vesicular palmoplantar eczema, acne vulgaris, atopic dermatitis, contact dermatitis, allergic contact dermatitis, dermatomyositis, exfoliative dermatitis, hand eczema, pompholyx, rosacea, rosacea caused by sarcoidosis, rosacea caused by scleroderma, rosacea caused by Sweet's syndrome, rosacea caused by systemic lupus erythematosus, rosacea caused by inflammatory
  • proliferative skin disease is meant a benign or malignant disease that is characterized by accelerated cell division in the epidermis or dermis.
  • proliferative skin diseases are psoriasis, atopic dermatitis, non-specific dermatitis, primary irritant contact dermatitis, allergic contact dermatitis, actinic keratosis, basal and squamous cell carcinomas of the skin, lamellar ichthyosis, epidermolytic hyperkeratosis, premalignant keratosis, acne, and seborrheic dermatitis.
  • musculoskeletal disorder is meant an immune system-related disorder of the muscles, ligaments, bones, joints, cartilage, or other connective tissue.
  • musculoskeletal disorders are various forms of arthritis, e.g., osteoarthritis, rheumatoid arthritis, juvenile rheumatoid arthritis, and gout.
  • musculoskeletal disorders include acquired hyperostosis syndrome, acromegaly, ankylosing spondylitis, Behcet's disease, bone diseases, bursitis, cartilage diseases, chronic fatigue syndrome, compartment syndromes, congenital hypothyroidism, congenital myopathies, dentigerous cyst, dermatomyositis, diffuse idiopathic skeletal hyperostosis, Dupuytren's contracture, eosinophilia-myalgia syndrome, fasciitis, Felty's syndrome, fibromyalgia, hallux valgus, infectious arthritis, joint diseases, Kabuki make-up syndrome, Legg-Perthes disease, lupus, Lyme disease, Melas syndrome, metabolic bone diseases, mitochondrial myopathies, mixed connective tissue disease, muscular diseases, muscular dystrophies, musculoskeletal abnormalities, musculoskeletal diseases, myositis, myositis ossificans, necrotizing fasciit
  • Optamic disorder refers to physiologic abnormalities of the eye. They may involve the retina, the vitreous humor, lens, cornea, sclera or other portions of the eye, or physiologic abnormalities which adversely affect the eye, such as inadequate tear production.
  • Ophthalmic disorders that can be treated using the compositions, methods, and kits of the invention include age related macular degeneration, alkaline erosive keratoconjunctivitis, allergic conjunctivitis, allergic keratitis, anterior uveitis, Behcet's disease, blepharitis, blood-aqueous barrier disruption, chorioiditis, chronic uveitis, conjunctivitis, contact lens-induced keratoconjunctivitis, corneal abrasion, corneal trauma, corneal ulcer, crystalline retinopathy, cystoid macular edema, dacryocystitis, diabetic keratophathy, diabetic macular edema, diabetic retinopathy, dry eye disease, dry age-related macular degeneration, eosinophilic granuloma, episcleritis, exudative macular edema, Fuchs' Dystrophy, giant cell arteriti
  • a particular disease, disorder, or condition may be characterized as being both a proliferative skin disease and an inflammatory dermatosis.
  • An example of such a disease is psoriasis.
  • a particular disease may be both an immunoinflammatory disorder and an ophthalmic disorder.
  • One such example is Behcet's disease.
  • gingivitis encompasses a variety of conditions, including gingivitis and periodontitis, as well as diseases of tissues that surround and support teeth, including the gingiva, cementum, periodontal ligament, alveolar process bone, and dental supporting bone.
  • a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level is meant any disease or disorder in which the level of serum CRP may be elevated compared to normal controls. Typically a serum CRP level of >3 mg/L is considered elevated.
  • diseases and conditions associated with an increased serum CRP level include cardiovascular disease (e.g., coronary artery disease, peripheral artery disease); hypertension; colon cancer; lymphoma; sarcoma; and pancreatitis.
  • sustained release or “controlled release” is meant that the therapeutically active component is released from the formulation at a controlled rate such that therapeutically beneficial blood levels (but below toxic levels) of the component are maintained over an extended period of time ranging from e.g., about 12 to about 24 hours, thus, providing, for example, a 12 hour or a 24 hour dosage form.
  • the number of atoms of a particular type in a substituent group is generally given as a range, e.g., an alkyl group containing from 1 to 4 carbon atoms or C 1-4 alkyl. Reference to such a range is intended to include specific references to groups having each of the integer number of atoms within the specified range.
  • an alkyl group from 1 to 4 carbon atoms includes each of C 1 , C 2 , C 3 , and C 4 .
  • a C 1-12 heteroalkyl for example, includes from 1 to 12 carbon atoms in addition to one or more heteroatoms.
  • Other numbers of atoms and other types of atoms may be indicated in a similar manner.
  • alkyl and the prefix “alk-” are inclusive of both straight chain and branched chain groups and of cyclic groups, i.e., cycloalkyl.
  • Cyclic groups can be monocyclic or polycyclic and preferably have from 3 to 6 ring carbon atoms, inclusive.
  • Exemplary cyclic groups include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, and cyclohexyl groups.
  • C 1-4 alkyl is meant a branched or unbranched hydrocarbon group having from 1 to 4 carbon atoms.
  • a C 1-4 alkyl group may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • substituents include alkoxy, aryloxy, sulfhydryl, alkylthio, arylthio, halide, hydroxyl, fluoroalkyl, perfluoralkyl, amino, aminoalkyl, disubstituted amino, quaternary amino, hydroxyalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and carboxyl groups.
  • C 1-4 alkyls include, without limitation, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclopropylmethyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, sec-butyl, tert-butyl, and cyclobutyl.
  • halogen is meant bromine, chlorine, iodine, or fluorine.
  • alkoxy is meant a chemical substituent of the formula —OR, wherein R is selected from C 1-7 alkyl, C 2-7 alkenyl, C 2-7 alkynyl, C 2-6 heterocyclyl, C 6-12 aryl, C 7-14 alkaryl, C 3-10 alkheterocyclyl, or C 1-7 heteroalkyl.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable salt represents those salts which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response and the like, and are commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are well known in the art.
  • the salts can be prepared in situ during the final isolation and purification of the compounds of the invention, or separately by reacting the free base function with a suitable organic acid.
  • Representative acid addition salts include acetate, adipate, alginate, ascorbate, aspartate, benzenesulfonate, benzoate, bisulfate, borate, butyrate, camphorate, camphersulfonate, citrate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dodecylsulfate, ethanesulfonate, fumarate, glucoheptonate, glycerophosphate, hemisulfate, heptonate, hexanoate, hydrobromide, hydrochloride, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxy-ethanesulfonate, isethionate, lactobionate, lactate, laurate, lauryl sulfate, malate, maleate, malonate, mesylate, methanesulfonate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, nicotinate, nitrate, oleate, oxa
  • alkali or alkaline earth metal salts include sodium, lithium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and the like, as well as nontoxic ammonium, quaternary ammonium, and amine cations, including, but not limited to ammonium, tetramethylammonium, tetraethylammonium, methylamine, dimethylamine, trimethylamine, triethylamine, ethylamine, and the like.
  • Compounds useful in the invention include those described herein in any of their pharmaceutically acceptable forms, including isomers such as diastereomers and enantiomers, salts, esters, amides, thioesters, solvates, and polymorphs thereof, as well as racemic mixtures and pure isomers of the compounds described herein.
  • FIGS. 1 A- 1 MM are graphs showing suppression of PMA/ionomycin-induced TNF ⁇ secretion in cells treated with a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3.
  • FIGS. 2 A- 2 LL are graphs showing suppression of IFN ⁇ , IL-2, and TNF ⁇ in cells treated with combinations of an NsIDI and a corticosteroid.
  • the invention features methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders.
  • treatment of an immunoinflammatory disorder is performed by administering two drugs simultaneously or within 14 days of each other to a patient in need of such treatment.
  • the invention also features methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders.
  • a patient with an ophthalmic disorder is treated by administering two drugs simultaneously.
  • Cyclosporine A a non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant (NsIDI), is approved for treating several ophthalmic conditions. Cyclosporine A causes eye irritation and other undesired side effects when administered to patients at the lowest approved concentration. Lower concentrations of cyclosporine A do not cause these undesired side effects but are not sufficient to alleviate the symptoms of the ophthalmic disorders.
  • NsIDI non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant
  • the invention is based on our discovery that certain combinations of drugs inhibit cytokine production and/or secretion in vitro.
  • the combinations are listed on Table 1A and Table 1B.
  • TABLE 1A Drug 1 Drug 2 Prednisolone Ibudilast Prednisolone RO-20-1724 Prednisolone Epinastine Prednisolone Prostaglandin Prednisolone Bufexamac Cyclosporine A Brimonidine Cyclosporine A Epinastine Cyclosporine A Dipivefrin Cyclosporine A Prostaglandin E Cyclosporine A Amantadine Cyclosporine A Apraclonidine Cyclosporine A Loratadine Tacrolimus Amantadine Dipyridamole Amoxapine Dipyridamole Sertraline Loratadine Nortriptyline Loratadine Paroxetine Amoxapine Bufexamac Amoxapine Loratadine Amoxapine Nitrendipine
  • Drug 1 Drug 2 Dexamethasone Cyclosporine A Fluorometholone Cyclosporine A Hydrocortisone Cyclosporine A Loteprednol Etabonate Cyclosporine A Medrysone Cyclosporine A Methylprednisolone Cyclosporine A Prednisolone Cyclosporine A Prednisolone Acetate Cyclosporine A Rimexolone Cyclosporine A Triamcinolone Cyclosporine A Dexamethasone Tacrolimus Fluorometholone Tacrolimus Hydrocortisone Tacrolimus Medrysone Tacrolimus Methylprednisolone Tacrolimus Prednisolone Tacrolimus Prednisolone Acetate Tacrolimus Triamcinolone Tacrolimus
  • drugs that are the same mechanistic, structural, or therapeutic class may be used in lieu of one or more of the drugs listed on Table 1A or Table 1B.
  • Exemplary classes are provided on Table 2.
  • TABLE 2 Class Drug Alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonist Brimonidine Apraclonidine Anticoccidial compound Nicocicazin Antihistamine Loratadine Epinastine Antiinfective Bithionol Antiinflammatory Bufexamac Calcium channel blocker Nitrendipine Corticosteroid Prednisolone Dexamethasone Fluorometholone Hydrocortisone Loteprednol Etabonate Medrysone Methylprednisolone Prednisolone Acetate Rimexolone Triamcinolone Electron donor-acceptor molecular complex Nicarbazin NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic Amantadine NsIDI Cyclosporine A Tacrolimus Phosphodiesterase inhibitor Dipyridamole Ibud
  • the drug pairs of Table 3 may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • TABLE 3 Drug 1 Drug 2 Antihistamine Phosphodiesterase inhibitor Antihistamine SSRI Antihistamine Tricyclic compound Antiinfective Anticoccidial compound Corticosteroid Antihistamine Corticosteroid Phosphodiesterase inhibitor Corticosteroid Prostaglandin NsIDI Alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonist NsIDI Antihistamine NsIDI NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic NsIDI Prostaglandin NsIDI Sympathomimetic Prostaglandin Phosphodiesterase inhibitor Prostaglandin Tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine Sympathomimetic NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic Sympathomimetic Prostaglandin Sympathomimetic Tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine Sympathomimetic NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic Sympat
  • a corticosteroid may be employed in a method, composition, or kit of the invention.
  • Suitable corticosteroids include those from the class of selective glucocorticosteroid receptor agonists (SEGRAs), 11-alpha, 17-alpha,21-trihydroxypregn-4-ene-3,20-dione; 11-beta, 16-alpha, 17,21-tetrahydroxypregn-4-ene-3,20-dione; 11-beta, 16-alpha, 17,21-tetrahydroxypregn-1,4-diene-3,20-dione; 11-beta, 17-alpha,21-trihydroxy-6-alpha-methylpregn-4-ene-3,20-dione; 11-dehydrocorticosterone; 11-deoxycortisol; 11-hydroxy-1,4-androstadiene-3,17-dione; 11-ketotestosterone; 14-hydroxyandrost-4-ene-3,6,
  • Standard recommended dosages for various steroid/disease combinations are provided in Table 4A and Table 4B, below.
  • the dosage of corticosteroid administered is a dosage equivalent to a prednisolone dosage, as defined herein.
  • a low dosage of a corticosteroid may be considered as the dosage equivalent to a low dosage of prednisolone.
  • a corticosteroid can be administered at a concentration between 0.01% and 5% (e.g., 5.0%, 4.0%, 3.0%, 2.0%, 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • Low concentrations of corticosteroids of the invention are 95% or less of the lowest approved concentration.
  • low concentration of corticosteroids of the invention can be 90%, 85%, 80%, 70%, 60%, 50%, 25%, 10%, 5%, 2%, 1%, 0.5% or 0.1% of the lowest approved concentration.
  • a low concentration of clocortolone pivalate is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%)
  • a low concentration of hydrocortisone is between 0.01% and 1.0% (e.g., 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%)
  • a low concentration of dexamethasone is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%)
  • a low concentration of fluorometholone is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%)
  • Steroid receptor modulators may be used as a substitute for or in addition to a corticosteroid in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Glucocorticoid receptor modulators that may used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include compounds described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,380,207, 6,380,223, 6,448,405, 6,506,766, and 6,570,020, U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2003/0176478, 2003/0171585, 2003/0120081, 2003/0073703, 2002/015631, 2002/0147336, 2002/0107235, 2002/0103217, and 2001/0041802, and PCT Publication No.
  • WO00/66522 each of which is hereby incorporated by reference.
  • Other steroid receptor modulators may also be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,093,821, 6,121,450, 5,994,544, 5,696,133, 5,696,127, 5,693,647, 5,693,646, 5,688,810, 5,688,808, and 5,696,130, each of which is hereby incorporated by reference.
  • the invention features methods, compositions, and kits employing a non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant (NsIDI).
  • NsIDI non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant
  • the immune system uses cellular effectors, such as B-cells and T-cells, to target infectious microbes and abnormal cell types while leaving normal cells intact.
  • activated T-cells damage healthy tissues.
  • Calcineurin inhibitors e.g., cyclosporines, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, ABT-281, ISAtx247
  • rapamycin target many types of immunoregulatory cells, including T-cells, and suppress the immune response in organ transplantation and autoimmune disorders.
  • the NsIDI is cyclosporine A, and is administered in an amount between 0.05 and 50 milligrams per kilogram per day (e.g., orally in an amount between 0.1 and 12 milligrams per kilogram per day). In another embodiment, the NsIDI is cyclosporine and is administered as a 0.05% ophthalmic emulsion twice per day. In another embodiment, the NsIDI is tacrolimus and is administered in an amount between 0.0001-20 milligrams per kilogram per day (e.g., orally in an amount between 0.01-0.2 milligrams per kilogram per day). In another embodiment, the NsIDI is tacrolimus and is administered as a 0.02% ophthalmic suspension.
  • the NsIDI is rapamycin and is administered in an amount between 0.1-502 milligrams per day (e.g., at a single loading dose of 6 mg/day, followed by a 2 mg/day maintenance dose). In another embodiment, the NsIDI is everolimus, administered at a dosage of 0.75-8 mg/day.
  • the NsIDI is pimecrolimus, administered in an amount between 0.1 and 200 milligrams per day (e.g., as a 1% cream/twice a day to treat atopic dermatitis or 60 mg a day for the treatment of psoriasis), or the NsIDI is a calcineurin-binding peptide administered in an amount and frequency sufficient to treat the patient. Two or more NsIDIs can be administered contemporaneously.
  • the cyclosporines are fungal metabolites that comprise a class of cyclic oligopeptides that act as immunosuppressants.
  • Cyclosporine A is a hydrophobic cyclic polypeptide consisting of eleven amino acids. It binds and forms a complex with the intracellular receptor cyclophilin. The cyclosporine/cyclophilin complex binds to and inhibits calcineurin, a Ca 2+ -calmodulin-dependent serine-threonine-specific protein phosphatase. Calcineurin mediates signal transduction events required for T-cell activation (reviewed in Schreiber et al., Cell 70:365-368, 1991). Cyclosporines and their functional and structural analogs suppress the T cell-dependent immune response by inhibiting antigen-triggered signal transduction. This inhibition decreases the expression of proinflammatory cytokines, such as IL-2.
  • Cyclosporine A is a commercially available under the trade name NEORAL from Novartis.
  • Cyclosporine A structural and functional analogs include cyclosporines having one or more fluorinated amino acids (described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. No. 5,227,467); cyclosporines having modified amino acids (described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,122,511 and 4,798,823); and deuterated cyclosporines, such as ISAtx247 (described in U.S. Patent Application Publication No.
  • Cyclosporine analogs include, but are not limited to, D-Sar ( ⁇ -SMe) 3 Val 2 -DH-Cs (209-825), Allo-Thr-2-Cs, Norvaline-2-Cs, D-Ala(3-acetylamino)-8-Cs, Thr-2-Cs, and D-MeSer-3-Cs, D-Ser(O—CH 2 CH 2 —OH)-8-Cs, and D-Ser-8-Cs, which are described in Cruz et al. (Antimicrob. Agents Chemother. 44:143-149, 2000).
  • Cyclosporines are highly hydrophobic and readily precipitate in the presence of water (e.g. on contact with body fluids). Methods of providing cyclosporine formulations with improved bioavailability are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,388,307, 6,468,968, 5,051,402, 5,342,625, 5,977,066, and 6,022,852. Cyclosporine microemulsion compositions are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,866,159, 5,916,589, 5,962,014, 5,962,017, 6,007,840, and 6,024,978.
  • Cyclosporines can be administered either intravenously or orally, but oral administration is preferred.
  • an intravenous cyclosporine A may be provided in an ethanol-polyoxyethylated castor oil vehicle that must be diluted prior to administration.
  • Cyclosporine A may be provided, e.g., as a microemulsion in a 25 mg or 100 mg tablets, in a 100 mg/ml oral solution (NEORAL), or in a 0.05% ophthalmic emulsion.
  • patient dosage of an oral cyclosporine varies according to the patient's condition, but some standard recommended dosages are provided herein.
  • Patients undergoing organ transplant typically receive an initial dose of oral cyclosporine A in amounts between 12 and 15 mg/kg/day. Dosage is then gradually decreased by 5% per week until a 7-12 mg/kg/day maintenance dose is reached.
  • For intravenous administration 2-6 mg/kg/day is preferred for most patients.
  • dosage amounts from 6-8 mg/kg/day are generally given.
  • dosage amounts from 2.2-6.0 mg/kg/day are generally given.
  • dosage amounts from 0.5-4 mg/kg/day are typical.
  • a suggested dosing schedule is shown in Table 5.
  • Other useful dosages include 0.5-5 mg/kg/day, 5-10 mg/kg/day, 10-15 mg/kg/day, 15-20 mg/kg/day, or 20-25 mg/kg/day.
  • the lowest approved ophthalmic concentration of cyclosporine A is 0.05%.
  • Low concentrations of cyclosporine A are 0.04%, or more preferably 0.03%, 0.02%, 0.01%, 0.008%, 0.005%, or 0.001%.
  • the lowest standard recommended ophthalmic dosage of cyclosporine A is 0.2 ⁇ g twice daily.
  • Tacrolimus is an immunosuppressive agent that targets T cell intracellular signal transduction pathways. Tacrolimus binds to an intracellular protein FK506 binding protein (FKBP-12) that is not structurally related to cyclophilin. The FKBP/FK506 complex binds to calcineurin and inhibits calcineurin's phosphatase activity. This inhibition prevents the dephosphorylation and nuclear translocation of nuclear factor of activated T cells (NFAT), a nuclear component that initiates gene transcription required for proinflammatory cytokine (e.g., IL-2, gamma interferon) production and T cell activation. Thus, tacrolimus inhibits T cell activation.
  • NFAT nuclear factor of activated T cells
  • Tacrolimus is a macrolide antibiotic that is produced by Streptomyces tsukubaensis . It suppresses the immune system and prolongs the survival of transplanted organs. It is currently available in oral and injectable formulations.
  • Tacrolimus capsules contain 0.5 mg, 1 mg, or 5 mg of anhydrous tacrolimus within a gelatin capsule shell.
  • the injectable formulation contains 5 mg anhydrous tacrolimus in castor oil and alcohol that is diluted with 0.9% sodium chloride or 5% dextrose prior to injection. While oral administration is preferred, patients unable to take oral capsules may receive injectable tacrolimus.
  • the initial dose should be administered no sooner than six hours after transplant by continuous intravenous infusion.
  • Tacrolimus and tacrolimus analogs are described by Tanaka et al., (J. Am. Chem. Soc., 109:5031, 1987) and in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,894,366, 4,929,611, and 4,956,352.
  • FK506-related compounds including FR-900520, FR-900523, and FR-900525, are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,254,562; O-aryl, O-alkyl, O-alkenyl, and O-alkynylmacrolides are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,250,678, 532,248, 5,693,648; amino O-aryl macrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No.
  • alkylidene macrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,284,840; N-heteroaryl, N-alkylheteroaryl, N-alkenylheteroaryl, and N-alkynylheteroaryl macrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,208,241; aminomacrolides and derivatives thereof are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,208,228; fluoromacrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,189,042; amino O-alkyl, O-alkenyl, and O-alkynylmacrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,162,334; and halomacrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,143,918.
  • While suggested dosages will vary with a patient's condition, standard recommended dosages are provided below.
  • patients diagnosed as having Crohn's disease or ulcerative colitis are administered 0.1-0.2 mg/kg/day oral tacrolimus.
  • Patients having a transplanted organ typically receive doses of 0.1-0.2 mg/kg/day of oral tacrolimus.
  • Patients being treated for rheumatoid arthritis typically receive 1-3 mg/day oral tacrolimus.
  • 0.01-0.15 mg/kg/day of oral tacrolimus is administered to a patient.
  • Atopic dermatitis can be treated twice a day by applying a cream having 0.03-0.1% tacrolimus to the affected area.
  • tacrolimus capsules typically receive the first dose no sooner than six hours after transplant, or eight to twelve hours after intravenous tacrolimus infusion was discontinued.
  • Other suggested tacrolimus dosages include 0.005-0.01 mg/kg/day, 0.01-0.03 mg/kg/day, 0.03-0.05 mg/kg/day, 0.05-0.07 mg/kg/day, 0.07-0.10 mg/kg/day, 0.10-0.25 mg/kg/day, or 0.25-0.5 mg/kg/day.
  • Tacrolimus is extensively metabolized by the mixed-function oxidase system, in particular, by the cytochrome P-450 system.
  • the primary mechanism of metabolism is demethylation and hydroxylation. While various tacrolimus metabolites are likely to exhibit immunosuppressive biological activity, the 13-demethyl metabolite is reported to have the same activity as tacrolimus.
  • Pimecrolimus is the 33-epi-chloro derivative of the macrolactam ascomyin. Pimecrolimus structural and functional analogs are described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,384,073. Pimecrolimus is particularly useful for the treatment of atopic dermatitis. Pimecrolimus is currently available as a 1% cream. Suggested dosing schedule for pimecrolimus is shown at Table 5. While individual dosing will vary with the patient's condition, some standard recommended dosages are provided below. Oral pimecrolimus can be given for the treatment of psoriasis or rheumatoid arthritis in amounts of 40-60 mg/day.
  • pimecrolimus For the treatment of Crohn's disease or ulcerative colitis amounts of 80-160 mg/day pimecrolimus can be given. Patients having an organ transplant can be administered 160-240 mg/day of pimecrolimus. Patients diagnosed as having systemic lupus erythamatosus can be administered 40-120 mg/day of pimecrolimus. Other useful dosages of pimecrolimus include 0.5-5 mg/day, 5-10 mg/day, 10-30 mg/day, 40-80 mg/day, 80-120 mg/day, or even 120-200 mg/day.
  • Rapamycin is a cyclic lactone produced by Streptomyces hygroscopicus . Rapamycin is an immunosuppressive agent that inhibits T cell activation and proliferation. Like cyclosporines and tacrolimus, rapamycin forms a complex with the immunophilin FKBP-12, but the rapamycin-FKBP-12 complex does not inhibit calcineurin phosphatase activity. The rapamycin immunophilin complex binds to and inhibits the mammalian kinase target of rapamycin (mTOR). mTOR is a kinase that is required for cell-cycle progression. Inhibition of mTOR kinase activity blocks T cell activation and proinflammatory cytokine secretion.
  • mTOR mammalian kinase target of rapamycin
  • Rapamycin structural and functional analogs include mono- and diacylated rapamycin derivatives (U.S. Pat. No. 4,316,885); rapamycin water-soluble prodrugs (U.S. Pat. No. 4,650,803); carboxylic acid esters (PCT Publication No. WO 92/05179); carbamates (U.S. Pat. No. 5,118,678); amide esters (U.S. Pat. No. 5,118,678); biotin esters (U.S. Pat. No. 5,504,091); fluorinated esters (U.S. Pat. No. 5,100,883); acetals (U.S. Pat. No. 5,151,413); silyl ethers (U.S.
  • Rapamycin is currently available for oral administration in liquid and tablet formulations.
  • RAPAMUNE liquid contains 1 mg/mL rapamycin that is diluted in water or orange juice prior to administration. Tablets containing 1 or 2 mg of rapamycin are also available. Rapamycin is preferably given once daily as soon as possible after transplantation. It is absorbed rapidly and completely after oral administration.
  • patient dosage of rapamycin varies according to the patient's condition, but some standard recommended dosages are provided below.
  • the initial loading dose for rapamycin is 6 mg. Subsequent maintenance doses of 0.5-2 mg/day are typical.
  • a loading dose of 3 mg, 5 mg, 10 mg, 15 mg, 20 mg, or 25 mg can be used with a 1 mg, 3 mg, 5 mg, 7 mg, or 10 mg per day maintenance dose.
  • rapamycin dosages are typically adjusted based on body surface area; generally a 3 mg/m 2 /day loading dose and a 1 mg/m 2 /day maintenance dose is used.
  • Peptides, peptide mimetics, peptide fragments, either natural, synthetic or chemically modified, that impair the calcineurin-mediated dephosphorylation and nuclear translocation of NFAT are suitable for use in practicing the invention.
  • Examples of peptides that act as calcineurin inhibitors by inhibiting the NFAT activation and the NFAT transcription factor are described, e.g., by Aramburu et al., Science 285:2129-2133, 1999) and Aramburu et al., Mol. Cell. 1:627-637, 1998).
  • these agents are useful in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • a phosphodiesterase inhibitor may be employed in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Suitable phosphodiesterase inhibitors include inhibitors of the type III phosphodiesterases (cAMP-specific-cGMP inhibitable form), the type IV phosphodiesterases (high affinity-high specificity cAMP form) and the type V phosphodiesterases (the cGMP specific form).
  • type III phosphodiesterase inhibitors include bipyridines such as mihinone and aminone, imidazolones such as piroximone and enoximone, dihydropyridazinones such as imazodan, 5-methylimazodan, indolidan and ICI118233 (6-(p-(3-methylureido)phenyl)-3(2H)-pyridazinone), quinolinone compounds such as cilostamide, cilostazol and vesnarinone, and other compounds such as bemoradan, anergrelide, siguazodan, trequensin, pimobendan, SKF-94120 (5-(4-acetamidophenyl)pyrazin-2-(1H)-one), SKF-95654, lixazinone and isomazole.
  • bipyridines such as mihinone and aminone
  • imidazolones such as piroximone and enoxi
  • type IV phosphodiesterase inhibitors include rolipram and rolipram derivatives such as RO-20-1724 (4-(3-butyloxy-4-methoxyphenyl)-imidazolidinone), nitraquazone and nitraquazone derivatives such as CP-77059 (1-(carbomethoxyphenyl)-3-benzylpyrido[2,3d]pyrimidine-2,4(1H,3H)dione), and RS-25344-00 (1-(3-nitrophenyl)-3-(4-pyridylmethyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro pyrido(2,3-d) pyrimidine-2,4-dione)), xanthine derivatives such as denbufylline and ICI63197, and miscellaneous other compounds such as EMD54622 (5-[1-(3,4-dimethoxybenzoyl)-4,4-dimethyl-1,2,3,4-tetra
  • type V phosphodiesterase inhibitors examples include zaprinast, MY5445 (N-(3-chlorophenyl)-4-phenyl-1-phthalazinamine), dipyridamole, and sildenafil.
  • Sildenafil (5-[2-ethoxy-5-(4-methyl-1-piperazinylsulfonyl)-phenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propy 1-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one) and other suitable type V phosphodiesterase inhibitors are disclosed in PCT Publication Nos.
  • WO 94/28902 and WO 96/16644 e.g., 5-(2-ethoxy-5-morpholinoacetyl-phenyl)-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-(5-morpholino-acetyl-2-n-propoxyphenyl)-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-[2-ethoxy-5-(4-methyl-1-piperazinylsulfonyl)-phenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-[2-allyloxy-5-(4-methyl-1-piperazinylsulfonyl)-phenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-d
  • Still other type V phosphodiesterase inhibitors useful in conjunction with the present invention are IC-351 (ICOS), also referred to as tadalafil, 4-bromo-5-(pyridylmethylamino)-6-[3-(4-chlorophenyl)-propoxy]-3(2H)pyridazinone, 1-[4-[(1,3-benzodioxol-5-ylmethyl)amiono]-6-chloro-2-quinazolinyl]-4-piperidine-carboxylic acid, monosodium salt, (+)-cis-5,6a,7,9,9,9a-hexahydro-2-[4-(trifluoromethyl)-phenylmethyl-5-methyl-cyclopent-4,5]imidazo[2,1-b]purin-4(3H)one, furazlocillin, cis-2-hexyl-5-methyl-3,4,5,6a,7,8,9,9a-oct
  • phosphodiesterase inhibitors that may be used in the present invention include filaminast, piclamilast, Org 20241, MCI-154, roflumilast, toborinone, posicar, pyrazolopyrimidinones (such as those disclosed in WO 98/49166), motapizone, pimobendan, zardaverine, siguazodan, CI 930, EMD 53998, imazodan, saterinone, loprinone hydrochloride, 3-pyridinecarbonitrile derivatives, albifylline, torbafylline, doxofylline, theophylline, pentoxofylline, nanterinone, cilostazol, cilostamide, MS 857, piroximone, milrinone, anrinone, tolafentrine, papaverine, E4021, thienopyrimidine derivatives (such as those disclosed in PCT Publication No.
  • WO 98/17668 triflusal, tetrahydropiperazino[1,2-b]beta-carboline-1,4-dione derivatives (such as those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,859,006 and PCT Publication Nos. WO 97/03985 and WO 97/03675), carboline derivatives, (such as those disclosed in PCT Publication No. WO 97/43287), 2-pyrazolin-5-one derivatives (such as those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,869,516), fused pyridazine derivatives (such as those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No.
  • Alpha-2-adrenergic agonists can be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • An exemplary alpha-2-adrenergic agonist is brimonidine (5-bromo-N-(4,5-dihydro-1H-imidazil-2-yl)-6-quinoxalinamine), described in U.S. Pat. No. 3,890,319.
  • alpha-2-adrenergic agonists that can be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include apraclonidine, clonidine, dexmedetomidine, guanabenz, guanfacine, medetomidine, methyldopa, oxymetazoline, tizanidine, and ( ⁇ )-(R,S)-5,6-diisobutyryloxy-2-methylaminotetralin.
  • Other alpha-2-adrenergic agonists are described in U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • brimonidine is available as brimonidine tartrate ophthalmic solution 0.2%.
  • Prostaglandins may be used in the methods, compostions, and kits of the invention.
  • Prostaglandins include alprostidil, dinoprostone, misoprostil, limaprost, bimatoprost, travoprost, unoprostone, latanoprost, prostaglandin E2, prostaglandin A1, prostaglandin A2, prostaglandin B1, prostaglandin B2, prostaglandin D2, prostaglandin F1 ⁇ , prostaglandin F2 ⁇ , prostaglandin I1, prostaglandin-ici 74205, prostaglandin F2 ⁇ , 6-keto-prostaglandin F1 ⁇ , prostaglandin E1 ethyl ester, prostaglandin E1 methyl ester, prostaglandin F2 methyl ester, arbaprostil, ornoprostil, 13,14-dihydroprostaglandin F2 ⁇ , and prostaglandin J.
  • Ophthalmic formulations of prostaglandins include
  • a tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine or an adenosine activity upregulator can be used in combination with a second agent in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine is meant a compound having the formula (V): wherein each Z and each Z′ is, independently, N, O, C,
  • each R 1 is, independently, X, OH, N-alkyl (wherein the alkyl group has 1 to 20, more preferably 1-5, carbon atoms); a branched or unbranched alkyl group having 1 to 20, more preferably 1-5, carbon atoms; or a heterocycle, preferably as defined in formula (V).
  • two R 1 groups from a common Z or Z′ atom, in combination with each other may represent —(CY 2 ) k — in which k is an integer between 4 and 6, inclusive.
  • Each Y is, independently, H, F, Cl, Br, or I.
  • each Z is the same moiety, each Z′ is the same moiety, and Z and Z′ are different moieties.
  • adenosine activity upregulator is meant adenosine and any compounds that mimic or potentiate the physiological effects of adenosine, such as adenosine receptor agonists, adenosine transport inhibitors, adenosine kinase inhibitors, and phosphodiesterase (PDE) inhibitors, as described herein.
  • adenosine receptor agonists such as adenosine receptor agonists, adenosine transport inhibitors, adenosine kinase inhibitors, and phosphodiesterase (PDE) inhibitors, as described herein.
  • PDE phosphodiesterase
  • Adenosine receptor agonists include adenosine hemisulfate salt, adenosine amine congener solid, N 6 -(4-amino-3-iodophenyl)methyl-5′-N-methylcarboxamidoadenosine (1-AB-MECA); N-((2-methylphenyl)methyl)adenosine (Metrifudil); 2-(1-hexynyl)-N-methyladenosine (HEMADO); N-(1-methyl-2-phenylethyl)adenosine (R-PIA); N 6 —(R-4-hydroxyphenylisopropyl) adenosine (HPIA); N 6 -cyclopentyladenosine (CPA); N 6 -cyclopentyl-2-(3-phenylaminocarbonyltriazene-1-yl)adenosine (TCPA); N-((1S,trans)-2-hydroxycycl
  • adenosine receptor agonists are those described or claimed in Gao et al., JPET, 298: 209-218 (2001); U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,278,150, 5,877,180, 6,232,297; U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2005/0261236, and PCT Publication No. WO/9808855, incorporated herein by reference.
  • Adenosine transport inhibitors that can be employed in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include 3-[1-(6,7-diethoxy-2-morpholinoquinazolin-4-yl)piperidin-4-yl]-1,6-dimethyl-2,4(1H,3H)-quinazolinedione hydrochloride (KF24345); 6-(4-nitrobenzyl)-thioinosine (NBI) and 6-(2-hydroxy-5-nitrobenzyl)-thioguanosine (NBG); 6-[4-(1-cyclohexyl-1H-tetrazol-5-yl)butoxy]-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-quinolinone (Cilostazol); (2-amino-4,5-dimethyl-3-thienyl)-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]methanone (PD 81723); 3,7-dihydro-3-methyl-1-(5-oxohexyl)
  • Adenosine kinase inhibitors can be used as adenosine activity upregulators in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Adenosine kinase inhibitors are generally described as either nucleoside-like, or nonnucleoside-like.
  • Nucleoside-like adenosine kinase inhibitors that can be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include 5-iodotubercidin (5IT) and 2-diaryltubercidin analogues; 5′-deoxo-5′-deoxy-5-iodotubercidin (5′d-5IT); and 5′-deoxo-5′-aminoadenosine (NH 2 dADO).
  • 5IT 5-iodotubercidin
  • 2-diaryltubercidin analogues 5′-deoxo-5′-deoxy-5-iodotubercidin
  • 5′d-5IT 5′-deoxo-5′-aminoadenosine
  • NH 2 dADO 5′-deoxo-5′-aminoadenosine
  • Nonnucleoside-like adenosine kinase inhibitors that can be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include 5-bromopyrrolopyrrolidine; 4-amino-5-(3-bromophenyl)-7-(6-morpholino-pyridin-3-yl)pyrido[2,3-d]pyrimidine (ABT-702).
  • ABT-702 4-amino-5-(3-bromophenyl)-7-(6-morpholino-pyridin-3-yl)pyrido[2,3-d]pyrimidine
  • Other nonnucleoside-like AK inhibitors are described in McGaraughty et al., Current Topics in Medicinal Chemistry 5:43-58 (2005), Gomtsyan and Lee, Current Pharmaceutical Design 10:1093-1103 (2004); Jarvis et al. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther. 295:1156-1164 (2000); Kowaluk, et al
  • isozymes of phosphodiesterases act as regulatory switches by catalyzing the degradation of cAMP to adenosine-5-monophosphate (5′-AMP). Inhibitors of phosphodiesterases can lead to an increase in cAMP levels, which in turn can lead to an increase in antiinflammatory actions.
  • Type I PDE inhibitors include (3-alpha,16-alpha)-eburnamenine-14-carboxylic acid ethyl ester (Vinpocetine); 18-methoxymethyl-3-isobutyl-1-methylxantine (MIMX); 1-carboxy-2,3,4,4a,4b,5,6,6a,6b,7,8,8a,8b,9,10,10a,14,16,17,17a,17b,18,19,19a,19b,20,21,21a,21b,22,23,23a-dotriacontahydro-14-hydroxy-8a,10a-bis(hydroxymethyl)-14-(3-methoxy-3-oxopropyl)-1,4,4a, 6,6a,17b,19b,21b-octamethyl beta-D-glucopyranosiduronic acid (Ks-505a); cis-5,6a,7,8,9,9a-hexahydro-2-(4-
  • Type II PDE inhibitors include erythro-9-(2-hydroxy-3-nonyl)adenine (EHNA); 2,3,6,7-tetrahydro-9,10-dimethoxy-3-methyl-2-((2,4,6-trimethylphenyl)imino)-4H-pyrimido(6,1-a)isoquinolin-4-one (trequinsin); ND7001 (Neuro3D Pharmaceuticals); and BAY 60-7550 (Alexis Biochemicals).
  • EHNA erythro-9-(2-hydroxy-3-nonyl)adenine
  • trequinsin 2,3,6,7-tetrahydro-9,10-dimethoxy-3-methyl-2-((2,4,6-trimethylphenyl)imino)-4H-pyrimido(6,1-a)isoquinolin-4-one
  • ND7001 Neuro3D Pharmaceuticals
  • BAY 60-7550 Alexis Biochemicals
  • Type III PDE inhibitors include 3-isobutyl-1-methylxanthine (IBMX); 6-dihydro-2-methyl-6-oxo-3,4′-bipyridine)-5-carbonitrile (milrinone) and N-cyclohexyl-4-((1,2-dihydro-2-oxo-6-quinolinyl)oxy)-N-methyl-butanamide (cilostamide).
  • Type III PDE inhibitors are described in the following patents and patent applications: EP 0 653 426, EP 0 294 647, EP 0 357 788, EP 0 220 044, EP 0 326 307, EP 0 207 500, EP 0 406 958, EP 0 150 937, EP 0 075 463, EP 0 272 914, and EP 0 112 987, U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,963,561; 5,141,931, 6,897,229, and 6,156,753; U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos.
  • Type IV PDE inhibitors include 4-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxyphenyl)-2-pyrrolidone (rolipram) and 4-(3-butoxy-4-methoxybenzyl)-2-imidazolidinone (Ro20-1724).
  • Other Type IV PDE inhibitors are described in the following patents, patent applications, and references: U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,892,777, 4,193,926, 4,655,074, 4,965,271, 5,096,906, 5,124,455, 5,272,153, 6,569,890, 6,953,853, 6,933,296, 6,919,353, 6,953,810, 6,949,573, 6,909,002, and 6,740,655; U.S.
  • Type V PDE inhibitors are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,992,192, 6,984,641, 6,960,587, 6,943,166, 6,878,711, and 6,869,950, and U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2003/0144296, 2003/0171384, 2004/0029891, 2004/0038996, 2004/0186046, 2004/0259792, 2004/0087561, 2005/0054660, 2005/0042177, 2005/0245544, and 2006/0009481.
  • Type VI PDE inhibitors include those described in U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2004/0259792, 2004/0248957, 2004/0242673, and 2004/0259880.
  • Type VII PDE inhibitors include those described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,838,559, 6,753,340, 6,617,357, and 6,852,720; U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2003/0186988, 2003/0162802, 2003/0191167, 2004/0214843, and 2006/0009481; PCT Publication WO 00/68230; and Martinez et al., J. Med. Chem. 43:683-689, 2000.
  • Tricyclic compounds that can be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include amitriptyline, amoxapine, clomipramine, desipramine, dothiepin, doxepin, imipramine, lofepramine, maprotiline, mianserin, mirtazapine, nortriptyline, octriptyline, oxaprotiline, protriptyline, trimipramine, 10-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl)pyrido(4,3-b)(1,4)benzothiazepine; 11-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)-5H-dibenzo(b,e)(1,4)diazepine; 5,10-dihydro-7-chloro-10-(2-(morpholino)ethyl)-11H-dibenzo(b,e)(1,4)diazepin-11-one; 2-(2-(7-hydroxy-4-dibenzo(b,f
  • SSRIs may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Suitable SSRIs are cericlamine (e.g., cericlamine hydrochloride); citalopram (e.g., citalopram hydrobromide); clovoxamine; cyanodothiepin; dapoxetine; escitalopram (escitalopram oxalate); femoxetine (e.g., femoxetine hydrochloride); fluoxetine (e.g., fluoxetine hydrochloride); fluvoxamine (e.g., fluvoxamine maleate); ifoxetine; indalpine (e.g., indalpine hydrochloride); indeloxazine (e.g., indeloxazine hydrochloride); litoxetine; milnacipran (e.g., minlacipran hydrochloride); paroxetine (e.g., par
  • Structural analogs of cericlamine are those having the formula: as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein R 1 is a C 1 -C 4 alkyl and R 2 is H or C 1-4 alkyl, R 3 is H, C 1-4 alkyl, C 2-4 alkenyl, phenylalkyl or cycloalkylalkyl with 3 to 6 cyclic carbon atoms, alkanoyl, phenylalkanoyl or cycloalkylcarbonyl having 3 to 6 cyclic carbon atoms, or R 2 and R 3 form, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are linked, a heterocycle saturated with 5 to 7 chain links which can have, as the second heteroatom not directly connected to the nitrogen atom, an oxygen, a sulphur or a nitrogen, the latter nitrogen heteroatom possibly carrying a C 2-4 alkyl.
  • cericlamine structural analogs are 2-methyl-2-amino-3-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-propanol, 2-pentyl-2-amino-3-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-propanol, 2-methyl-2-methylamino-3-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-propanol, 2-methyl-2-dimethylamino-3-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-propanol, and pharmaceutically acceptable salts of any thereof.
  • Structural analogs of citalopram are those having the formula: as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein each of R 1 and R 2 is independently selected from the group consisting of bromo, chloro, fluoro, trifluoromethyl, cyano and R—CO—, wherein R is C 1-4 alkyl.
  • Exemplary citalopram structural analogs are 1-(4′-fluorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-bromophthalane; 1-(4′-chlorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-chlorophthalane; 1-(4′-bromophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-chlorophthalane; 1-(4′-fluorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-chlorophthalane; 1-(4′-chlorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-trifluoromethyl-phthalane; 1-(4′-bromophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-trifluoromethyl-phthalane; 1-(4′-fluorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylamin
  • Structural analogs of clovoxamine are those having the formula: as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein Hal is a chloro, bromo, or fluoro group and R is a cyano, methoxy, ethoxy, methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, methoxyethoxy, or cyanomethyl group.
  • Exemplary clovoxamine structural analogs are 4′-chloro-5-ethoxyvalerophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-chloro-5-(2-methoxyethoxy)valerophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-chloro-6-methoxycaprophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-chloro-6-ethoxycaprophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-bromo-5-(2-methoxyethoxy)valerophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-bromo-5-methoxyvalerophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-chloro-6-cyanocaprophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-chloro-5-cyanovalerophenone O-(2-
  • Structural analogs of femoxetine are those having the formula: wherein R 1 represents a C 1-4 alkyl or C 2-4 alkynyl group, or a phenyl group optionally substituted by C 1-4 alkyl, C 1-4 alkylthio, C 1-4 alkoxy, bromo, chloro, fluoro, nitro, acylamino, methylsulfonyl, methylenedioxy, or tetrahydronaphthyl, R 2 represents a C 1-4 alkyl or C 2-4 alkynyl group, and R 3 represents hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, C 1-4 alkoxy, trifluoroalkyl, hydroxy, bromo, chloro, fluoro, methylthio, or aralkyloxy.
  • Structural analogs of fluoxetine are those compounds having the formula: as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein each R 1 is independently hydrogen or methyl; R is naphthyl or wherein each of R 2 and R 3 is, independently, bromo, chloro, fluoro, trifluoromethyl, C 1-4 alkyl, C 1-3 alkoxy or C 3-4 alkenyl; and each of n and m is, independently, 0, 1 or 2.
  • R is naphthyl, it can be either ⁇ -naphthyl or ⁇ -naphthyl.
  • Exemplary fluoxetine structural analogs are 3-(p-isopropoxyphenoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine methanesulfonate, N,N-dimethyl 3-(3′,4′-dimethoxyphenoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine p-hydroxybenzoate, N,N-dimethyl 3-( ⁇ -naphthoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine bromide, N,N-dimethyl 3-( ⁇ -naphthoxy)-3-phenyl-1-methylpropylamine iodide, 3-(2′-methyl-4′,5′-dichlorophenoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine nitrate, 3-(p-t-butylphenoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine glutarate, N-methyl 3-(2′-chloro-p-tolyloxy)-3-phenyl-1-methylpropylamine lactate, 3-(2′,4′-dichlorophenoxy)-3-pheny
  • Structural analogs of fluvoxamine are those having the formula: as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein R is cyano, cyanomethyl, methoxymethyl, or ethoxymethyl.
  • Structural analogs of indalpine are those having the formula: or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein R 1 is a hydrogen atom, a C 1 -C 4 alkyl group, or an aralkyl group of which the alkyl has 1 or 2 carbon atoms, R 2 is hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, C 1-4 alkoxy or C 1-4 alkylthio, chloro, bromo, fluoro, trifluoromethyl, nitro, hydroxy, or amino, the latter optionally substituted by one or two C 1-4 alkyl groups, an acyl group or a C 1-4 alkylsulfonyl group; A represents —CO or —CH 2 — group; and n is 0, 1 or 2.
  • indalpine structural analogs are indolyl-3 (piperidyl-4 methyl) ketone; (methoxy-5-indolyl-3) (piperidyl-4 methyl) ketone; (chloro-5-indolyl-3) (piperidyl-4 methyl) ketone; (indolyl-3)-1(piperidyl-4)-3 propanone, indolyl-3 piperidyl-4 ketone; (methyl-1 indolyl-3) (piperidyl-4 methyl) ketone, (benzyl-1 indolyl-3) (piperidyl-4 methyl) ketone; [(methoxy-5 indolyl-3)-2 ethyl]-piperidine, [(methyl-1 indolyl-3)-2 ethyl]-4-piperidine; [(indolyl-3)-2 ethyl]-4 piperidine; (indolyl-3 methyl)-4 piperidine, [(chloro
  • Structural analogs of indeloxazine are those having the formula: and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein R 1 and R 3 each represents hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, or phenyl; R 2 represents hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, C 4-7 cycloalkyl, phenyl, or benzyl; one of the dotted lines means a single bond and the other means a double bond, or the tautomeric mixtures thereof.
  • Exemplary indeloxazine structural analogs are 2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-4-isopropylmorpholine; 4-butyl-2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-4-methylmorpholine; 4-ethyl-2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine, 2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-morpholine; 2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-4-propylmorpholine; 4-cyclohexyl-2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 4-benzyl-2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-morpholine; 2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-4-phenylmorpholine; 2-(4-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 2-(3-methyl-7-indenyloxymethyl)-morpholine; 4-isopropyl-2-(3-methyl-7-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 4-is
  • Structural analogs of milnacipram are those having the formula: as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein each R, independently, represents hydrogen, bromo, chloro, fluoro, C 1-4 alkyl, C 1-4 alkoxy, hydroxy, nitro or amino; each of R 1 and R 2 , independently, represents hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, C 6-12 aryl or C 7-14 alkylaryl, optionally substituted, preferably in para position, by bromo, chloro, or fluoro, or R 1 and R 2 together form a heterocycle having 5 or 6 members with the adjacent nitrogen atoms; R 3 and R 4 represent hydrogen or a C 1-4 alkyl group or R 3 and R 4 form with the adjacent nitrogen atom a heterocycle having 5 or 6 members, optionally containing an additional heteroatom selected from nitrogen, sulphur, and oxygen.
  • Exemplary milnacipram structural analogs are 1-phenyl 1-aminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-phenyl 1-dimethylaminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-phenyl 1-ethylaminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-phenyl 1-diethylaminocarbonyl 2-aminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-phenyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl N-(4′-chlorophenyl)cyclopropane carboxamide; 1-phenyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl N-(4′-chlorobenzyl)cyclopropane carboxamide; 1-phenyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl N-(2-phenylethyl)cyclopropane carboxamide; (3,4-dichloro-1-phenyl) 2-dimethylaminomethyl N,N-dimethylcyclopropan
  • Structural analogs of paroxetine are those having the formula: and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein R 1 represents hydrogen or a C 1-4 alkyl group, and the fluorine atom may be in any of the available positions.
  • Structural analogs of sertraline are those having the formula: wherein R 1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and C 1-4 alkyl; R 2 is C 1-4 alkyl; X and Y are each selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, fluoro, chloro, bromo, trifluoromethyl, C 1-3 alkoxy, and cyano; and W is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, fluoro, chloro, bromo, trifluoromethyl and C 1-3 alkoxy.
  • Preferred sertraline analogs are in the cis-isomeric configuration.
  • cis-isomeric refers to the relative orientation of the NR 1 R 2 and phenyl moieties on the cyclohexene ring (i.e. they are both oriented on the same side of the ring). Because both the 1- and 4-carbons are asymmetrically substituted, each cis-compound has two optically active enantiomeric forms denoted (with reference to the 1-carbon) as the cis-(1R) and cis-(1S) enantiomers.
  • Structural analogs of zimeldine are those compounds having the formula: and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein the pyridine nucleus is bound in ortho-, meta- or para-position to the adjacent carbon atom and where R 1 is selected from the group consisting of H, chloro, fluoro, and bromo.
  • Exemplary zimeldine analogs are (e)- and (z)-3-(4′-bromophenyl-3-(2′′-pyridyl)-dimethylallylamine; 3-(4′-bromophenyl)-3-(3′′-pyridyl)-dimethylallylamine; 3-(4′-bromophenyl)-3-(4′′-pyridyl)-dimethylallylamine; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts of any thereof.
  • Structural analogs of any of the above SSRIs are considered herein to be SSRI analogs and thus may be employed in any of the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Pharmacologically active metabolites of any of the foregoing SSRIs can also be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Exemplary metabolites are didesmethylcitalopram, desmethylcitalopram, desmethylsertraline, and norfluoxetine.
  • SSRIs serotonin norepinephrine reuptake inhibitors
  • SNRIs selective serotonin norepinephrine reuptake inhibitors
  • venlafaxine venlafaxine
  • duloxetine venlafaxine
  • Structural analogs of venlafaxine are those compounds having the formula: as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein A is a moiety of the formula: where the dotted line represents optional unsaturation; R 1 is hydrogen or alkyl; R 2 is C 1-4 alkyl; R 4 is hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, formyl or alkanoyl; R 3 is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl; R 5 and R 6 are, independently, hydrogen, hydroxyl, C 1-4 alkyl, C 1-4 alkoxy, C 1-4 alkanoyloxy, cyano, nitro, alkylmercapto, amino, C 1-4 alkylamino, dialkylamino, C 1-4 alkanamido, halo, trifluoromethyl or, taken together, methylenedioxy; and n is 0, 1, 2, 3 or 4.
  • Structural analogs of duloxetine are those compounds described by the formula disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,956,388, hereby incorporated by reference.
  • SSRI analogs are 4-(2-fluorophenyl)-6-methyl-2-piperazinothieno[2,3-d]pyrimidine, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-N-methyl-4-phenyl-1-naphthylamine hydrochloride; 1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-N-methyl-4-phenyl-(E)-1-naphthylamine hydrochloride; N,N-dimethyl-1-phenyl-1-phthalanpropylamine hydrochloride; gamma-(4-(trifluoromethyl)phenoxy)-benzenepropanamine hydrochloride; BP 554; CP 53261; 0-desmethylvenlafaxine; WY 45,818; WY 45,881; N-(3-fluoropropyl)paroxetine; Lu 19005; and SNRIs described in PCT Publication No. WO04/004734.
  • Standard recommended dosages for exemplary SSRIs are provided in Table 7, below. Other standard dosages are provided, e.g., in the Merck Manual of Diagnosis & Therapy (17th Ed. M H Beers et al., Merck & Co.) and Physicians' Desk Reference 2003 (57 th Ed. Medical Economics Staff et al., Medical Economics Co., 2002). TABLE 7 Compound Standard Dose Fluoxetine 20-80 mg/day Sertraline 50-200 mg/day Paroxetine 20-50 mg/day Fluvoxamine 50-300 mg/day Citalopram 10-80 mg qid Escitalopram 10 mg qid Antihistamines
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention employ a histamine receptor antagonist (or analog thereof).
  • Antihistamines are compounds that block the action of histamine. Classes of antihistamines include:
  • Ethanolamines e.g., bromodiphenhydramine, carbinoxamine, clemastine, dimenhydrinate, diphenhydramine, diphenylpyraline, and doxylamine
  • Ethylenediamines e.g., pheniramine, pyrilamine, tripelennamine, and triprolidine
  • Phenothiazines e.g., diethazine, ethopropazine, methdilazine, promethazine, thiethylperazine, and trimeprazine
  • Alkylamines e.g., acrivastine, brompheniramine, chlorpheniramine, desbrompheniramine, dexchlorpheniramine, pyrrobutamine, and triprolidine;
  • piperazines e.g., buclizine, cetirizine, chlorcyclizine, cyclizine, meclizine, hydroxyzine
  • Piperidines e.g., astemizole, azatadine, cyproheptadine, desloratadine, fexofenadine, loratadine, ketotifen, olopatadine, phenindamine, and terfenadine;
  • Atypical antihistamines e.g., azelastine, levocabastine, methapyrilene, and phenyltoxamine.
  • non-sedating and sedating antihistamines may be employed.
  • Particularly desirable antihistamines for use in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention are non-sedating antihistamines such as loratadine and desloratadine. Sedating antihistamines can also be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Preferred sedating antihistamines for use in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention are azatadine, bromodiphenhydramine; chlorpheniramine; clemizole; cyproheptadine; dimenhydrinate; diphenhydramine; doxylamine; meclizine; promethazine; pyrilamine; thiethylperazine; and tripelennamine.
  • antihistamines suitable for use in the methods and compositions of the invention are acrivastine; ahistan; antazoline; astemizole; azelastine (e.g., azelsatine hydrochloride); bamipine; bepotastine; bietanautine; brompheniramine (e.g., brompheniramine maleate); carbinoxamine (e.g., carbinoxamine maleate); cetirizine (e.g., cetirizine hydrochloride); cetoxime; chlorocyclizine; chloropyramine; chlorothen; chlorphenoxamine; cinnarizine; clemastine (e.g., clemastine fumarate); clobenzepam; clobenztropine; clocinizine; cyclizine (e.g., cyclizine hydrochloride; cyclizine lactate); deptropine; dexchlorpheniramine; de
  • Antihistamine analogs include, without limitation, 10-piperazinylpropylphenothiazine; 4-(3-(2-chlorophenothiazin-10-yl)propyl)-1-piperazineethanol dihydrochloride; 1-(10-(3-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)propyl)-10H-phenothiazin-2-yl)-(9CI) 1-propanone; 3-methoxycyproheptadine; 4-(3-(2-Chloro-10H-phenothiazin-10-yl)propyl)piperazine-1-ethanol hydrochloride; 10,11-dihydro-5-(3-(4-ethoxycarbonyl-4-phenylpiperidino)propylidene)-5H-dibenzo(a,d)cycloheptene; aceprometazine; acetophenazine; alimemaz
  • AD-0261 AHR-5333; alinastine; arpromidine; ATI-19000; bermastine; bilastin; Bron-12; carebastine; chlorphenamine; clofurenadine; corsym; DF-1105501; DF-11062; DF-1111301; EL-301; elbanizine; F-7946T; F-9505; HE-90481; HE-90512; hivenyl; HSR-609; icotidine; KAA-276; KY-234; lamiakast; LAS-36509; LAS-36674; levocetirizine; levoprotiline; metoclopramide; NIP-531; noberastine; oxatomide; PR-881-884A; quisultazine; rocastine; selenotifen; SK&F-94461; SODAS-HC; tagorizine; TAK-4
  • Standard recommended dosages for several exemplary antihistamines are shown in Table 8. Other standard dosages are provided, e.g., in the Merck Manual of Diagnosis & Therapy (17th Ed. M H Beers et al., Merck & Co.) and Physicians' Desk Reference 2003 (57 th Ed. Medical Economics Staff et al., Medical Economics Co., 2002).
  • Loratadine is a tricyclic piperidine that acts as a selective peripheral histamine H1-receptor antagonist.
  • Loratadine and structural and functional analogs thereof, such as piperidines, tricyclic piperidines, histamine H1-receptor antagonists, may be used in the anti-immunoinflammatory combination of the invention for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders, transplanted organ rejection, and graft versus host disease.
  • Loratadine functional and/or structural analogs include other H1-receptor antagonists, such as AHR-11325, acrivastine, antazoline, astemizole, azatadine, azelastine, bromopheniramine, carebastine, cetirizine, chlorpheniramine, chlorcyclizine, clemastine, cyproheptadine, descarboethoxyloratadine, dexchlorpheniramine, dimenhydrinate, diphenylpyraline, diphenhydramine, ebastine, fexofenadine, hydroxyzine ketotifen, lodoxamide, levocabastine, methdilazine, mequitazine, oxatomide, pheniramine pyrilamine, promethazine, pyrilamine, setastine, tazifylline, warmthlastine, terfenadine, trimeprazine, tripelennamine, trip
  • Piperidine H1-receptor antagonists include loratadine, cyproheptadine hydrochloride (PERIACTIN), and phenindiamine tartrate (NOLAHIST).
  • Piperazine H1-receptor antagonists include hydroxyzine hydrochloride (ATARAX), hydroxyzine pamoate (VISTARIL), cyclizine hydrochloride (MAREZINE), cyclizine lactate, and meclizine hydrochloride.
  • Loratadine oral formulations include tablets, redi-tabs, and syrup. Loratadine tablets contain 10 mg micronized loratadine. Loratadine syrup contains 1 mg/ml micronized loratadine, and reditabs (rapidly-disintegrating tablets) contain 10 mg micronized loratadine in tablets that disintegrate quickly in the mouth. While suggested dosages will vary with a patient's condition, standard recommended dosages are provided below. Loratadine is typically administered once daily in a 10 mg dose, although other daily dosages useful in the anti-immunoinflammatory combination of the invention include 0.01-0.05 mg, 0.05-1 mg, 1-3 mg, 3-5 mg, 5-10 mg, 10-15 mg, 15-20 mg, 20-30 mg, and 30-40 mg.
  • Loratadine is rapidly absorbed following oral administration. It is metabolized in the liver to descarboethoxyloratadine by cytochrome P450 3A4 and cytochrome P450 2D6. Loratadine metabolites are also useful in the anti-immunoinflammatory combination of the invention.
  • Bufexamac p-butoxyphenylacetydroxamic, 4-butoxyphenylacetohydroxamic acts as an anti-pruritic and anti-inflammatory drug.
  • Bufexamac analogs include, but are not limited to, 2-(p-propoxyphenyl)acetohydroxamic acid; 2-(4-butoxy-m-tolyl)acetohydroxamic acid; 2-(4-butoxy-3-ethylphenyl)acetohydroxamic acid; 2-(4-butoxy-3-chlorophenyl)acetohydroxamic acid.
  • the indications for bufexamac include but are not limited to eczema, dermatitis, pruritus, and hemorrhoids.
  • Bufexamac is currently available in a cream, oral, gel, ointment, or suppository formulation. The cream is typically used 1 to 3 times daily. Creams, ointments, suppositories, and gels have a concentration of bufexamac ranging from 0.25% to 0.5%.
  • oral dosages of bufexamac are often given for patients afflicted with rheumatoid arthritis. In this case, a dosage of bufexamac of 250 mg is given four times a day. Clinical dosages of bufexamac up to 2.0 g per day have been given.
  • Calcium channel inhibitors may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Calcium channel inhibitors include verapamil, anipamil, bepridil, gallopamil, devapamil, falipamil, tiapamil, nifedipine, amlodipine, dazodipine, felodipine, isradipine, lanicardipine, nicardipine, nimodipine, nisoldipine, nitrendipine, ryosidie, diltiazem, cinnarizine, and flunarizine, BAY-m 4786, and diperdipine.
  • Antidyskinetic compounds that may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include D-AP5 (D( ⁇ )-2-amino-5-phosphonopentanoate), CGS19755 (4-phosphonomethyl-2-piperidine carboxylic acid), CGP37849 (D,L-(E)-2-amino-4-methylphosphono-3-pentanoic acid), LY233053 (cis-(.+ ⁇ .)-4-(2H-tetrazol-5-yl)methyl-piperidine-2-carboxyl acid), AIDA (1-aminoindan-1,5(RS)-dicarboxylic acid), (s)-(+)-CBPG ((S)-(+)-2-(3′-carboxy-bicyclo(1.1.1.)pentyl)glycine), CPCCOEt (cyclopropan(b)chromen-1a-carboxylate), EGLU ((s)-(.alpha.)-ethyl
  • Anticoccidial compounds may be employed in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Such compounds include salinomycin, monensin, narasin, lasalocid, nicarbazin, maduramycin, nicarbazin and narasin in combination, diclazuril, dinitolmide, halofuginone, robenidine, amprolium and clopidol. Other anticoccidial compounds are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,582,822; 4,824,863; 5,552,386; 6,384,052; and 6,528,531.
  • the invention features methods for treating an immunoinflammatory disorder. While the examples describe a two-drug combination, it is understood that the combination of multiple agents is often desirable. For example, methotrexate, hydroxychloroquine, and sulfasalazine are commonly administered for the treatment of rheumatoid arthritis, and may also be employed in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Additional therapies are described below.
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention are more effective than other methods, compositions, and kits.
  • “more effective” is meant that a method, composition, or kit exhibits greater efficacy, is less toxic, safer, more convenient, better tolerated, or less expensive, or provides more treatment satisfaction than another method, composition, or kit with which it is being compared.
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of psoriasis.
  • one or more antipsoriatic agents typically used to treat psoriasis may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • agents include biologics (e.g.
  • retinoids e.g. acitretin, tazarotene
  • DMARDs e.g. methotrexate
  • anthralin topical glucocorticosteroids (e.g. clobetasol, triamcinolone, betamethasone, hydrocortisone, halobetasol, diflorasone, mometasone, halcinonide, fluticasone), and systemic glucocorticosteroids (e.g. prednisone, dexamethasone).
  • glucocorticosteroids e.g. clobetasol, triamcinolone, betamethasone, hydrocortisone, halobetasol, diflorasone, mometasone, halcinonide, fluticasone
  • systemic glucocorticosteroids e.g. prednisone, dexamethasone
  • atopic dermatitis agents typically used to treat atopic dermatitis may be used in the methods, composition, and kits of the invention.
  • agents include topical and systemic non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressants (e.g. cyclosporine, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, ABT-281, and ISAtx247), topical glucocorticosteroids (e.g.
  • clobetasol triamcinolone, betamethasone, hydrocortisone, halobetasol, diflorasone, mometasone, halcinonide, fluticasone), systemic glucocorticosteroids (e.g. prednisone, dexamethasone) and antihistamines (e.g. hydroxyzine, loratadine, cetirizine, diphenhydramine, cyproheptadine, fexofenadine).
  • systemic glucocorticosteroids e.g. prednisone, dexamethasone
  • antihistamines e.g. hydroxyzine, loratadine, cetirizine, diphenhydramine, cyproheptadine, fexofenadine.
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of hand dermatitis.
  • hand dermatitis agents typically used to treat hand dermatitis may be used in the methods, composition, and kits of the invention.
  • Such agents include topical and systemic non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressants (e.g. cyclosporine, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, ABT-281, and ISAtx247), topical glucocorticosteroids (e.g.
  • clobetasol triamcinolone, betamethasone, hydrocortisone, halobetasol, diflorasone, mometasone, halcinonide, fluticasone), systemic glucocorticosteroids (e.g. prednisone, dexamethasone) antihistamines (e.g. hydroxyzine, loratadine, cetirizine, diphenhydramine, cyproheptadine, fexofenadine), and emollients, ointments, humectants, and lotions.
  • prednisone e.g. prednisone, dexamethasone
  • antihistamines e.g. hydroxyzine, loratadine, cetirizine, diphenhydramine, cyproheptadine, fexofenadine
  • emollients e.g. hydroxyzine
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of actinic keratosis.
  • hand dermatitis agents typically used to treat hand dermatitis may be used in the methods, composition, and kits of the invention.
  • Such agents include chemotherapeutic agents (e.g. 5-fluorouracil, imiquimod), non-steroid inflammatory agents (e.g. diclofenac), topical retinoids (e.g. adapalene), and photodynamic therapy using topical aminolevulinic acid.
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of basal cell carcinoma.
  • basal cell carcinoma agents typically used to treat basal cell carcinoma may be used in the methods, composition, and kits of the invention.
  • agents include chemotherapeutic agents (e.g. 5-fluorouracil, imiquimod).
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention are used for the treatment of chronic obstructive pulmonary disease (COPD).
  • COPD chronic obstructive pulmonary disease
  • agents typically used to treat COPD include xanthines (e.g., theophylline), anticholinergic compounds (e.g., ipratropium, tiotropium), biologics, small molecule immunomodulators, and beta receptor agonists/bronchodilators (e.g., ibuterol sulfate, bitolterol mesylate, epinephrine, formoterol fumarate, isoproteronol, levalbuterol hydrochloride, metaproterenol sulfate, pirbuterol acetate, salmeterol xinafoate, and terbutaline).
  • xanthines e.g., theophylline
  • anticholinergic compounds e.g., ipratropium
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of inflammatory bowel disease.
  • agents typically used to treat inflammatory bowel disease may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • agents include biologics (e.g., inflixamab, adelimumab, and CDP-870), small molecule immunomodulators (e.g., VX 702, SCIO 469, doramapimod, RO 30201195, SCIO 323, DPC 333, pranalcasan, mycophenolate, and merimepodib), non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressants (e.g., cyclosporine, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, ABT-281, and ISAtx247), 5-amino salicylic acid (e.g., mesalamine, sulfasalazine, balsalazide disodium, and olsalazine sodium), DMARDs (e.g.,
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of rheumatoid arthritis. If desired, one or more agents typically used to treat rheumatoid arthritis may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Such agents include NSAIDs (e.g., naproxen sodium, diclofenac sodium, diclofenac potassium, aspirin, sulindac, diflunisal, piroxicam, indomethacin, ibuprofen, nabumetone, choline magnesium trisalicylate, sodium salicylate, salicylsalicylic acid (salsalate), fenoprofen, flurbiprofen, ketoprofen, meclofenamate sodium, meloxicam, oxaprozin, sulindac, and tolmetin), COX-2 inhibitors (e.g., rofecoxib, celecoxib, valdecoxib, and lumiracoxib), biologics (e.g., inflixamab, adelimumab, etanercept, CDP-870, rituximab, and atlizumab), small molecule immunomodulators (e.g., VX
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of asthma.
  • agents typically used to treat asthma may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • agents include beta 2 agonists/bronchodilators/leukotriene modifiers (e.g., zafirlukast, montelukast, and zileuton), biologics (e.g., omalizumab), small molecule immunomodulators, anticholinergic compounds, xanthines, ephedrine, guaifenesin, cromolyn sodium, nedocromil sodium, and potassium iodide.
  • beta 2 agonists/bronchodilators/leukotriene modifiers e.g., zafirlukast, montelukast, and zileuton
  • biologics e.g., omalizumab
  • small molecule immunomodulators e.g., anticholinergic compounds,
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of osteoarthritis, or pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling associated therewith. If desired, one or more agents typically used to treat osteoarthritis may be used as a substitute for or in addition to a corticosteroid in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Such agents include NSAIDs (e.g., naproxen sodium, diclofenac sodium, diclofenac potassium, aspirin, sulindac, diflunisal, piroxicam, indomethacin, ibuprofen, nabumetone, choline magnesium trisalicylate, sodium salicylate, salicylsalicylic acid (salsalate), fenoprofen, flurbiprofen, ketoprofen, meclofenamate sodium, meloxicam, oxaprozin, sulindac, and tolmetin), COX-2 inhibitors (e.g., rofecoxib, celecoxib, valdecoxib, and lumiracoxib), biologics (e.g., inflixamab, adelimumab, etanercept, CDP-870, rituximab, and atlizumab), small molecule immunomodulators (e.g., VX
  • the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders.
  • the prophylactic and therapeutic medicament of the present invention may contain or may be used together with other appropriate pharmacologically effective substances, for example, dipivefrin (e.g., dipivefrin hydrochloride ophthalmic 0.1%), anti-VEGF therapies (e.g., pegaptanib (MACUGEN) ranibizumab, anecortave, and squalamine lactate), photodynamic therapy (e.g., VISUDYNE (verteporfin)), corticosteroids (e.g., dexamethasone, prednisolone), NSAIDs (e.g., diclofenac sodium, pranoprofen), antiallergic agents (e.g., tranilast, ketotifen fumarate, sodium cromoglicate), antihistamines (e.g., diphenhydramine hydroch
  • anti-VEGF therapies e
  • the compounds are administered within 14 days of each other, within 10 days of each other, within five days of each other, within twenty-four hours of each other, or simultaneously.
  • the compounds may be formulated together as a single composition, or may be formulated and administered separately.
  • One or both compounds may be administered in a low dosage or in a high dosage, each of which is defined herein.
  • NSAID e.g., naproxen sodium, diclofenac sodium, diclofenac potassium, aspirin, sulindac, diflunisal, piroxicam, indomethacin, ibuprofen, nabumetone, choline magnesium trisalicylate, sodium salicylate, salicylsalicylic acid, fenoprofen, flurbiprofen, ketoprofen, meclofenamate sodium, meloxicam, oxaprozin, sulindac, and tolmetin), COX-2 inhibitor (e.g., rofecoxib, celecoxib, valdecoxib, and lumiracoxib), glucocorticoid receptor modulator, or DMARD.
  • COX-2 inhibitor e.g., rofecoxib, celecoxib, valdecoxib, and lumiracoxib
  • glucocorticoid receptor modulator e.g.,
  • Combination therapies of the invention are especially useful for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders in combination with other agents—either biologics or small molecules—that modulate the immune response to positively affect disease.
  • agents include those that deplete key inflammatory cells, influence cell adhesion, or influence cytokines involved in immune response.
  • This last category includes both agents that mimic or increase the action of anti-inflammatory cytokines such as IL-10, as well as agents inhibit the activity of pro-inflammatory cytokines such as IL-6, IL-1, IL-2, IL-12, IL-15 or TNF ⁇ .
  • Agents that inhibit TNF ⁇ include etanercept, adelimumab, infliximab, and CDP-870.
  • the combination therapy reduces the production of cytokines, etanercept or infliximab act on the remaining fraction of inflammatory cytokines, providing enhanced treatment.
  • Small molecule immunodulators include, e.g., p38 MAP kinase inhibitors such as VX 702, SCIO 469, doramapimod, RO 30201195, SCIO 323, TACE inhibitors such as DPC 333, ICE inhibitors such as pranalcasan, and IMPDH inhibitors such as mycophenolate and merimepodib.
  • Treatment may be performed alone or in conjunction with another therapy and may be provided at home, the doctor's office, a clinic, a hospital's outpatient department, or a hospital. Treatment optionally begins at a hospital so that the doctor can observe the therapy's effects closely and make any adjustments that are needed, or it may begin on an outpatient basis.
  • the duration of the therapy depends on the type of disease or disorder being treated, the age and condition of the patient, the stage and type of the patient's disease, and how the patient responds to the treatment. Additionally, a person having a greater risk of developing an inflammatory disease (e.g., a person who is undergoing age-related hormonal changes) may receive treatment to inhibit or delay the onset of symptoms.
  • Routes of administration for the various embodiments include, but are not limited to, topical, transdermal, nasal, and systemic administration (such as, intravenous, intramuscular, subcutaneous, inhalation, rectal, buccal, vaginal, intraperitoneal, intraarticular, ophthalmic, otic, or oral administration).
  • systemic administration refers to all nondermal routes of administration, and specifically excludes topical and transdermal routes of administration.
  • each component of the combination can be controlled independently.
  • one compound may be administered three times per day, while the second compound may be administered once per day.
  • Combination therapy may be given in on-and-off cycles that include rest periods so that the patient's body has a chance to recover from any as yet unforeseen side effects.
  • the compounds may also be formulated together such that one administration delivers both compounds.
  • each compound of the combination may be formulated in a variety of ways that are known in the art.
  • the first and second agents may be formulated together or separately.
  • the first and second agents are formulated together for the simultaneous or near simultaneous administration of the agents.
  • Such co-formulated compositions can include the two drugs together in the same pill, ointment, cream, foam, capsule, liquid, etc.
  • the formulation technology employed is also useful for the formulation of the individual agents of the combination, as well as other combinations of the invention (e.g., a glucocorticoid receptor modulator in lieu of a corticosteroid combination).
  • the pharmacokinetic profiles for each agent can be suitably matched.
  • kits that contain, e.g., two pills, a pill and a powder, a suppository and a liquid in a vial, two topical creams, ointments, foams etc.
  • the kit can include optional components that aid in the administration of the unit dose to patients, such as vials for reconstituting powder forms, syringes for injection, customized IV delivery systems, inhalers, etc.
  • the unit dose kit can contain instructions for preparation and administration of the compositions.
  • the kit may be manufactured as a single use unit dose for one patient, multiple uses for a particular patient (at a constant dose or in which the individual compounds may vary in potency as therapy progresses); or the kit may contain multiple doses suitable for administration to multiple patients (“bulk packaging”).
  • the kit components may be assembled in cartons, blister packs, bottles, tubes, and the like.
  • the combinations of the invention are, desirably, formulated for topical administration.
  • Topical formulations which can be used with the combinations of the invention include, without limitation, creams, foams, lotions, gels, sticks, sprays, solutions (e.g., for soaking, as with a bath salt), and ointments.
  • any conventional pharmacologically and cosmetically acceptable vehicles may be used.
  • the compounds may also be administered in liposomal formulations that allow compounds to enter the skin.
  • liposomal formulations are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,169,637; 5,000,958; 5,049,388; 4,975,282; 5,194,266; 5,023,087; 5,688,525; 5,874,104; 5,409,704; 5,552,155; 5,356,633; 5,032,582; 4,994,213; and PCT Publication No. WO 96/40061.
  • Examples of other appropriate vehicles are described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,877,805 and EP Publication No. 0586106A1.
  • Suitable vehicles of the invention may also include mineral oil, petrolatum, polydecene, stearic acid, isopropyl myristate, polyoxyl 40 stearate, stearyl alcohol, or vegetable oil.
  • the formulations can include various conventional colorants, fragrances, thickeners (e.g., xanthan gum), preservatives, emollients (e.g., hydrocarbon oils, waxes, or silicones), demulcents, solubilizing excipients, dispersants, penetration enhancers, plasticizing agents, preservatives, stabilizers, demulsifiers, wetting agents, emulsifiers, moisturizers, astringents, deodorants, and the like can be added to provide additional benefits and improve the feel and/or appearance of the topical preparation.
  • emollients e.g., hydrocarbon oils, waxes, or silicones
  • demulcents solubilizing excipients
  • dispersants e.g., hydrocarbon oils, waxes, or silicones
  • demulcents solubilizing excipients
  • dispersants e.g., hydrocarbon oils, waxes, or silicones
  • demulcents solubil
  • one or more solubilizing excipients may be a necessary component in the topical formulations.
  • Solubilization is taken to mean an improvement in the solubility by virtue of surface-active compounds that can convert substances that are insoluble or virtually insoluble in water into clear, or opalescent, aqueous solutions without changing the chemical structure of these substances in the process.
  • solubilizates formed are notable for the fact that the substance is present in dissolved form in the molecular associations, micelles, of the surface-active compounds, which form in aqueous solution.
  • the resulting solutions appear optically clear to opalescent.
  • Solubilizing excipients that may be used in the formulations of the invention include, without limitation, compounds belonging to the following classes: polyethoxylated fatty acids, PEG-fatty acid diesters, PEG-fatty acid mono-ester and di-ester mixtures, polyethylene glycol glycerol fatty acid esters, alcohol-oil transesterification products, polyglycerized fatty acids, propylene glycol fatty acid esters, mixtures of propylene glycol esters and glycerol esters, mono- and diglycerides, sterol and sterol derivatives, polyethylene glycol sorbitan fatty acid esters, polyethylene glycol alkyl ethers, sugar esters, polyethylene glycol alkyl phenols, polyoxyethylene-polyoxypropylene block copolymers, sorbitan fatty acid esters, lower alcohol fatty acid esters, ionic surfactants, tocopherol esters, and sterol esters.
  • Ophthalmic formulations include but are not limited to ocular injections such as intravitreal, subtenons, subconjunctival, periocular, retrobulbar injections; topical ophthalmic aqueous solutions, such as suspensions, ointments, and gels; intraocular biodegradable and non-biodegradable implants; implants that are inserted through incisions made in the eye wall or sutured around the globe of the eye; tack for intraocular drug delivery; and bioadhesive ophthalmic inserts.
  • ocular injections such as intravitreal, subtenons, subconjunctival, periocular, retrobulbar injections
  • topical ophthalmic aqueous solutions such as suspensions, ointments, and gels
  • intraocular biodegradable and non-biodegradable implants implants that are inserted through incisions made in the eye wall or sutured around the globe of the eye
  • tack for intraocular drug delivery and bioa
  • novel formulations of this invention may take the form of solutions, gels, ointments, suspensions or solid inserts, formulated so that a unit dosage comprises a therapeutically effective amount of each active component or some submultiple thereof.
  • Typical opthalmologically acceptable carriers for the novel formulations are, for example, water, mixtures of water and water-miscible solvents such as lower alkanols or aralkanols, vegetable oils, polyalkylene glycols, petroleum based jelly, ethyl cellulose, ethyl oleate, carboxymethylcellulose, polyvinylpyrrolidone, isopropyl myristate and other conventionally employed acceptable carriers.
  • the pharmaceutical preparation may also contain non-toxic auxiliary substances such as emulsifying, preserving, wetting agents, bodying agents and the like, as for example, polyethylene glycols 200, 300, 400 and 600, carbowaxes 1,000, 1,500, 4,000, 6,000 and 10,000, antibacterial components such as quaternary ammonium compounds, phenylmercuric salts known to have cold sterilizing properties and which are non-injurious in use, thimerosal, benzalkonium chloride, methyl and propyl paraben, benzyldodecinium bromide, benzyl alcohol, phenylethanol, buffering ingredients such as sodium chloride, sodium borate, sodium acetate, or gluconate buffers, and other conventional ingredients such as sorbitan monolaurate, triethanolamine, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monopalmitylate, dioctyl sodium sulfosuccinate, monothioglycerol, thiosorbitol, ethylenediamine
  • the formulation may also include a gum such as gellan gum at a concentration of 0.1 to 2% by weight so that the aqueous eyedrops gel on contact with the eye, thus providing the advantages of a solid ophthalmic insert as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,861,760.
  • a gum such as gellan gum at a concentration of 0.1 to 2% by weight so that the aqueous eyedrops gel on contact with the eye, thus providing the advantages of a solid ophthalmic insert as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,861,760.
  • the pharmaceutical preparation may also be in the form of a solid insert such as one which after dispensing the drug remains essentially intact as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,256,108; 4,160,452; and 4,265,874; or a bio-erodible insert that either is soluble in lacrimal fluids, or otherwise disintegrates as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,287,175 or EPO publication 0077261.
  • kits of the invention contain a corticosteroid and/or an NsIDI. These compounds can be provided in the kit as separate compositions, or combined into a single composition.
  • the kits of the invention can also contain instructions for the administration of both the corticosteroid and NsIDI.
  • Kits of the invention can also contain instructions for administering an additional pharmacologically acceptable substance (e.g., dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents) with a corticosteroid and/or an NsIDI.
  • an additional pharmacologically acceptable substance e.g., dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents.
  • This kit may contain any combination of the corticosteroid, NsIDI, and additional pharmaceutically acceptable substance (i.e., any one, two, or three of the above compounds).
  • each compound of the claimed combinations depends on several factors, including: the administration method, the disease to be treated, the severity of the disease, whether the disease is to be treated or prevented, and the age, weight, and health of the person to be treated. Additionally, pharmacogenomic (the effect of genotype on the pharmacokinetic, pharmacodynamic or efficacy profile of a therapeutic) information about a particular patient may affect dosage used.
  • a therapeutic regimen may require cycles, during which time a drug is not administered, or therapy may be provided on an as needed basis during periods of acute inflammation.
  • the compound in question may be administered orally in the form of tablets, capsules, elixirs or syrups, or rectally in the form of suppositories.
  • the compound may also be administered topically in the form of foams, lotions, drops, creams, ointments, emollients, or gels.
  • Parenteral administration of a compound is suitably performed, for example, in the form of saline solutions or with the compound incorporated into liposomes.
  • a solubilizer such as ethanol can be applied.
  • the drugs used in any of the combinations described herein may be covalently attached to one another to form a conjugate of formula (VII).
  • (A)-(L)-(B) (VII)
  • (A) is a “Drug 1” listed on Table 1A or Table 1B covalently tethered via a linker (L) to (B), the corresponding “Drug 2” listed on Table 1A or Table 1B.
  • Conjugates of the invention can be administered to a subject by any route and for the treatment of any disease described herein.
  • the conjugates of the invention can be prodrugs, releasing drug (A) and drug (B) upon, for example, cleavage of the conjugate by intracellular and extracellular enzymes (e.g., amidases, esterases, and phosphatases).
  • the conjugates of the invention can also be designed to largely remain intact in vivo, resisting cleavage by intracellular and extracellular enzymes. The degradation of the conjugate in vivo can be controlled by the design of linker (L) and the covalent bonds formed with drug (A) and drug (B) during the synthesis of the conjugate.
  • Conjugates can be prepared using techniques familiar to those skilled in the art.
  • the conjugates can be prepared using the methods disclosed in G. Hermanson, Bioconjugate Techniques, Academic Press, Inc., 1996.
  • the synthesis of conjugates may involve the selective protection and deprotection of alcohols, amines, ketones, sulthydryls or carboxyl functional groups of drug (A), the linker, and/or drug (B).
  • commonly used protecting groups for amines include carbamates, such as tert-butyl, benzyl, 2,2,2-trichloroethyl, 2-trimethylsilylethyl, 9-fluorenylmethyl, allyl, and m-nitrophenyl.
  • amides such as formamides, acetamides, trifluoroacetamides, sulfonamides, trifluoromethanesulfonyl amides, trimethylsilylethanesulfonamides, and tert-butylsulfonyl amides.
  • protecting groups for carboxyls include esters, such as methyl, ethyl, tert-butyl, 9-fluorenylmethyl, 2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy methyl, benzyl, diphenylmethyl, O-nitrobenzyl, ortho-esters, and halo-esters.
  • Examples of commonly used protecting groups for alcohols include ethers, such as methyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethoxymethyl, methylthiomethyl, benzyloxymethyl, tetrahydropyranyl, ethoxyethyl, benzyl, 2-napthylmethyl, O-nitrobenzyl, P-nitrobenzyl, P-methoxybenzyl, 9-phenylxanthyl, trityl (including methoxy-trityls), and silyl ethers.
  • Examples of commonly used protecting groups for sulfhydryls include many of the same protecting groups used for hydroxyls.
  • sulhydryls can be protected in a reduced form (e.g., as disulfides) or an oxidized form (e.g., as sulfonic acids, sulfonic esters, or sulfonic amides).
  • Protecting groups can be chosen such that selective conditions (e.g., acidic conditions, basic conditions, catalysis by a nucleophile, catalysis by a lewis acid, or hydrogenation) are required to remove each, exclusive of other protecting groups in a molecule.
  • the conditions required for the addition of protecting groups to amine, alcohol, sulthydryl, and carboxyl functionalities and the conditions required for their removal are provided in detail in T. W. Green and P. G. M. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis (2 nd Ed.), John Wiley & Sons, 1991 and P. J. Kocienski, Protecting Groups, Georg Thieme Verlag, 1994. Additional synthetic details are provided below.
  • the linker component of the invention is, at its simplest, a bond between drug (A) and drug (B), but typically provides a linear, cyclic, or branched molecular skeleton having pendant groups covalently linking drug (A) to drug (B).
  • linking of drug (A) to drug (B) is achieved by covalent means, involving bond formation with one or more functional groups located on drug (A) and drug (B).
  • Examples of chemically reactive functional groups which may be employed for this purpose include, without limitation, amino, hydroxyl, sulfhydryl, carboxyl, carbonyl, carbohydrate groups, vicinal diols, thioethers, 2-aminoalcohols, 2-aminothiols, guanidinyl, imidazolyl, and phenolic groups.
  • the covalent linking of drug (A) and drug (B) may be effected using a linker which contains reactive moieties capable of reaction with such functional groups present in drug (A) and drug (B).
  • a linker which contains reactive moieties capable of reaction with such functional groups present in drug (A) and drug (B).
  • an amine group of drug (A) may react with a carboxyl group of the linker, or an activated derivative thereof, resulting in the formation of an amide linking the two.
  • N-Maleimide derivatives are also considered selective towards sulfhydryl groups, but may additionally be useful in coupling to amino groups under certain conditions.
  • Reagents such as 2-iminothiolane (Traut et al., Biochemistry 12:3266 (1973)), which introduce a thiol group through conversion of an amino group, may be considered as sulfhydryl reagents if linking occurs through the formation of disulphide bridges.
  • reactive moieties capable of reaction with amino groups include, for example, alkylating and acylating agents.
  • Representative alkylating agents include:
  • N-maleimide derivatives which may react with amino groups either through a Michael type reaction or through acylation by addition to the ring carbonyl group, for example, as described by Smyth et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 82:4600 (1960) and Biochem. J. 91:589 (1964);
  • epoxide derivatives such as epichlorohydrin and bisoxiranes, which may react with amino, sulfhydryl, or phenolic hydroxyl groups;
  • Representative amino-reactive acylating agents include:
  • active esters such as nitrophenylesters or N-hydroxysuccinimidyl esters
  • acylazides e.g. wherein the azide group is generated from a preformed hydrazide derivative using sodium nitrite, as described by Wetz et al., Anal. Biochem. 58:347 (1974); and
  • Aldehydes and ketones may be reacted with amines to form Schiff's bases, which may advantageously be stabilized through reductive amination.
  • Alkoxylamino moieties readily react with ketones and aldehydes to produce stable alkoxamines, for example, as described by Webb et al., in Bioconjugate Chem. 1:96 (1990).
  • reactive moieties capable of reaction with carboxyl groups include diazo compounds such as diazoacetate esters and diazoacetamides, which react with high specificity to generate ester groups, for example, as described by Herriot, Adv. Protein Chem. 3:169 (1947).
  • Carboxyl modifying reagents such as carbodiimides, which react through O-acylurea formation followed by amide bond formation, may also be employed.
  • functional groups in drug (A) and/or drug (B) may, if desired, be converted to other functional groups prior to reaction, for example, to confer additional reactivity or selectivity.
  • methods useful for this purpose include conversion of amines to carboxyls using reagents such as dicarboxylic anhydrides; conversion of amines to thiols using reagents such as N-acetylhomocysteine thiolactone, S-acetylmercaptosuccinic anhydride, 2-iminothiolane, or thiol-containing succinimidyl derivatives; conversion of thiols to carboxyls using reagents such as ⁇ -haloacetates; conversion of thiols to amines using reagents such as ethylenimine or 2-bromoethylamine; conversion of carboxyls to amines using reagents such as carbodiimides followed by diamines; and conversion of alcohols to
  • So-called zero-length linkers involving direct covalent joining of a reactive chemical group of drug (A) with a reactive chemical group of drug (B) without introducing additional linking material may, if desired, be used in accordance with the invention.
  • the linker will include two or more reactive moieties, as described above, connected by a spacer element.
  • the presence of such a spacer permits bifunctional linkers to react with specific functional groups within drug (A) and drug (B), resulting in a covalent linkage between the two.
  • the reactive moieties in a linker may be the same (homobifunctional linker) or different (heterobifunctional linker, or, where several dissimilar reactive moieties are present, heteromultifunctional linker), providing a diversity of potential reagents that may bring about covalent attachment between drug (A) and drug (B).
  • Spacer elements in the linker typically consist of linear or branched chains and may include a C 1-10 alkyl, C 2-10 alkenyl, C 2-10 alkynyl, C 2-6 heterocyclyl, C 6-12 aryl, C 7-14 alkaryl, C 3-10 alkheterocyclyl, or C 1-10 heteroalkyl.
  • the linker is described by formula (VIII): G 1 -(Z 1 ) o -(Y 1 ) u -(Z 2 ) s -(R 30 )-(Z 3 ) t -(Y 2 ) v -(Z 4 ) p -G 2 (VIII)
  • G 1 is a bond between drug (A) and the linker;
  • G 2 is a bond between the linker and drug (B);
  • Z 1 , Z 2 , Z 3 , and Z 4 each, independently, is selected from O, S, and NR 31 ;
  • R 31 is hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, C 2-4 alkenyl, C 2-4 alkynyl, C 2-6 heterocyclyl, C 6-12 aryl, C 7-14 alkaryl, C 3-10 alkheterocyclyl, or C 1-7 heteroalkyl;
  • Y 1 and Y 2 are each, independently, selected from carbonyl, thiocarbonyl, sulphonyl, or phosphoryl;
  • o, p, s, t, u, and v are each, independently, 0 or 1;
  • R 30 is a C 1-10 alkyl, C 2-10 alkenyl, C 2-10 alkynyl, C 2-6 heterocyclyl, C 6-12 ary
  • homobifunctional linkers useful in the preparation of conjugates of the invention include, without limitation, diamines and diols selected from ethylenediamine, propylenediamine and hexamethylenediamine, ethylene glycol, diethylene glycol, propylene glycol, 1,4-butanediol, 1,6-hexanediol, cyclohexanediol, and polycaprolactone diol.
  • the compounds of the invention can be employed in immunomodulatory or mechanistic assays to determine whether other combinations, or single agents, are as effective as the combination in inhibiting secretion or production of proinflammatory cytokines or modulating immune response using assays generally known in the art, examples of which are described herein. After a suitable time, the cells are examined for cytokine secretion or production or other suitable immune response. The relative effects of the combinations versus each other, and versus the single agents are compared, and effective compounds and combinations are identified.
  • the combinations of the invention are also useful tools in elucidating mechanistic information about the biological pathways involved in inflammation. Such information can lead to the development of new combinations or single agents for inhibiting inflammation caused by proinflammatory cytokines.
  • Methods known in the art to determine biological pathways can be used to determine the pathway, or network of pathways affected by contacting cells stimulated to produce proinflammatory cytokines with the compounds of the invention. Such methods can include, analyzing cellular constituents that are expressed or repressed after contact with the compounds of the invention as compared to untreated, positive or negative control compounds, and/or new single agents and combinations, or analyzing some other metabolic activity of the cell such as enzyme activity, nutrient uptake, and proliferation.
  • Cellular components analyzed can include gene transcripts, and protein expression.
  • Suitable methods can include standard biochemistry techniques, radiolabeling the compounds of the invention (e.g., 14 C or 3 H labeling), and observing the compounds binding to proteins, e.g. using 2d gels, gene expression profiling. Once identified, such compounds can be used in in vivo models to further validate the tool or develop new anti-inflammatory agents.
  • a 100 ⁇ l suspension of diluted human white blood cells contained within each well of a polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc) was stimulated to secrete TNF ⁇ by treatment with a final concentration of 2 ⁇ g/mL lipopolysaccharide (Sigma L-4130).
  • Various concentrations of each test compound were added at the time of stimulation.
  • the plate was centrifuged and the supernatant transferred to a white opaque polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc, Maxisorb) coated with an anti-TNF ⁇ antibody (PharMingen, #551220).
  • a 100 ⁇ l suspension of diluted human white blood cells contained within each well of a polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc) was stimulated to secrete TNF ⁇ by treatment with a final concentration of 10 ng/mL phorbol 12-myristate 13-acetate (Sigma, P-1585) and 750 ng/mL ionomycin (Sigma, I-0634).
  • Various concentrations of each test compound were added at the time of stimulation. After 16-18 hours of incubation at 37° C.
  • a 100 ⁇ L suspension of diluted human white blood cells contained within each well of a polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc) was stimulated to secrete IFN ⁇ by treatment with a final concentration of 10 ng/mL phorbol 12-myristate 13-acetate (Sigma, P-1585) and 750 ng/mL ionomycin (Sigma, I-0634).
  • Various concentrations of each test compound were added at the time of stimulation. After 16-18 hours of incubation at 37° C.
  • the plate washed (Tecan PowerWasher 384) with phosphate buffered saline (PBS) containing 0.1% Tween 20 (polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurate) and incubated for an additional one hour with another anti-IFN ⁇ antibody that was biotin labeled (Endogen, M701B) and horseradish peroxidase (HRP) coupled to strepavidin (PharMingen, #13047E). After the plate washed with 0.1% Tween 20/PBS, an HRP-luminescent substrate was added to each well and light intensity measured using a LJL Analyst plate luminometer.
  • PBS phosphate buffered saline
  • Tween 20 polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurate
  • HRP-luminescent substrate was added to each well and light intensity measured using a LJL Analyst plate luminometer.
  • a 100 ⁇ L suspension of diluted human white blood cells contained within each well of a polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc) was stimulated to secrete IL-2 by treatment with a final concentration of 10 ng/mL phorbol 12-myristate 13-acetate (Sigma, P-1585) and 750 ng/mL ionomycin (Sigma, I-0634).
  • Various concentrations of each test compound were added at the time of stimulation. After 16-18 hours of incubation at 37° C.
  • the plate was centrifuged and the supernatant transferred to a white opaque polystyrene 384 well plate (NalgeNunc, Maxisorb) coated with an anti-IL-2 antibody (PharMingen, #555051). After a two-hour incubation, the plate washed (Tecan PowerWasher 384) with PBS containing 0.1% Tween 20 and incubated for an additional one hour with another anti-IL-2 antibody that was biotin labeled (Endogen, M600B) and HRP coupled to strepavidin (PharMingen, #13047E). After the plate washed with 0.1% Tween 20/PBS, an HRP-luminescent substrate was added to each well and light intensity measured using a LJL Analyst plate luminometer.
  • test compound combinations on TNF ⁇ secretion were assayed in white blood cells from human buffy coat stimulated with phorbol 12-myistate 13-acetate as follows.
  • Human white blood cells from buffy coat were diluted 1:50 in media (RPMI; Gibco BRL, #11875-085), 10% fetal bovine serum (Gibco BRL, #25140-097), 2% penicillin/streptomycin (Gibco BRL, #15140-122)) and 50 ⁇ L of the diluted white blood cells was placed in each well of the assay plate. Drugs were added to the indicated concentration. After 16-18 hours of incubation at 37° C.
  • the average untreated well value (avg. untreated wells) is the arithmetic mean of 40 wells from the same assay plate treated with vehicle alone. Negative inhibition values result from local variations in treated wells as compared to untreated wells.
  • the final single agent plates were generated by transferring 1 ⁇ L of stock solution from the specific master plate to a dilution plate containing 100 ⁇ L of media (RPMI; Gibco BRL, #11875-085), 10% fetal bovine serum (Gibco BRL, #25140-097), 2% Penicillin/Streptomycin (Gibco BRL, #15140-122)) using the Packard Mini-Trak liquid handler.
  • This dilution plate was then mixed and a 5 mL aliquot transferred to the final assay plate, which had been pre-filled with 50 mL/well RPMI media containing the appropriate stimulant to activate IFN ⁇ , IL-2, or TNF ⁇ secretion.

Abstract

The invention features methods, compositions, and kits for treating an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.

Description

    CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • This application claims benefit of U.S. Provisional Application No. 60/735,989, filed Nov. 9, 2005, which is hereby incorporated by reference.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • The invention relates to the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders and ophthalmic disorders.
  • Immunoinflammatory disorders are characterized by the inappropriate activation of the body's immune defenses. Rather than targeting infectious invaders, the immune response targets and damages the body's own tissues or transplanted tissues. The tissue targeted by the immune system varies with the disorder. For example, in multiple sclerosis, the immune response is directed against the neuronal tissue, while in Crohn's disease the digestive tract is targeted. Immunoinflammatory disorders affect millions of individuals and include conditions such as asthma, allergic intraocular inflammatory diseases, arthritis, atopic dermatitis, atopic eczema, diabetes, hemolytic anaemia, inflammatory dermatoses, inflammatory bowel or gastrointestinal disorders (e.g., Crohn's disease and ulcerative colitis), multiple sclerosis, myasthenia gravis, pruritis/inflammation, psoriasis, rheumatoid arthritis, cirrhosis, and systemic lupus erythematosus.
  • Current treatment regimens for immunoinflammatory disorders typically rely on immunosuppressive agents. The effectiveness of these agents can vary and their use is often accompanied by adverse side effects. Thus, improved therapeutic agents and methods for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders are needed.
  • Musculoskeletal disorders such as arthritis are among the most frequent causes of physical disability among older adults. The three most common types of arthritis are osteoarthritis (OA), rheumatoid arthritis (RA), and gout. Osteoarthritis is the most common joint disease, with radiological evidence of its existence found in 50% of the population.
  • OA affects the hands, lower back, neck, and weight-bearing joints such as the knees, hips, and foot joints. The yearly incidence of OA of the hand is about 50 new cases per 1,000 for persons under age 40, rising to 65 per 1,000 for ages 40-59 and 110 per 1000 for ages 60 and greater.
  • OA has been characterized as a slowly evolving degenerative disease with a multifactorial etiology that may differ depending on the joint site. OA occurs when cartilage, the tissue that cushions the ends of the bones within the joints, begins to break down and wear away. In some cases, all of the cartilage may wear away, leaving bones that rub against each other. Arthroscopic studies of early disease have shown synovitis in approximately half of those joints with cartilage damage, suggesting a localized inflammatory reaction in patients with early OA. Furthermore, numerous studies have identified an association between C-reactive protein (CRP) and OA. CRP is an acute phase response protein whose production is stimulated by cytokines, particularly interleukin-6 (IL-6). The relationship between inflammatory processes and elevation in plasma CRP and pro-inflammatory cytokines is well known. CRP has also been related to the inflammatory activity of rheumatoid arthritis.
  • Symptoms of OA range from stiffness and intermittent mild pain to severe joint pain and impaired biomechanical function. Although there is no cure for most forms of OA, various therapies can help patients manage symptoms and improve their overall quality of life. Symptomatic treatment of OA traditionally involves administration of non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs (NSAIDs), local analgesic therapies, intra-articular corticosteroid injection, and surgery.
  • Treatment of OA with NSAIDs such as indomethacin, ketoprofen, ibuprofen, acetylsalicylic acid (ASA), and flurbiprofen can relieve pain by reducing local inflammation and attenuating levels of proinflammatory agents. However, long-term NSAID use is compromised by significant gastrointestinal (GI) toxicity. A large multi-center, prospective, observational study involving 1,921 patients with rheumatoid arthritis taking NSAIDs reported that 81% of patients who were hospitalized with serious GI complications had no prior GI problems. This makes it difficult for clinicians to identify patients at risk for GI side-effects. In the United States, it has been conservatively estimated that there are 107,000 annual hospitalizations for NSAID-related GI complications and 16,500 annual NSAID-related deaths among patients with RA or OA. This mortality figure is almost as high as the number of deaths due to asthma, cervical cancer and malignant melanoma combined.
  • Steroids are known powerful anti-inflammatory agents that have been used in treating OA. However, chronic administration of anti-inflammatory doses of steroids is also limited by well-known toxicities. For example, prolonged use of steroids has been associated with osteoporosis, high blood pressure, neurological complications, suboptimal immune response, and ocular disturbances, limiting their utility in therapeutic situations. A therapeutic agent that, for example, retained the potent anti-inflammatory effects of steroids, or the therapeutic effects of another class of drugs, while limiting the associated toxicities, would be of great benefit to patients with OA or other musculoskeletal disorders.
  • Periodontal disease refers to diseases of tissues that surround and support teeth, including the gingiva, cementum, periodontal ligament, alveolar process bone, and dental supporting bone. The most common forms of periodontal disease are periodontitis and gingivitis.
  • Periodontal disease involves the inflammation, destruction and degeneration of periodontal tissues that surround and support mammalian teeth. These periodontal tissues include the crevicular epithelium, junctional epithelium, external marginal epithelium, gingiva, alveolar bone, periodontal ligament, and cementum. The loss of supporting bone in periodontitis is the latest stage of this progressive disorder and is the major cause of tooth loss in adults.
  • Periodontal disease is typically classified as gingivitis and periodontitis according to the progress of disease. “Gingivitis” refers to a condition in which inflammation is localized within the gingiva and no lesion occurs in the bone and periodontal ligament, and a pocket is relative pocket. “Periodontitis” refers to a condition in which the inflammation of gingiva reaches the periodontal ligament and alveolar bone, the pocket becomes a periodontal pocket, and the attachment level (the position of attachment) is on the root apex side downward from the cementum-enamel junction. The inflammation prolongs and proceeds toward deep parts with a deepening periodontal pocket.
  • The relationship between inflammatory processes and elevation in plasma C-reactive protein (CRP) and proinflammatory cytokines is well known, and this relationship is observed in periodontitis. In atherosclerotic heart disease where elevated plasma CRP levels are a known risk factor, a correlation with the incidence of periodontitis has also been reported. As such, agents that can modify levels of inflammation in periodontitis would be expected to be active across such inflammatory diseases. Indeed, treatment of periodontitis with NSAIDs such as indomethacin, ketoprofen, ibuprofen, ASA and flurbiprofen, can reduce local inflammation and attenuate levels of pro-inflammatory agents. However, there have been no reports on the use of corticosteroids to treat periodontitis, perhaps because chronic administration of antiinflammatory doses of steroids is limited by well known toxicities. An agent that could provide the anti-inflammatory effect of steroids without the associated toxicity is desirable for the treatment of periodontal disease. Such an agent would also be useful for reducing the level of serum CRP and, consequently, for treating diseases and conditions associated with an elevated serum CRP level.
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • The invention features compositions, methods, and kits for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders and ophthalmic disorders.
  • In one aspect, the invention features a composition that includes a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A and Table 3. Desirably, one or both drugs are present in amounts that together are sufficient to treat an immunoinflammatory disorder, ophthalmic disorder, or musculoskeletal disorder, or pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling associated therewith in a patient in need thereof. Exemplary drug pairs are: antihistamine and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; antihistamine and SSRI; antihistamine and tricyclic compound; antinfective and anticoccidial compound; corticosteroid and antihistamine; corticosteroid and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; corticosteroid and prostaglandin; NsIDI and alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonist; NsIDI and antihistamine; NsIDI and NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic; NsIDI and prostaglandin; NsIDI and sympathomimetic; prostaglandin and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; prostaglandin and tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine; sympathomimetic and NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic; sympathomimetic and prostaglandin; sympathomimetic and tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine; sympathomimetic and tricyclic compound; tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine and SSRI; tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine and tricyclic compound; and tricyclic compound and calcium channel blocker.
  • One or both drugs in said pair may be present in the composition in a low dosage or in a high dosage. In certain embodiments, the composition is formulated for topical or systemic administration. In one embodiment, the composition is formulated for ophthalmic administration.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a method for treating a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder by administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3. Desirably, the first and second drug of said drug pair are administered simultaneously or within 14 days of each other and in amounts that together are sufficient to treat the patient. Optionally, the patient may also be administered one or more additional drugs (e.g., an NSAID, corticosteroid, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor agonist, bronchodilator, NsIDI, vitamin D analog, psoralen, retinoid, or 5-amino salicylic acid).
  • In a related aspect, the invention features a method of modulating an immune response (e.g., by decreasing proinflammatory cytokine secretion or production, or by modulating adhesion, gene expression, chemokine secretion, presentation of MHC complex, presentation of costimulation signals, or cell surface expression of other mediators) in a patient by administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A simultaneously or within 14 days of each other in amounts sufficient to modulate the immune response in the patient.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a method for treating a patient diagnosed with an ophthalmic disorder by administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3. Desirably, the first and second drug of said drug pair are administered simultaneously or within 14 days of each other in amounts that together are sufficient to treat the patient. Optionally, the patient may also be administered one or more additional drugs (e.g., an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, or antimycotic agent) or receive photodynamic therapy.
  • In any of the foregoing methods one or both drugs in said pair are administered in a low dosage or in a high dosage. The drugs may be administered within 10 days of each other, within five days of each other, within twenty-four hours of each other, or simultaneously.
  • In a related aspect, the invention features a method for treating an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level in a patient in need thereof by concomitantly administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A in amounts that together are more effective in treating the immunoinflammatory disorder than the administration of either drug alone.
  • In still another related aspect, the invention features a method for treating an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level in a patient in need thereof by administering a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A to the patient; wherein: (i) the two drugs are concomitantly administered and (ii) the respective amounts of the two drugs administered to the patient are more effective in treating the immunoinflammatory disorder compared to the administration of the either drug alone.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a composition that includes (i) drug listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) a second compound selected from the group consisting of an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, antimycotic agent, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor agonist, bronchodilator, NsIDI, vitamin D analog, psoralen, retinoid, or 5-amino salicylic acid.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a kit having (i) a composition that includes a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) instructions for administering the composition to a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
  • In a related aspect, the invention features a kit having (i) a first drug from a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3; (ii) a second drug from the same drug pair; and (iii) instructions for administering said the two drugs to a patient diagnosed an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
  • In another related aspect, the invention features a kit having (i) a first drug from a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) instructions for administering this drug and a second drug from the same drug pair to a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
  • In yet another related aspect, the invention features a kit having (i) a first drug listed on Table 1A or Table 3; (ii) a second drug selected from an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, antimycotic agent, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor agonist, bronchodilator, NsIDI, vitamin D analog, psoralen, retinoid, or 5-amino salicylic acid; and (iii) instructions for administering said first drug and said second drug to a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
  • In another related aspect, the invention features a kit having (i) a first drug listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) instructions for administering this first drug and a second drug selected from an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, antimycotic agent, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor agonist, bronchodilator, NsIDI, vitamin D analog, psoralen, retinoid, or 5-amino salicylic acid to a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder or an ophthalmic disorder.
  • The invention also features methods, compositions, and kits for treating a musculoskeletal disorder, or pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling associated with a musculoskeletal disorder, in a patient by administering to the patient in need thereof a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A, optionally in combination with any of a number of companion compounds, including a corticosteroid, a non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drug (NSAID) (e.g., naproxen sodium, diclofenac sodium, diclofenac potassium, aspirin, sulindac, diflunisal, piroxicam, indomethacin, ibuprofen, nabumetone, choline magnesium trisalicylate, sodium salicylate, salicylsalicylic acid, fenoprofen, flurbiprofen, ketoprofen, meclofenamate sodium, meloxicam, oxaprozin, sulindac, or tolmetin), a COX-2 inhibitor (e.g., rofecoxib, celecoxib, valdecoxib, or lumiracoxib), a biologic (e.g., adelimumab, etanercept, or infliximab), a small molecule immunomodulator (e.g., VX 702, SCIO 469, doramapimod, RO 30201195, SCIO 323, DPC 333, pranalcasan, mycophenolate, or merimepodib), a disease-modifying anti-rheumatic drug (DMARD) (e.g., methotrexate or leflunomide), a xanthine (e.g., theophylline), a non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant (NsIDI) (e.g., cyclosporine, tacrolimus, ascomycin, pimecrolimus, rapamycin, or everolimus), a vitamin D analog (e.g., calcipotriene or calcipotriol), a psoralen (e.g., methoxsalen), a retinoid (e.g., acitretin or tazoretene), 5-amino salicylic acid (e.g., mesalamine, sulfasalazine, balsalazide disodium, or olsalazine sodium), hydroxychloroquine sulfate, penicillamine, or an analog of any thereof, as described herein.
  • Accordingly, the invention features, in one instance, a method for treating pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling associated with a musculoskeletal disorder, e.g., osteoarthritis, by administering to a patient diagnosed with or at risk of developing such pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A, such that the two drugs are administered simultaneously or within fourteen days, ten days, five days, or even 24 hours of each other in amounts sufficient to treat the patient. Desirably, the patient experiences a reduction in pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling subsequent to treatment, e.g., within fifty days of treatment. The reduction in pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling can be measured using any method known in the art, e.g., a 10 cm visual analog scale, a Likert scale, the Lequesne index, or the WOMAC index. For example, an AUSCAN index that utilizes a 10 cm visual analog scale may be used.
  • The invention also features a method for treating a musculoskeletal disorder, e.g., osteoarthritis, by administering to a patient diagnosed with or at risk of developing such a disorder a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A, such that the two drugs are administered simultaneously or within fourteen days, ten days, five days, or even 24 hours of each other in amounts sufficient to treat the patient.
  • In any of the foregoing instances, the two drugs may be administered in the same or different pharmaceutical formulations. Compounds used in the methods of the invention may be formulated for, e.g., topical or systemic administration, and may be formulated in high, moderate, or low dosages.
  • In addition, a third drug, e.g., a corticosteroid, an NSAID, a COX-2 inhibitor, a biologic, a small molecule immunomodulator, a DMARD, a xanthine, an NsIDI, a vitamin D analog, a psoralen, a retinoid, 5-amino salicylic acid, hydroxychloroquine sulfate, or penicillamine may be administered to the patient such that the first drug, the second drug, and the third drug are administered simultaneously or within fourteen days, ten days, five days, or even 24 hours of each other in amounts sufficient to treat the patient.
  • In other embodiments, the drugs of the drug combination of Table 1A or Table 3 are the only two active ingredients (although excipients will generally also be present).
  • In another aspect, the invention features a method of treating an ophthalmic disorder in a patient by administering to the patient a corticosteroid and a non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant (NsIDI). In this aspect of the invention, the corticosteroid and/or the NsIDI can be administered at a low concentration. Desirably, the concentration of the NsIDI does not cause eye irritation, such as burning, and the compositions of the invention are administered in an amount sufficient to alleviate the symptoms of the ophthalmic disorder. Also desirably, the concentration of the corticosteroid does not cause steroid toxicity.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a method of treating an ophthalmic disorder in a patient by administering to the patient a substance selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents in combination with a corticosteroid and/or an NsIDI. In this aspect of the invention, the corticosteroid and/or the NsIDI can be administered at a low concentration.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a composition (e.g., a solution, gel, ointment, suspension, emulsion, or solid insert) including a corticosteroid and a NsIDI. In this aspect of the invention, the corticosteroid and/or the NsIDI can be administered at a low concentration.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a composition (e.g., a solution, gel, ointment, suspension, emulsion, or solid insert) including a substance selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents in combination with a corticosteroid and/or an NsIDI. In this aspect of the invention, the corticosteroid and/or the NsIDI can be administered at a low concentration.
  • The invention also features a kit that includes (i) a corticosteroid; and (ii) instructions for administering a corticosteroid and an NsIDI to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • The invention also features a kit that includes (i) an NsIDI; and (ii) instructions for administering a corticosteroid and an NsIDI to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • The invention also features a kit that includes (i) a composition containing a corticosteroid and an NsIDI; and (ii) instructions for administering the composition to a patient having or at risk of having a metabolic disorder.
  • The invention also features a kit that includes (i) a corticosteroid; (ii) an NsIDI; and (iii) instructions for administering a corticosteroid and an NsIDI to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • Any of the foregoing kits can also include instructions for administering a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents.
  • Any of the foregoing kits can also include a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents. In these kits, the NsIDI and/or corticosteroid can optionally be formulated in a single composition with a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents.
  • The invention also features a kit that includes (i) a corticosteroid; and (ii) instructions for administering a corticosteroid and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents, to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • The invention also features a kit that includes (i) an NsIDI; and (ii) instructions for administering an NsIDI and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents, to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • The invention also features a kit that includes (i) a composition containing a corticosteroid and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents; and (ii) instructions for administering the composition to a patient having or at risk of having a metabolic disorder.
  • The invention also features a kit that includes (i) a composition containing an NsIDI and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents; and (ii) instructions for administering the composition to a patient having or at risk of having a metabolic disorder.
  • The invention also features a kit that includes (i) a corticosteroid; (ii) a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents (iii) instructions for administering a corticosteroid and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents, to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • The invention also features a kit that includes (i) a NsIDI; (ii) a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents (iii) instructions for administering a NsIDI and a compound selected from: dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents, to a patient having or at risk of having an ophthalmic disorder.
  • In any of the forgoing aspects of the invention, the corticosteroid can be selected from SEGRAs (selective glucocorticosteroid receptor agonists), fluocinolone acetonide, fluorometholone, dexamethasone, hydrocortisone, loteprednol, medrysone, methylprednisolone, prednisolone, rimexolone, or triamcinolone.
  • In any of the forgoing aspects of the invention, the NsIDI can be selected from cyclosporine A, ABT-281, ISAtx247, tacrolimus, ascomycin, pimecrolimus, rapamycin, or everolimus.
  • In any of the foregoing aspects of the invention, the concentration of the corticosteroid can be equivalent to a concentration of prednisolone of between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, or 0.01%) and the concentration of the non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant can be equivalent to a concentration of cyclosporine A between 0.001% and 0.049% (e.g., 0.04%, 0.03%, 0.02%, 0.01%, 0.009%, 0.008%, 0.007%, 0.006%, 0.005%, or 0.001%).
  • In one embodiment, the corticosteroid is prednisolone and the concentration of prednisolone is between 0.01% and 0.12% (e.g., 0.12%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • In another embodiment, the corticosteroid is clocortolone pivalate and the concentration of clocortolone pivalate is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • In another embodiment, the corticosteroid is hydrocortisone and the concentration of hydrocortisone is between 0.01% and 1.0% (e.g., 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • In another embodiment, the corticosteroid is dexamethasone and the concentration of dexamethasone is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • In another embodiment, the corticosteroid is fluorometholone and the concentration of fluorometholone is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • In another embodiment, the corticosteroid is loteprednol etabonate and the concentration of loteprednol etabonate is between 0.01% and 0.2% (e.g., 0.2%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • In another embodiment, the corticosteroid is medrysone and the concentration of medrysone is between 0.01% and 1.0% (e.g., 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • In another embodiment, the corticosteroid is rimexolone and the concentration of rimexolone is between 0.01% and 1.0% (e.g., 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • In any of the foregoing embodiments, the NsIDI can be cyclosporine A and the concentration of cyclosporine A is between 0.001% and 0.049% (e.g., 0.04%, 0.03%, 0.02%, 0.01%, 0.009%, 0.008%, 0.007%, 0.006%, 0.005%, and 0.001%).
  • In certain embodiments of the compositions, kits, and methods of the invention, the only pharmacologically active agents in the composition or kit, or used in the method, are those recited. In this embodiment, pharmacologically inactive excipients may also be present in the composition or kit, or used in the practice of the method.
  • The invention features the treatment of an ophthalmic disorder, for example age related macular degeneration, alkaline erosive keratoconjunctivitis, allergic conjunctivitis, allergic keratitis, anterior uveitis, Behcet's disease, blepharitis, blood-aqueous barrier disruption, chorioiditis, chronic uveitis, conjunctivitis, contact lens-induced keratoconjunctivitis, corneal abrasion, corneal trauma, corneal ulcer, crystalline retinopathy, cystoid macular edema, dacryocystitis, diabetic keratophathy, diabetic macular edema, diabetic retinopathy, dry eye disease, dry age-related macular degeneration, eosinophilic granuloma, episcleritis, exudative macular edema, Fuchs' Dystrophy, giant cell arteritis, giant papillary conjunctivitis, glaucoma, glaucoma surgery failure, graft rejection, herpes zoster, inflammation after cataract surgery, iridocorneal endothelial syndrome, iritis, keratoconjunctiva sicca, keratoconjunctival inflammatory disease, keratoconus, lattice dystrophy, map-dot-fingerprint dystrophy, necrotic keratitis, neovascular diseases involving the retina, uveal tract or cornea such as neovascular glaucoma, corneal neovascularization, neovascularization resulting following a combined vitrectomy and lensectomy, neovascularization of the optic nerve, and neovascularization due to penetration of the eye or contusive ocular injury, neuroparalytic keratitis, non-infectious uveitisocular herpes, ocular lymphoma, ocular rosacea, ophthalmic infections, ophthalmic pemphigoid, optic neuritis, panuveitis, papillitis, pars planitis, persistent macular edema, phacoanaphylaxis, posterior uveitis, post-operative inflammation, proliferative diabetic retinopathy, proliferative sickle cell retinopathy, proliferative vitreoretinopathy, retinal artery occlusion, retinal detachment, retinal vein occlusion, retinitis pigmentosa, retinopathy of prematurity, rubeosis iritis, scleritis, Stevens-Johnson syndrome, sympathetic ophthalmia, temporal arteritis, thyroid associated opthalmopathy, uveitis, vernal conjunctivitis, vitamin A insufficiency-induced keratomalacia, vitreitis, or wet age-related macular degeneration.
  • Compounds useful in the invention include those described herein in any of their pharmaceutically acceptable forms, including isomers such as diastereomers and enantiomers, salts, esters, solvates, and polymorphs thereof, as well as racemic mixtures and pure isomers of the compounds described herein.
  • By “corticosteroid” is meant any naturally occurring or synthetic compound characterized by a hydrogenated cyclopentanoperhydro-phenanthrene ring system and having immunosuppressive and/or anti-inflammatory activity. Naturally occurring corticosteroids are generally produced by the adrenal cortex. Synthetic corticosteroids may be halogenated. Examples corticosteroids are provided herein.
  • By “non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant” or “NsIDI” is meant any non-steroidal agent that decreases proinflammatory cytokine production or secretion, binds an immunophilin, or causes a down regulation of the proinflammatory reaction. NsIDIs include calcineurin inhibitors, such as cyclosporine A, ABT-281, ISAtx247, tacrolimus, ascomycin, pimecrolimus, as well as other agents (peptides, peptide fragments, chemically modified peptides, or peptide mimetics) that inhibit the phosphatase activity of calcineurin. NsIDIs also include rapamycin (sirolimus) and everolimus, which bind to an FK506-binding protein, FKBP-12, and block antigen-induced proliferation of white blood cells and cytokine secretion.
  • By “small molecule immunomodulator” is meant a non-steroidal, non-NsIDI compound that decreases proinflammatory cytokine production or secretion, causes a down regulation of the proinflammatory reaction, or otherwise modulates the immune system in an immunophilin-independent manner. Exemplary small molecule immunomodulators are p38 MAP kinase inhibitors such as VX 702 (Vertex Pharmaceuticals), SCIO 469 (Scios), doramapimod (Boehringer Ingelheim), RO 30201195 (Roche), and SCIO 323 (Scios), TACE inhibitors such as DPC 333 (Bristol Myers Squibb), ICE inhibitors such as pranalcasan (Vertex Pharmaceuticals), and IMPDH inhibitors such as mycophenolate (Roche) and merimepodib (Vertex Pharmaceuticals).
  • By “tricyclic compound” is meant a compound having one the formulas (I), (II), (III), (IV), or (V):
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00001

    wherein each X is, independently, H, Cl, F, Br, I, CH3, CF3, OH, OCH3, CH2CH3, or OCH2CH3; Y is CH2, O, NH, S(O)0-2, (CH2)2, (CH)2, CH2O, CH2NH, CHN, or CH2S; Z is C or S; A is a branched or unbranched, saturated or monounsaturated hydrocarbon chain having between 3 and 6 carbons, inclusive; each B is, independently, H, Cl, F, Br, I, CX3, CH2CH3, OCX3, or OCX2CX3; and D is CH2, O, NH, or S(O)0-2. In preferred embodiments, each X is, independently, H, Cl, or F; Y is (CH2)2, Z is C; A is (CH2)3; and each B is, independently, H, Cl, or F. Other tricyclic compounds are described below. Tricyclic compounds include tricyclic antidepressants such as amoxapine, 8-hydroxyamoxapine, 7-hydroxyamoxapine, loxapine (e.g., loxapine succinate, loxapine hydrochloride), 8-hydroxyloxapine, amitriptyline, clomipramine, doxepin, imipramine, trimipramine, desipramine, nortriptyline, and protriptyline, although compounds need not have antidepressant activities to be considered tricyclic compounds of the invention.
  • By “tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine” is meant a compound having the formula (V):
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00002

    wherein each Z and each Z′ is, independently, N, O, C,
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00003
  • When Z or Z′ is O or
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00004

    then p=1, when Z or Z′ is N,
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00005

    then p=2, and when Z or Z′ is C, then p=3. In formula (V), each R1 is, independently, X, OH, N-alkyl (wherein the alkyl group has 1 to 20, more preferably 1-5, carbon atoms); a branched or unbranched alkyl group having 1 to 20, more preferably 1-5, carbon atoms; or a heterocycle, preferably as defined in formula (V). Alternatively, when p>1, two R1 groups from a common Z or Z′ atom, in combination with each other, may represent —(CY2)k— in which k is an integer between 4 and 6, inclusive. Each X is, independently, Y, CY3, C(CY3)3, CY2CY3, (CY2)1-5OY, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkane of the structure CnY2n-1, wherein n=3-7, inclusive. Each Y is, independently, H, F, Cl, Br, or I. In one embodiment, each Z is the same moiety, each Z′ is the same moiety, and Z and Z′ are different moieties.
  • By “prostaglandin” is meant a member of the lipid class of biochemicals that belongs to a subclass of lipids known as the eicosanoids, because of their structural similarities to the C-20 polyunsaturated fatty acids, the eicosaenoic acids. Prostaglandins include alprostidil, dinoprostone, limaprost, misoprostil, prostaglandin E2, prostaglandin A1, prostaglandin A2, prostaglandin B1, prostaglandin B2, prostaglandin D2, prostaglandin F1α, prostaglandin F2α, prostaglandin 11, prostaglandin-ici 74205, prostaglandin F2β, 6-keto-prostaglandin F1α, prostaglandin E1 ethyl ester, prostaglandin E1 methyl ester, prostaglandin F2 methyl ester, arbaprostil, ornoprostil, 13,14-dihydroprostaglandin F2α, and prostaglandin J.
  • By “bufexamac” is meant a compound having the structure:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00006

    or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug thereof.
  • By “bufexamac analog” is meant a compound having the formula (VI):
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00007

    or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or prodrug thereof, wherein R1 is
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00008

    wherein R1A is and R1B is H, halo, CF3, optionally substituted C1-6 alkyl, optionally substituted C2-6 alkenyl, optionally substituted C2-6 alkynyl, optionally substituted C3-8 cycloalkyl, optionally substituted C1-6 alkoxy, or optionally substituted C1-6 thioalkoxy; each of R2 and R3 is, independently, H, C1-4 alkyl, or CF3; and R4 is optionally substituted C1-6 alkyl or optionally substituted C3-8 cycloalkyl.
  • By a “low dosage” or “low concentration” is meant at least 5% less (e.g., at least 10%, 20%, 50%, 80%, 90%, or even 95%) than the lowest standard recommended dosage or lowest standard recommended concentration of a particular compound formulated for a given route of administration for treatment of any human disease or condition. For example, a low dosage of corticosteroid formulated for administration by inhalation will differ from a low dosage of corticosteroid formulated for oral administration.
  • By a “high dosage” is meant at least 5% (e.g., at least 10%, 20%, 50%, 100%, 200%, or even 300%) more than the highest standard recommended dosage of a particular compound for treatment of any human disease or condition.
  • By a “moderate dosage” is meant the dosage between the low dosage and the high dosage.
  • By a “dosage equivalent to a prednisolone dosage” is meant a dosage of a corticosteroid that, in combination with a given dosage of a second drug produces the same anti-inflammatory effect in a patient as a dosage of prednisolone in combination with that dosage.
  • By “selective serotonin reuptake inhibitor” or “SSRI” is meant any member of the class of compounds that (i) inhibit the uptake of serotonin by neurons of the central nervous system, (ii) have an inhibition constant (Ki) of 10 nM or less, and (iii) a selectivity for serotonin over norepinephrine (i.e., the ratio of Ki(norepinephrine) over Ki(serotonin)) of greater than 100. Typically, SSRIs are administered in dosages of greater than 10 mg per day when used as antidepressants. Exemplary SSRIs for use in the invention are fluoxetine, fluvoxamine, paroxetine, sertraline, citalopram, and venlafaxine.
  • By “treating” is meant administering or prescribing a pharmaceutical composition for the treatment or prevention of an immunoinflammatory disease.
  • By “patient” is meant any animal (e.g., a human). Other animals that can be treated using the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include horses, dogs, cats, pigs, goats, rabbits, hamsters, monkeys, guinea pigs, rats, mice, lizards, snakes, sheep, cattle, fish, and birds.
  • By “steroid toxicity” is meant a substantial detrimental increase in intraocular pressure resulting from steroid administration.
  • By “an amount sufficient” is meant the amount of a compound, in a combination of the invention, required to treat or prevent an immunoinflammatory disease in a clinically relevant manner. A sufficient amount of an active compound used to practice the present invention for therapeutic treatment of conditions caused by or contributing to an immunoinflammatory disease varies depending upon the manner of administration, the age, body weight, and general health of the patient. Ultimately, the prescribers will decide the appropriate amount and dosage regimen.
  • By “more effective” is meant that a method, composition, or kit exhibits greater efficacy, is less toxic, safer, more convenient, better tolerated, or less expensive, or provides more treatment satisfaction than another method, composition, or kit with which it is being compared. Efficacy may be measured by a skilled practitioner using any standard method that is appropriate for a given indication.
  • The term “immunoinflammatory disorder” encompasses a variety of conditions, including autoimmune diseases, proliferative skin diseases, and inflammatory dermatoses. Immunoinflammatory disorders result in the destruction of healthy tissue by an inflammatory process, dysregulation of the immune system, and unwanted proliferation of cells. Examples of immunoinflammatory disorders are acne vulgaris; acute respiratory distress syndrome; Addison's disease; adrenocortical insufficiency; adrenogenital ayndrome; allergic conjunctivitis; allergic rhinitis; allergic intraocular inflammatory diseases, ANCA-associated small-vessel vasculitis; angioedema; ankylosing spondylitis; aphthous stomatitis; arthritis, asthma; atherosclerosis; atopic dermatitis; autoimmune disease; autoimmune hemolytic anemia; autoimmune hepatitis; Behcet's disease; Bell's palsy; berylliosis; bronchial asthma; bullous herpetiformis dermatitis; bullous pemphigoid; carditis; celiac disease; cerebral ischaemia; chronic obstructive pulmonary disease; cirrhosis; Cogan's syndrome; contact dermatitis; COPD; Crohn's disease; Cushing's syndrome; dermatomyositis; diabetes mellitus; discoid lupus erythematosus; eosinophilic fasciitis; epicondylitis; erythema nodosum; exfoliative dermatitis; fibromyalgia; focal glomerulosclerosis; giant cell arteritis; gout; gouty arthritis; graft-versus-host disease; hand dermatitis; Henoch-Schonlein purpura; herpes gestationis; hirsutism; hypersensitivity drug reactions; idiopathic cerato-scleritis; idiopathic pulmonary fibrosis; idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura; inflammatory bowel or gastrointestinal disorders, inflammatory dermatoses; juvenile rheumatoid arthritis; laryngeal edema; lichen planus; Loeffler's syndrome; lupus nephritis; lupus vulgaris; lymphomatous tracheobronchitis; macular edema; multiple sclerosis; musculoskeletal and connective tissue disorder; myasthenia gravis; myositis; obstructive pulmonary disease; ocular inflammation; organ transplant rejection; osteoarthritis; pancreatitis; pemphigoid gestationis; pemphigus vulgaris; polyarteritis nodosa; polymyalgia rheumatica; primary adrenocortical insufficiency; primary billiary cirrhosis; pruritus scroti; pruritis/inflammation, psoriasis; psoriatic arthritis; Reiter's disease; relapsing polychondritis; rheumatic carditis; rheumatic fever; rheumatoid arthritis; rosacea caused by sarcoidosis; rosacea caused by scleroderma; rosacea caused by Sweet's syndrome; rosacea caused by systemic lupus erythematosus; rosacea caused by urticaria; rosacea caused by zoster-associated pain; sarcoidosis; scleroderma; segmental glomerulosclerosis; septic shock syndrome; serum sickness; shoulder tendinitis or bursitis; Sjogren's syndrome; Still's disease; stroke-induced brain cell death; Sweet's disease; systemic dermatomyositis; systemic lupus erythematosus; systemic sclerosis; Takayasu's arteritis; temporal arteritis; thyroiditis; toxic epidermal necrolysis; tuberculosis; type-1 diabetes; ulcerative colitis; uveitis; vasculitis; and Wegener's granulomatosis.
  • “Non-dermal inflammatory disorders” include rheumatoid arthritis, inflammatory bowel disease, asthma, and chronic obstructive pulmonary disease.
  • By “dermal inflammatory disorders” or “inflammatory dermatoses” is meant an inflammatory disorder selected from psoriasis, guttate psoriasis, inverse psoriasis, pustular psoriasis, erythrodermic psoriasis, acute febrile neutrophilic dermatosis, eczema, asteatotic eczema, dyshidrotic eczema, vesicular palmoplantar eczema, acne vulgaris, atopic dermatitis, contact dermatitis, allergic contact dermatitis, dermatomyositis, exfoliative dermatitis, hand eczema, pompholyx, rosacea, rosacea caused by sarcoidosis, rosacea caused by scleroderma, rosacea caused by Sweet's syndrome, rosacea caused by systemic lupus erythematosus, rosacea caused by urticaria, rosacea caused by zoster-associated pain, Sweet's disease, neutrophilic hidradenitis, sterile pustulosis, drug eruptions, seborrheic dermatitis, pityriasis rosea, cutaneous kikuchi disease, pruritic urticarial papules and plaques of pregnancy, Stevens-Johnson Syndrome and toxic epidermal necrolysis, tatoo reactions, Wells Syndrome (eosinophilic cellulitis), reactive arthritis (Reiter's Syndrome), bowel-associated dermatosis-arthritis syndrome, rheumatoid neutrophilic dermatosis, neutrophilic eccrine hidradenitis, neutrophilic dermatosis of the dorsal hands, balanitis circumscripta plasmacellularis, balanoposthitis, Behcet's disease, erythema annulare centrifugum, erythema dyschromicum perstans, erythema multiforme, granuloma annulare, hand dermatitis, lichen nitidus, lichen planus, lichen sclerosus et atrophicus, lichen simplex chronicus, lichen spinulosus, nummular dermatitis, pyoderma gangrenosum, sarcoidosis, subcorneal pustular dermatosis, urticaria, and transient acantholytic dermatosis.
  • By “proliferative skin disease” is meant a benign or malignant disease that is characterized by accelerated cell division in the epidermis or dermis. Examples of proliferative skin diseases are psoriasis, atopic dermatitis, non-specific dermatitis, primary irritant contact dermatitis, allergic contact dermatitis, actinic keratosis, basal and squamous cell carcinomas of the skin, lamellar ichthyosis, epidermolytic hyperkeratosis, premalignant keratosis, acne, and seborrheic dermatitis.
  • By “musculoskeletal disorder” is meant an immune system-related disorder of the muscles, ligaments, bones, joints, cartilage, or other connective tissue. Among the most commonly-occurring musculoskeletal disorders are various forms of arthritis, e.g., osteoarthritis, rheumatoid arthritis, juvenile rheumatoid arthritis, and gout. Other musculoskeletal disorders include acquired hyperostosis syndrome, acromegaly, ankylosing spondylitis, Behcet's disease, bone diseases, bursitis, cartilage diseases, chronic fatigue syndrome, compartment syndromes, congenital hypothyroidism, congenital myopathies, dentigerous cyst, dermatomyositis, diffuse idiopathic skeletal hyperostosis, Dupuytren's contracture, eosinophilia-myalgia syndrome, fasciitis, Felty's syndrome, fibromyalgia, hallux valgus, infectious arthritis, joint diseases, Kabuki make-up syndrome, Legg-Perthes disease, lupus, Lyme disease, Melas syndrome, metabolic bone diseases, mitochondrial myopathies, mixed connective tissue disease, muscular diseases, muscular dystrophies, musculoskeletal abnormalities, musculoskeletal diseases, myositis, myositis ossificans, necrotizing fasciitis, neurogenic arthropathy, osteitis deformans, osteochondritis, osteomalacia, osteomyelitis, osteonecrosis, osteoporosis, Paget's disease, Pierre Robin syndrome, polymyalgia rheumatica, polymyositis, postpoliomyelitis syndrome, pseudogout, psoriatric arthritis, reactive arthritis, Reiter disease, relapsing polychondritis, renal osteodystrophy, rhabdomyolysis, rheumatic diseases, rheumatic fever, scleroderma, Sever's disease (calceneal apophysitis), Sjögren's syndrome, spinal diseases, spinal stenosis, Still's disease, synovitis, temporomandibular joint disorders, tendinopathy, tennis elbow, tenosynovitis, Tietze's syndrome, and Wegener's granulomatosis.
  • “Ophthalmic disorder” refers to physiologic abnormalities of the eye. They may involve the retina, the vitreous humor, lens, cornea, sclera or other portions of the eye, or physiologic abnormalities which adversely affect the eye, such as inadequate tear production.
  • Ophthalmic disorders that can be treated using the compositions, methods, and kits of the invention include age related macular degeneration, alkaline erosive keratoconjunctivitis, allergic conjunctivitis, allergic keratitis, anterior uveitis, Behcet's disease, blepharitis, blood-aqueous barrier disruption, chorioiditis, chronic uveitis, conjunctivitis, contact lens-induced keratoconjunctivitis, corneal abrasion, corneal trauma, corneal ulcer, crystalline retinopathy, cystoid macular edema, dacryocystitis, diabetic keratophathy, diabetic macular edema, diabetic retinopathy, dry eye disease, dry age-related macular degeneration, eosinophilic granuloma, episcleritis, exudative macular edema, Fuchs' Dystrophy, giant cell arteritis, giant papillary conjunctivitis, glaucoma, glaucoma surgery failure, graft rejection, herpes zoster, inflammation after cataract surgery, iridocorneal endothelial syndrome, iritis, keratoconjunctiva sicca, keratoconjunctival inflammatory disease, keratoconus, lattice dystrophy, map-dot-fingerprint dystrophy, necrotic keratitis, neovascular diseases involving the retina, uveal tract or cornea such as neovascular glaucoma, corneal neovascularization, neovascularization resulting following a combined vitrectomy and lensectomy, neovascularization of the optic nerve, and neovascularization due to penetration of the eye or contusive ocular injury, neuroparalytic keratitis, non-infectious uveitisocular herpes, ocular lymphoma, ocular rosacea, ophthalmic infections, ophthalmic pemphigoid, optic neuritis, panuveitis, papillitis, pars planitis, persistent macular edema, phacoanaphylaxis, posterior uveitis, post-operative inflammation, proliferative diabetic retinopathy, proliferative sickle cell retinopathy, proliferative vitreoretinopathy, retinal artery occlusion, retinal detachment, retinal vein occlusion, retinitis pigmentosa, retinopathy of prematurity, rubeosis iritis, scleritis, Stevens-Johnson syndrome, sympathetic ophthalmia, temporal arteritis, thyroid associated opthalmopathy, uveitis, vernal conjunctivitis, vitamin A insufficiency-induced keratomalacia, vitreitis, or wet age-related macular degeneration.
  • As will be appreciated by one skilled in the art, a particular disease, disorder, or condition may be characterized as being both a proliferative skin disease and an inflammatory dermatosis. An example of such a disease is psoriasis.
  • As also will be appreciated, a particular disease may be both an immunoinflammatory disorder and an ophthalmic disorder. One such example is Behcet's disease.
  • The term “periodontal disease” encompasses a variety of conditions, including gingivitis and periodontitis, as well as diseases of tissues that surround and support teeth, including the gingiva, cementum, periodontal ligament, alveolar process bone, and dental supporting bone.
  • By “a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level” is meant any disease or disorder in which the level of serum CRP may be elevated compared to normal controls. Typically a serum CRP level of >3 mg/L is considered elevated. Such diseases and conditions associated with an increased serum CRP level include cardiovascular disease (e.g., coronary artery disease, peripheral artery disease); hypertension; colon cancer; lymphoma; sarcoma; and pancreatitis.
  • By “sustained release” or “controlled release” is meant that the therapeutically active component is released from the formulation at a controlled rate such that therapeutically beneficial blood levels (but below toxic levels) of the component are maintained over an extended period of time ranging from e.g., about 12 to about 24 hours, thus, providing, for example, a 12 hour or a 24 hour dosage form.
  • In the generic descriptions of compounds of this invention, the number of atoms of a particular type in a substituent group is generally given as a range, e.g., an alkyl group containing from 1 to 4 carbon atoms or C1-4 alkyl. Reference to such a range is intended to include specific references to groups having each of the integer number of atoms within the specified range. For example, an alkyl group from 1 to 4 carbon atoms includes each of C1, C2, C3, and C4. A C1-12 heteroalkyl, for example, includes from 1 to 12 carbon atoms in addition to one or more heteroatoms. Other numbers of atoms and other types of atoms may be indicated in a similar manner.
  • As used herein, the terms “alkyl” and the prefix “alk-” are inclusive of both straight chain and branched chain groups and of cyclic groups, i.e., cycloalkyl. Cyclic groups can be monocyclic or polycyclic and preferably have from 3 to 6 ring carbon atoms, inclusive. Exemplary cyclic groups include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, and cyclohexyl groups.
  • By “C1-4 alkyl” is meant a branched or unbranched hydrocarbon group having from 1 to 4 carbon atoms. A C1-4 alkyl group may be substituted or unsubstituted. Exemplary substituents include alkoxy, aryloxy, sulfhydryl, alkylthio, arylthio, halide, hydroxyl, fluoroalkyl, perfluoralkyl, amino, aminoalkyl, disubstituted amino, quaternary amino, hydroxyalkyl, carboxyalkyl, and carboxyl groups. C1-4 alkyls include, without limitation, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, cyclopropyl, cyclopropylmethyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, sec-butyl, tert-butyl, and cyclobutyl.
  • By “halogen” is meant bromine, chlorine, iodine, or fluorine.
  • By “alkoxy” is meant a chemical substituent of the formula —OR, wherein R is selected from C1-7 alkyl, C2-7 alkenyl, C2-7 alkynyl, C2-6 heterocyclyl, C6-12 aryl, C7-14 alkaryl, C3-10 alkheterocyclyl, or C1-7 heteroalkyl.
  • The term “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” represents those salts which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response and the like, and are commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are well known in the art. The salts can be prepared in situ during the final isolation and purification of the compounds of the invention, or separately by reacting the free base function with a suitable organic acid. Representative acid addition salts include acetate, adipate, alginate, ascorbate, aspartate, benzenesulfonate, benzoate, bisulfate, borate, butyrate, camphorate, camphersulfonate, citrate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dodecylsulfate, ethanesulfonate, fumarate, glucoheptonate, glycerophosphate, hemisulfate, heptonate, hexanoate, hydrobromide, hydrochloride, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxy-ethanesulfonate, isethionate, lactobionate, lactate, laurate, lauryl sulfate, malate, maleate, malonate, mesylate, methanesulfonate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, nicotinate, nitrate, oleate, oxalate, palmitate, pamoate, pectinate, persulfate, 3-phenylpropionate, phosphate, picrate, pivalate, propionate, stearate, succinate, sulfate, tartrate, thiocyanate, toluenesulfonate, undecanoate, valerate salts, and the like. Representative alkali or alkaline earth metal salts include sodium, lithium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and the like, as well as nontoxic ammonium, quaternary ammonium, and amine cations, including, but not limited to ammonium, tetramethylammonium, tetraethylammonium, methylamine, dimethylamine, trimethylamine, triethylamine, ethylamine, and the like.
  • Compounds useful in the invention include those described herein in any of their pharmaceutically acceptable forms, including isomers such as diastereomers and enantiomers, salts, esters, amides, thioesters, solvates, and polymorphs thereof, as well as racemic mixtures and pure isomers of the compounds described herein.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
  • FIGS. 1A-1MM are graphs showing suppression of PMA/ionomycin-induced TNFα secretion in cells treated with a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3.
  • FIGS. 2A-2LL are graphs showing suppression of IFNγ, IL-2, and TNFα in cells treated with combinations of an NsIDI and a corticosteroid.
  • Other features and advantages of the invention will be apparent from the following detailed description.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION
  • The invention features methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders. In one embodiment of the invention, treatment of an immunoinflammatory disorder is performed by administering two drugs simultaneously or within 14 days of each other to a patient in need of such treatment.
  • The invention also features methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders. In one embodiment, a patient with an ophthalmic disorder is treated by administering two drugs simultaneously.
  • Cyclosporine A, a non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant (NsIDI), is approved for treating several ophthalmic conditions. Cyclosporine A causes eye irritation and other undesired side effects when administered to patients at the lowest approved concentration. Lower concentrations of cyclosporine A do not cause these undesired side effects but are not sufficient to alleviate the symptoms of the ophthalmic disorders.
  • Both corticosteroids and NsIDIs suppress cytokine production in cell culture models of immune function (Table 1B). We have discovered that combinations of certain NsIDIs with certain corticosteroids suppress cytokine production in a synergistic manner.
  • Based upon these data, we propose that when combined with a corticosteroid, low concentrations of cyclosporine A are sufficient to alleviate the symptoms of ophthalmic disorders while not causing undesired side effects.
  • The invention is based on our discovery that certain combinations of drugs inhibit cytokine production and/or secretion in vitro. The combinations are listed on Table 1A and Table 1B.
    TABLE 1A
    Drug
    1 Drug 2
    Prednisolone Ibudilast
    Prednisolone RO-20-1724
    Prednisolone Epinastine
    Prednisolone Prostaglandin
    Prednisolone Bufexamac
    Cyclosporine A Brimonidine
    Cyclosporine A Epinastine
    Cyclosporine A Dipivefrin
    Cyclosporine A Prostaglandin E
    Cyclosporine A Amantadine
    Cyclosporine A Apraclonidine
    Cyclosporine A Loratadine
    Tacrolimus Amantadine
    Dipyridamole Amoxapine
    Dipyridamole Sertraline
    Loratadine Nortriptyline
    Loratadine Paroxetine
    Amoxapine Bufexamac
    Amoxapine Loratadine
    Amoxapine Nitrendipine
    Ibudilast Desloratadine
    Dipivefrin Dipyridamole
    Dipivefrin Limaprost
    Dipivefrin Prostaglandin
    Dipivefrin Bufexamac
    Dipivefrin Amoxapine
    Dipivefrin Amantadine
    Prostaglandin E Ibudilast
    Misoprostol Ibudilast
    Misoprostol RO-20-1724
    Prostaglandin E Dipyridamole
    Prostaglandin E Rolipram
    Prostaglandin E RO-20-1724
    Limaprost RO-20-1724
    Limaprost Ibudilast
    Bithionol Nicarbazin
    Dipyridamole Rolipram
    Triamcinolone Ibudilast
    Triamcinolone Bufexamac
  • TABLE 1B
    Drug
    1 Drug 2
    Dexamethasone Cyclosporine A
    Fluorometholone Cyclosporine A
    Hydrocortisone Cyclosporine A
    Loteprednol Etabonate Cyclosporine A
    Medrysone Cyclosporine A
    Methylprednisolone Cyclosporine A
    Prednisolone Cyclosporine A
    Prednisolone Acetate Cyclosporine A
    Rimexolone Cyclosporine A
    Triamcinolone Cyclosporine A
    Dexamethasone Tacrolimus
    Fluorometholone Tacrolimus
    Hydrocortisone Tacrolimus
    Medrysone Tacrolimus
    Methylprednisolone Tacrolimus
    Prednisolone Tacrolimus
    Prednisolone Acetate Tacrolimus
    Triamcinolone Tacrolimus
  • In the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention, drugs that are the same mechanistic, structural, or therapeutic class may be used in lieu of one or more of the drugs listed on Table 1A or Table 1B. Exemplary classes are provided on Table 2.
    TABLE 2
    Class Drug
    Alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonist Brimonidine
    Apraclonidine
    Anticoccidial compound Nicarbazin
    Antihistamine Loratadine
    Epinastine
    Antiinfective Bithionol
    Antiinflammatory Bufexamac
    Calcium channel blocker Nitrendipine
    Corticosteroid Prednisolone
    Dexamethasone
    Fluorometholone
    Hydrocortisone
    Loteprednol Etabonate
    Medrysone
    Methylprednisolone
    Prednisolone Acetate
    Rimexolone
    Triamcinolone
    Electron donor-acceptor molecular complex Nicarbazin
    NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic Amantadine
    NsIDI Cyclosporine A
    Tacrolimus
    Phosphodiesterase inhibitor Dipyridamole
    Ibudilast
    RO-20-1724
    Rolipram
    Prostaglandin Prostaglandin E
    Misoprostol
    Limaprost
    SSRI Sertraline
    Paroxetine
    Sympathomimetic Dipivefrin
    Tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine Dipyridamole
    Tricyclic compound Amoxapine
    Nortriptyline
  • Thus, more broadly, the drug pairs of Table 3 may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
    TABLE 3
    Drug 1 Drug 2
    Antihistamine Phosphodiesterase inhibitor
    Antihistamine SSRI
    Antihistamine Tricyclic compound
    Antiinfective Anticoccidial compound
    Corticosteroid Antihistamine
    Corticosteroid Phosphodiesterase inhibitor
    Corticosteroid Prostaglandin
    NsIDI Alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonist
    NsIDI Antihistamine
    NsIDI NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic
    NsIDI Prostaglandin
    NsIDI Sympathomimetic
    Prostaglandin Phosphodiesterase inhibitor
    Prostaglandin Tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine
    Sympathomimetic NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic
    Sympathomimetic Prostaglandin
    Sympathomimetic Tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine
    Sympathomimetic Tricyclic compound
    Tetra-substituted Phosphodiesterase inhibitor
    pyrimidopyrimidine
    Tetra-substituted SSRI
    pyrimidopyrimidine
    Tetra-substituted Tricyclic compound
    pyrimidopyrimidine
    Tricyclic compound Calcium channel blocker
  • The classes are discussed in more detail below.
  • Corticosteroids
  • In certain embodiments, a corticosteroid may be employed in a method, composition, or kit of the invention. Suitable corticosteroids include those from the class of selective glucocorticosteroid receptor agonists (SEGRAs), 11-alpha, 17-alpha,21-trihydroxypregn-4-ene-3,20-dione; 11-beta, 16-alpha, 17,21-tetrahydroxypregn-4-ene-3,20-dione; 11-beta, 16-alpha, 17,21-tetrahydroxypregn-1,4-diene-3,20-dione; 11-beta, 17-alpha,21-trihydroxy-6-alpha-methylpregn-4-ene-3,20-dione; 11-dehydrocorticosterone; 11-deoxycortisol; 11-hydroxy-1,4-androstadiene-3,17-dione; 11-ketotestosterone; 14-hydroxyandrost-4-ene-3,6,17-trione; 15,17-dihydroxyprogesterone; 16-methylhydrocortisone; 17,21-dihydroxy-16-alpha-methylpregna-1,4,9(11)-triene-3,20-dione; 17-alpha-hydroxypregn-4-ene-3,20-dione; 17-alpha-hydroxypregnenolone; 17-hydroxy-16-beta-methyl-5-beta-pregn-9(11)-ene-3,20-dione; 17-hydroxy-4,6,8(14)-pregnatriene-3,20-dione; 17-hydroxypregna-4,9(11)-diene-3,20-dione; 18-hydroxycorticosterone; 18-hydroxycortisone; 18-oxocortisol; 21-acetoxypregnenolone; 21-deoxyaldosterone; 21-deoxycortisone; 2-deoxyecdysone; 2-methylcortisone; 3-dehydroecdysone; 4-pregnene-17-alpha,20-beta, 21-triol-3,11-dione; 6,17,20-trihydroxypregn-4-ene-3-one; 6-alpha-hydroxycortisol; 6-alpha-fluoroprednisolone, 6-alpha-methylprednisolone, 6-alpha-methylprednisolone 21-acetate, 6-alpha-methylprednisolone 21-hemisuccinate sodium salt, 6-beta-hydroxycortisol, 6-alpha, 9-alpha-difluoroprednisolone 21-acetate 17-butyrate, 6-hydroxycorticosterone; 6-hydroxydexamethasone; 6-hydroxyprednisolone; 9-fluorocortisone; alclomethasone dipropionate; aldosterone; algestone; alphaderm; amadinone; amcinonide; anagestone; androstenedione; anecortave acetate; beclomethasone; beclomethasone dipropionate; betamethasone 17-valerate; betamethasone sodium acetate; betamethasone sodium phosphate; betamethasone valerate; bolasterone; budesonide; calusterone; chlormadinone; chloroprednisone; chloroprednisone acetate; cholesterol; ciclesonide; clobetasol; clobetasol propionate; clobetasone; clocortolone; clocortolone pivalate; clogestone; cloprednol; corticosterone; cortisol; cortisol acetate; cortisol butyrate; cortisol cypionate; cortisol octanoate; cortisol sodium phosphate; cortisol sodium succinate; cortisol valerate; cortisone; cortisone acetate; cortivazol; cortodoxone; daturaolone; deflazacort, 21-deoxycortisol, dehydroepiandrosterone; delmadinone; deoxycorticosterone; deprodone; descinolone; desonide; desoximethasone; dexafen; dexamethasone; dexamethasone 21-acetate; dexamethasone acetate; dexamethasone sodium phosphate; dichlorisone; diflorasone; diflorasone diacetate; diflucortolone; difluprednate; dihydroelatericin a; domoprednate; doxibetasol; ecdysone; ecdysterone; emoxolone; endrysone; enoxolone; fluazacort; flucinolone; flucloronide; fludrocortisone; fludrocortisone acetate; flugestone; flumethasone; flumethasone pivalate; flumoxonide; flunisolide; fluocinolone; fluocinolone acetonide; fluocinonide; fluocortin butyl; 9-fluorocortisone; fluocortolone; fluorohydroxyandrostenedione; fluorometholone; fluorometholone acetate; fluoxymesterone; fluperolone acetate; fluprednidene; fluprednisolone; flurandrenolide; fluticasone; fluticasone propionate; formebolone; formestane; formocortal; gestonorone; glyderinine; halcinonide; halobetasol propionate; halometasone; halopredone; haloprogesterone; hydrocortamate; hydrocortiosone cypionate; hydrocortisone; hydrocortisone 21-butyrate; hydrocortisone aceponate; hydrocortisone acetate; hydrocortisone buteprate; hydrocortisone butyrate; hydrocortisone cypionate; hydrocortisone hemisuccinate; hydrocortisone probutate; hydrocortisone sodium phosphate; hydrocortisone sodium succinate; hydrocortisone valerate; hydroxyprogesterone; inokosterone; isoflupredone; isoflupredone acetate; isoprednidene; loteprednol etabonate; meclorisone; mecortolon; medrogestone; medroxyprogesterone; medrysone; megestrol; megestrol acetate; melengestrol; meprednisone; methandrostenolone; methylprednisolone; methylprednisolone aceponate; methylprednisolone acetate; methylprednisolone hemisuccinate; methylprednisolone sodium succinate; methyltestosterone; metribolone; mometasone; mometasone furoate; mometasone furoate monohydrate; nisone; nomegestrol; norgestomet; norvinisterone; oxymesterone; paramethasone; paramethasone acetate; ponasterone; prednicarbate; prednisolamate; prednisolone; prednisolone 21-diethylaminoacetate; prednisolone 21-hemisuccinate; prednisolone acetate; prednisolone farnesylate; prednisolone hemisuccinate; prednisolone-21 (beta-D-glucuronide); prednisolone metasulphobenzoate; prednisolone sodium phosphate; prednisolone steaglate; prednisolone tebutate; prednisolone tetrahydrophthalate; prednisone; prednival; prednylidene; pregnenolone; procinonide; tralonide; progesterone; promegestone; rhapontisterone; rimexolone; roxibolone; rubrosterone; stizophyllin; tixocortol; topterone; triamcinolone; triamcinolone acetonide; triamcinolone acetonide 21-palmitate; triamcinolone benetonide; triamcinolone diacetate; triamcinolone hexacetonide; trimegestone; turkesterone; and wortmannin.
  • Standard recommended dosages for various steroid/disease combinations are provided in Table 4A and Table 4B, below.
    TABLE 4A
    Standard Recommended Corticosteroid Dosages
    Indication Route Drug Dose Schedule
    Corticosteroid-responsive Topical Clobetasol 0.05% Lotion Twice daily
    dermatoses proprionate
    Topical Betamethsone 0.1% Cream, Twice daily
    valerate Lotion
    Topical Hydrocortisone
    1% Gel 2-4 times daily
    acetate
    Psoriasis oral prednisolone 7.5-60 mg per day or divided
    b.i.d.
    oral prednisone 7.5-60 mg per day or divided
    b.i.d.
    Asthma inhaled beclomethasone 42 μg/puff) 4-8 puffs b.i.d.
    dipropionate
    inhaled budesonide (200 μg/inhalation) 1-2 inhalations
    b.i.d.
    inhaled flunisolide (250 μg/puff) 2-4 puffs b.i.d.
    inhaled fluticasone (44, 110 or 220 μg/puff) 2-4 puffs b.i.d.
    propionate
    inhaled triamcinolone (100 μg/puff) 2-4 puffs b.i.d.
    acetonide
    COPD oral prednisone 30-40 mg per day
    Crohn's disease oral budesonide 9 mg per day
    Ulcerative colitis oral prednisone 40-60 mg per day
    oral hydrocortisone 300 mg (IV) per day
    oral methylprednisolone 40-60 mg per day
    Rheumatoid arthritis oral prednisone 10 mg per day
  • TABLE 4B
    Standard Recommended Corticosteroid Dosages
    for Ophthalmic Administration
    Lowest approved
    concentration for
    Ophthalmic ophthalmic Lowest standard
    corticosteroid administration recommended dosage
    Clocortolone Pivalate 0.1% N/A
    Hydrocortisone 1.0% 0.5 μg/3 times daily
    Dexamethasone 0.1% 0.05 μg/4-6 times daily
    Fluorometholone 0.1% 0.05 μg/2-4 times daily
    Loteprednol Etabonate 0.2% 0.1 μg/4 times daily
    Medrysone 1.0% 0.5 μg/up to every 4 hours
    Prednisolone Acetate 0.12% 0.06 μg/2-4 times daily
    Rimexolone 1.0% 0.5 μg/4 times daily

    (N/A = Not Available)
  • Other standard recommended dosages for corticosteroids are provided, e.g., in the Merck Manual of Diagnosis & Therapy (17th Ed. M H Beers et al., Merck & Co.) and Physicians' Desk Reference 2003 (57th Ed. Medical Economics Staff et al., Medical Economics Co., 2002). In one embodiment, the dosage of corticosteroid administered is a dosage equivalent to a prednisolone dosage, as defined herein. For example, a low dosage of a corticosteroid may be considered as the dosage equivalent to a low dosage of prednisolone.
  • For ophthalmic administration, a corticosteroid can be administered at a concentration between 0.01% and 5% (e.g., 5.0%, 4.0%, 3.0%, 2.0%, 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • Low concentrations of corticosteroids of the invention are 95% or less of the lowest approved concentration. For example, low concentration of corticosteroids of the invention can be 90%, 85%, 80%, 70%, 60%, 50%, 25%, 10%, 5%, 2%, 1%, 0.5% or 0.1% of the lowest approved concentration.
  • For ophthalmic administration for example, a low concentration of clocortolone pivalate is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%), a low concentration of hydrocortisone is between 0.01% and 1.0% (e.g., 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%), a low concentration of dexamethasone is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%), a low concentration of fluorometholone is between 0.01% and 0.1% (e.g., 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%), a low concentration of loteprednol etabonate is between 0.01% and 0.2% (e.g., 0.2%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%), a low concentration of medrysone is between 0.01% and 1.0% (e.g., 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%), a low concentration of rimexolone is between 0.01% and 1.0% (e.g., 1.0%, 0.9%, 0.8%, 0.7%, 0.6%, 0.5%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%), and a low concentration of prednisolone is between 0.01% and 0.12% (e.g., 0.12%, 0.1%, 0.09%, 0.08%, 0.07%, 0.06%, 0.05%, and 0.01%).
  • Steroid Receptor Modulators
  • Steroid receptor modulators (e.g., antagonists and agonists) may be used as a substitute for or in addition to a corticosteroid in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Glucocorticoid receptor modulators that may used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include compounds described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,380,207, 6,380,223, 6,448,405, 6,506,766, and 6,570,020, U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2003/0176478, 2003/0171585, 2003/0120081, 2003/0073703, 2002/015631, 2002/0147336, 2002/0107235, 2002/0103217, and 2001/0041802, and PCT Publication No. WO00/66522, each of which is hereby incorporated by reference. Other steroid receptor modulators may also be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,093,821, 6,121,450, 5,994,544, 5,696,133, 5,696,127, 5,693,647, 5,693,646, 5,688,810, 5,688,808, and 5,696,130, each of which is hereby incorporated by reference.
  • Other Compounds
  • Other compounds that may be used in addition to the drug combination of Table 1A or Table 3 in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention A-348441 (Karo Bio), adrenal cortex extract (GlaxoSmithKline), alsactide (Aventis), amebucort (Schering AG), amelometasone (Taisho), ATSA (Pfizer), bitolterol (Elan), CBP-2011 (InKine Pharmaceutical), cebaracetam (Novartis) CGP-13774 (Kissei), ciclesonide (Altana), ciclometasone (Aventis), clobetasone butyrate (GlaxoSmithKline), cloprednol (Hoffmann-La Roche), collismycin A (Kirin), cucurbitacin E (NIH), deflazacort (Aventis), deprodone propionate (SSP), dexamethasone acefurate (Schering-Plough), dexamethasone linoleate (GlaxoSmithKline), dexamethasone valerate (Abbott), difluprednate (Pfizer), domoprednate (Hoffmann-La Roche), ebiratide (Aventis), etiprednol dicloacetate (IVAX), fluazacort (Vicuron), flumoxonide (Hoffmann-La Roche), fluocortin butyl (Schering AG), fluocortolone monohydrate (Schering AG), GR-250495X (GlaxoSmithKline), halometasone (Novartis), halopredone (Dainippon), HYC-141 (Fidia), icomethasone enbutate (Hovione), itrocinonide (AstraZeneca), L-6485 (Vicuron), Lipocort (Draxis Health), locicortone (Aventis), meclorisone (Schering-Plough), naflocort (Bristol-Myers Squibb), NCX-1015 (NicOx), NCX-1020 (NicOx), NCX-1022 (NicOx), nicocortonide (Yamanouchi), NIK-236 (Nikken Chemicals), NS-126 (SSP), Org-2766 (Akzo Nobel), Org-6632 (Akzo Nobel), P16CM, propylmesterolone (Schering AG), RGH-1113 (Gedeon Richter), rofleponide (AstraZeneca), rofleponide palmitate (AstraZeneca), RPR-106541 (Aventis), RU-26559 (Aventis), Sch-19457 (Schering-Plough), T25 (Matrix Therapeutics), TBI-PAB (Sigma-Tau), ticabesone propionate (Hoffmann-La Roche), tifluadom (Solvay), timobesone (Hoffmann-La Roche), TSC-5 (Takeda), ZK-73634 (Schering AG), antibiotics (minocycline, penicillin, cephalosporin, tetracycline, oxytetracycline, chlortetracycline, metronidazole, chloramphenicol, streptomycin, neomycin, sulfonamides, phenolic compounds, quarternary ammonium compounds, doxycycline), antiseptics (e.g., chlorhexidine), tranexamic acid, allantoin, epsilon-aminocaproic acid, lysozyme, dihydrocholesterol, beta-glycyrrhetinic acid, platelet aggregation inhibitors (e.g., abciximab, aspirin, cilostazol, clopidogrel, dipyridamole, eptifibatide, ticlopidine, or tirofiban), anticoagulants (e.g., dalteparin, danaparoid, enoxaparin, heparin, tinzaparin, or warfarin), antipyretics (e.g., acetaminophen), ticlopidine, clopidogrel, angiotensin converting enzyme inhibitors, beta blockers, pentoxifylline, cilostazol, estrogen replacement therapy, and lipid-lowering agents (e.g., cholestyramine, colestipol, nicotinic acid, gemfibrozil, probucol, ezetimibe, or statins such as atorvastatin, rosuvastatin, lovastatin simvastatin, pravastatin, cerivastatin, and fluvastatin). These agents may be administered concomitantly or within 14 days of the method of the invention. If desired, one or more of the foregoing agents is coformulated with one or more agents of the invention to form a single composition.
  • Non-Steroidal Immunophilin-Dependent Immunosuppressants
  • In one embodiment, the invention features methods, compositions, and kits employing a non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant (NsIDI).
  • In healthy individuals the immune system uses cellular effectors, such as B-cells and T-cells, to target infectious microbes and abnormal cell types while leaving normal cells intact. In individuals with an autoimmune disorder or a transplanted organ, activated T-cells damage healthy tissues. Calcineurin inhibitors (e.g., cyclosporines, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, ABT-281, ISAtx247), and rapamycin target many types of immunoregulatory cells, including T-cells, and suppress the immune response in organ transplantation and autoimmune disorders.
  • In one embodiment, the NsIDI is cyclosporine A, and is administered in an amount between 0.05 and 50 milligrams per kilogram per day (e.g., orally in an amount between 0.1 and 12 milligrams per kilogram per day). In another embodiment, the NsIDI is cyclosporine and is administered as a 0.05% ophthalmic emulsion twice per day. In another embodiment, the NsIDI is tacrolimus and is administered in an amount between 0.0001-20 milligrams per kilogram per day (e.g., orally in an amount between 0.01-0.2 milligrams per kilogram per day). In another embodiment, the NsIDI is tacrolimus and is administered as a 0.02% ophthalmic suspension. In another embodiment, the NsIDI is rapamycin and is administered in an amount between 0.1-502 milligrams per day (e.g., at a single loading dose of 6 mg/day, followed by a 2 mg/day maintenance dose). In another embodiment, the NsIDI is everolimus, administered at a dosage of 0.75-8 mg/day. In still other embodiments, the NsIDI is pimecrolimus, administered in an amount between 0.1 and 200 milligrams per day (e.g., as a 1% cream/twice a day to treat atopic dermatitis or 60 mg a day for the treatment of psoriasis), or the NsIDI is a calcineurin-binding peptide administered in an amount and frequency sufficient to treat the patient. Two or more NsIDIs can be administered contemporaneously.
  • Cyclosporines
  • The cyclosporines are fungal metabolites that comprise a class of cyclic oligopeptides that act as immunosuppressants. Cyclosporine A is a hydrophobic cyclic polypeptide consisting of eleven amino acids. It binds and forms a complex with the intracellular receptor cyclophilin. The cyclosporine/cyclophilin complex binds to and inhibits calcineurin, a Ca2+-calmodulin-dependent serine-threonine-specific protein phosphatase. Calcineurin mediates signal transduction events required for T-cell activation (reviewed in Schreiber et al., Cell 70:365-368, 1991). Cyclosporines and their functional and structural analogs suppress the T cell-dependent immune response by inhibiting antigen-triggered signal transduction. This inhibition decreases the expression of proinflammatory cytokines, such as IL-2.
  • Many different cyclosporines (e.g., cyclosporine A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H, and I) are produced by fungi. Cyclosporine A is a commercially available under the trade name NEORAL from Novartis. Cyclosporine A structural and functional analogs include cyclosporines having one or more fluorinated amino acids (described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. No. 5,227,467); cyclosporines having modified amino acids (described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,122,511 and 4,798,823); and deuterated cyclosporines, such as ISAtx247 (described in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2002/0132763 A1). Additional cyclosporine analogs are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,136,357, 4,384,996, 5,284,826, and 5,709,797. Cyclosporine analogs include, but are not limited to, D-Sar (α-SMe)3 Val2-DH-Cs (209-825), Allo-Thr-2-Cs, Norvaline-2-Cs, D-Ala(3-acetylamino)-8-Cs, Thr-2-Cs, and D-MeSer-3-Cs, D-Ser(O—CH2CH2—OH)-8-Cs, and D-Ser-8-Cs, which are described in Cruz et al. (Antimicrob. Agents Chemother. 44:143-149, 2000).
  • Cyclosporines are highly hydrophobic and readily precipitate in the presence of water (e.g. on contact with body fluids). Methods of providing cyclosporine formulations with improved bioavailability are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,388,307, 6,468,968, 5,051,402, 5,342,625, 5,977,066, and 6,022,852. Cyclosporine microemulsion compositions are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,866,159, 5,916,589, 5,962,014, 5,962,017, 6,007,840, and 6,024,978.
  • Cyclosporines can be administered either intravenously or orally, but oral administration is preferred. To overcome the hydrophobicity of cyclosporine A, an intravenous cyclosporine A may be provided in an ethanol-polyoxyethylated castor oil vehicle that must be diluted prior to administration. Cyclosporine A may be provided, e.g., as a microemulsion in a 25 mg or 100 mg tablets, in a 100 mg/ml oral solution (NEORAL), or in a 0.05% ophthalmic emulsion.
  • Typically, patient dosage of an oral cyclosporine varies according to the patient's condition, but some standard recommended dosages are provided herein. Patients undergoing organ transplant typically receive an initial dose of oral cyclosporine A in amounts between 12 and 15 mg/kg/day. Dosage is then gradually decreased by 5% per week until a 7-12 mg/kg/day maintenance dose is reached. For intravenous administration 2-6 mg/kg/day is preferred for most patients. For patients diagnosed as having Crohn's disease or ulcerative colitis, dosage amounts from 6-8 mg/kg/day are generally given. For patients diagnosed as having systemic lupus erythematosus, dosage amounts from 2.2-6.0 mg/kg/day are generally given. For psoriasis or rheumatoid arthritis, dosage amounts from 0.5-4 mg/kg/day are typical. A suggested dosing schedule is shown in Table 5. Other useful dosages include 0.5-5 mg/kg/day, 5-10 mg/kg/day, 10-15 mg/kg/day, 15-20 mg/kg/day, or 20-25 mg/kg/day.
    TABLE 5
    Atopic
    Compound Dermatitis Psoriasis RA Crohn's UC Transplant SLE
    CsA N/A 0.5-4 0.5-4 6-8 6-8 ˜7-12 2.2-6.0
    (NEORAL) mg/kg/day mg/kg/day mg/kg/day mg/kg/day mg/kg/day mg/kg/day
    (oral-fistulizing) (oral)
    Tacrolimus 0.03-0.1% 0.05-1.15 1-3 0.1-0.2 0.1-0.2 0.1-0.2 N/A
    cream/twice mg/kg/day mg/day mg/kg/day mg/kg/day mg/kg/day
    day (30 and (oral) (oral) (oral) (oral) (oral)
    60 gram tubes)
    Pimecrolimus 1% 40-60 40-60  80-160 160-240  40-120  40-120
    cream/twice mg/day mg/day mg/day mg/day mg/day mg/day
    day (15, 30, (oral) (oral) (oral) (oral) (oral) (oral)
    100 gram tubes)

    CsA = cyclosporine A

    RA = rheumatoid arthritis

    UC = ulcerative colitis

    SLE = systemic lupus erythamatosus
  • The lowest approved ophthalmic concentration of cyclosporine A is 0.05%. Low concentrations of cyclosporine A are 0.04%, or more preferably 0.03%, 0.02%, 0.01%, 0.008%, 0.005%, or 0.001%. The lowest standard recommended ophthalmic dosage of cyclosporine A is 0.2 μg twice daily.
  • Tacrolimus
  • Tacrolimus (FK506) is an immunosuppressive agent that targets T cell intracellular signal transduction pathways. Tacrolimus binds to an intracellular protein FK506 binding protein (FKBP-12) that is not structurally related to cyclophilin. The FKBP/FK506 complex binds to calcineurin and inhibits calcineurin's phosphatase activity. This inhibition prevents the dephosphorylation and nuclear translocation of nuclear factor of activated T cells (NFAT), a nuclear component that initiates gene transcription required for proinflammatory cytokine (e.g., IL-2, gamma interferon) production and T cell activation. Thus, tacrolimus inhibits T cell activation.
  • Tacrolimus is a macrolide antibiotic that is produced by Streptomyces tsukubaensis. It suppresses the immune system and prolongs the survival of transplanted organs. It is currently available in oral and injectable formulations. Tacrolimus capsules contain 0.5 mg, 1 mg, or 5 mg of anhydrous tacrolimus within a gelatin capsule shell. The injectable formulation contains 5 mg anhydrous tacrolimus in castor oil and alcohol that is diluted with 0.9% sodium chloride or 5% dextrose prior to injection. While oral administration is preferred, patients unable to take oral capsules may receive injectable tacrolimus. The initial dose should be administered no sooner than six hours after transplant by continuous intravenous infusion.
  • Tacrolimus and tacrolimus analogs are described by Tanaka et al., (J. Am. Chem. Soc., 109:5031, 1987) and in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,894,366, 4,929,611, and 4,956,352. FK506-related compounds, including FR-900520, FR-900523, and FR-900525, are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,254,562; O-aryl, O-alkyl, O-alkenyl, and O-alkynylmacrolides are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,250,678, 532,248, 5,693,648; amino O-aryl macrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,262,533; alkylidene macrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,284,840; N-heteroaryl, N-alkylheteroaryl, N-alkenylheteroaryl, and N-alkynylheteroaryl macrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,208,241; aminomacrolides and derivatives thereof are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,208,228; fluoromacrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,189,042; amino O-alkyl, O-alkenyl, and O-alkynylmacrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,162,334; and halomacrolides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,143,918.
  • While suggested dosages will vary with a patient's condition, standard recommended dosages are provided below. Typically patients diagnosed as having Crohn's disease or ulcerative colitis are administered 0.1-0.2 mg/kg/day oral tacrolimus. Patients having a transplanted organ typically receive doses of 0.1-0.2 mg/kg/day of oral tacrolimus. Patients being treated for rheumatoid arthritis typically receive 1-3 mg/day oral tacrolimus. For the treatment of psoriasis, 0.01-0.15 mg/kg/day of oral tacrolimus is administered to a patient. Atopic dermatitis can be treated twice a day by applying a cream having 0.03-0.1% tacrolimus to the affected area. Patients receiving oral tacrolimus capsules typically receive the first dose no sooner than six hours after transplant, or eight to twelve hours after intravenous tacrolimus infusion was discontinued. Other suggested tacrolimus dosages include 0.005-0.01 mg/kg/day, 0.01-0.03 mg/kg/day, 0.03-0.05 mg/kg/day, 0.05-0.07 mg/kg/day, 0.07-0.10 mg/kg/day, 0.10-0.25 mg/kg/day, or 0.25-0.5 mg/kg/day.
  • Tacrolimus is extensively metabolized by the mixed-function oxidase system, in particular, by the cytochrome P-450 system. The primary mechanism of metabolism is demethylation and hydroxylation. While various tacrolimus metabolites are likely to exhibit immunosuppressive biological activity, the 13-demethyl metabolite is reported to have the same activity as tacrolimus.
  • Pimecrolimus
  • Pimecrolimus is the 33-epi-chloro derivative of the macrolactam ascomyin. Pimecrolimus structural and functional analogs are described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,384,073. Pimecrolimus is particularly useful for the treatment of atopic dermatitis. Pimecrolimus is currently available as a 1% cream. Suggested dosing schedule for pimecrolimus is shown at Table 5. While individual dosing will vary with the patient's condition, some standard recommended dosages are provided below. Oral pimecrolimus can be given for the treatment of psoriasis or rheumatoid arthritis in amounts of 40-60 mg/day. For the treatment of Crohn's disease or ulcerative colitis amounts of 80-160 mg/day pimecrolimus can be given. Patients having an organ transplant can be administered 160-240 mg/day of pimecrolimus. Patients diagnosed as having systemic lupus erythamatosus can be administered 40-120 mg/day of pimecrolimus. Other useful dosages of pimecrolimus include 0.5-5 mg/day, 5-10 mg/day, 10-30 mg/day, 40-80 mg/day, 80-120 mg/day, or even 120-200 mg/day.
  • Rapamycin
  • Rapamycin is a cyclic lactone produced by Streptomyces hygroscopicus. Rapamycin is an immunosuppressive agent that inhibits T cell activation and proliferation. Like cyclosporines and tacrolimus, rapamycin forms a complex with the immunophilin FKBP-12, but the rapamycin-FKBP-12 complex does not inhibit calcineurin phosphatase activity. The rapamycin immunophilin complex binds to and inhibits the mammalian kinase target of rapamycin (mTOR). mTOR is a kinase that is required for cell-cycle progression. Inhibition of mTOR kinase activity blocks T cell activation and proinflammatory cytokine secretion.
  • Rapamycin structural and functional analogs include mono- and diacylated rapamycin derivatives (U.S. Pat. No. 4,316,885); rapamycin water-soluble prodrugs (U.S. Pat. No. 4,650,803); carboxylic acid esters (PCT Publication No. WO 92/05179); carbamates (U.S. Pat. No. 5,118,678); amide esters (U.S. Pat. No. 5,118,678); biotin esters (U.S. Pat. No. 5,504,091); fluorinated esters (U.S. Pat. No. 5,100,883); acetals (U.S. Pat. No. 5,151,413); silyl ethers (U.S. Pat. No. 5,120,842); bicyclic derivatives (U.S. Pat. No. 5,120,725); rapamycin dimers (U.S. Pat. No. 5,120,727); O-aryl, O-alkyl, O-alkyenyl and O-alkynyl derivatives (U.S. Pat. No. 5,258,389); and deuterated rapamycin (U.S. Pat. No. 6,503,921). Additional rapamycin analogs are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,202,332 and 5,169,851.
  • Rapamycin is currently available for oral administration in liquid and tablet formulations. RAPAMUNE liquid contains 1 mg/mL rapamycin that is diluted in water or orange juice prior to administration. Tablets containing 1 or 2 mg of rapamycin are also available. Rapamycin is preferably given once daily as soon as possible after transplantation. It is absorbed rapidly and completely after oral administration. Typically, patient dosage of rapamycin varies according to the patient's condition, but some standard recommended dosages are provided below. The initial loading dose for rapamycin is 6 mg. Subsequent maintenance doses of 0.5-2 mg/day are typical. Alternatively, a loading dose of 3 mg, 5 mg, 10 mg, 15 mg, 20 mg, or 25 mg can be used with a 1 mg, 3 mg, 5 mg, 7 mg, or 10 mg per day maintenance dose. In patients weighing less than 40 kg, rapamycin dosages are typically adjusted based on body surface area; generally a 3 mg/m2/day loading dose and a 1 mg/m2/day maintenance dose is used.
  • Peptide Moieties
  • Peptides, peptide mimetics, peptide fragments, either natural, synthetic or chemically modified, that impair the calcineurin-mediated dephosphorylation and nuclear translocation of NFAT are suitable for use in practicing the invention. Examples of peptides that act as calcineurin inhibitors by inhibiting the NFAT activation and the NFAT transcription factor are described, e.g., by Aramburu et al., Science 285:2129-2133, 1999) and Aramburu et al., Mol. Cell. 1:627-637, 1998). As a class of calcineurin inhibitors, these agents are useful in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Phosphodiesterase Inhibitors
  • In certain embodiments, a phosphodiesterase inhibitor may be employed in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Suitable phosphodiesterase inhibitors include inhibitors of the type III phosphodiesterases (cAMP-specific-cGMP inhibitable form), the type IV phosphodiesterases (high affinity-high specificity cAMP form) and the type V phosphodiesterases (the cGMP specific form). Examples of type III phosphodiesterase inhibitors include bipyridines such as mihinone and aminone, imidazolones such as piroximone and enoximone, dihydropyridazinones such as imazodan, 5-methylimazodan, indolidan and ICI118233 (6-(p-(3-methylureido)phenyl)-3(2H)-pyridazinone), quinolinone compounds such as cilostamide, cilostazol and vesnarinone, and other compounds such as bemoradan, anergrelide, siguazodan, trequensin, pimobendan, SKF-94120 (5-(4-acetamidophenyl)pyrazin-2-(1H)-one), SKF-95654, lixazinone and isomazole. Examples of type IV phosphodiesterase inhibitors include rolipram and rolipram derivatives such as RO-20-1724 (4-(3-butyloxy-4-methoxyphenyl)-imidazolidinone), nitraquazone and nitraquazone derivatives such as CP-77059 (1-(carbomethoxyphenyl)-3-benzylpyrido[2,3d]pyrimidine-2,4(1H,3H)dione), and RS-25344-00 (1-(3-nitrophenyl)-3-(4-pyridylmethyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro pyrido(2,3-d) pyrimidine-2,4-dione)), xanthine derivatives such as denbufylline and ICI63197, and miscellaneous other compounds such as EMD54622 (5-[1-(3,4-dimethoxybenzoyl)-4,4-dimethyl-1,2,3,4-tetrahydrochinolin-6-yl]-6-methyl-3,6-dihydro-1,3,4-thiadiazin-2-one), LAS-31025 (1-propyl-3-(4-chlorophenyl) xanthine; also referred to as arofylline) and etazolate. Examples of type V phosphodiesterase inhibitors include zaprinast, MY5445 (N-(3-chlorophenyl)-4-phenyl-1-phthalazinamine), dipyridamole, and sildenafil. Sildenafil (5-[2-ethoxy-5-(4-methyl-1-piperazinylsulfonyl)-phenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propy 1-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one) and other suitable type V phosphodiesterase inhibitors are disclosed in PCT Publication Nos. WO 94/28902 and WO 96/16644 (e.g., 5-(2-ethoxy-5-morpholinoacetyl-phenyl)-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-(5-morpholino-acetyl-2-n-propoxyphenyl)-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-[2-ethoxy-5-(4-methyl-1-piperazinylsulfonyl)-phenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-[2-allyloxy-5-(4-methyl-1-piperazinylsulfonyl)-phenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-[2-ethoxy-5-[4-(2-propyl)-1-piperazinylsulfonyl)-phenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-[2-ethoxy-5-[4-(2-hydroxyethyl)-1-piperazinylsulfonyl)phenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-[5-[4-(2-hydroxyethyl)-1-piperazinylsulfonyl]-2-n-propoxyphenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-[2-ethoxy-5-(4-methyl-1-piperazinylcarbonyl)phenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 5-[2-ethoxy-5-(1-methyl-2-imidazolyl)phenyl]-1-methyl-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidin-7-one, 1,3-dimethyl-5-benzylpyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidine-7-one, 2-(2-propoxyphenyl)-6-purinone, 6-(2-propoxyphenyl)-1,2-dihydro-2-oxypyridine-3-carboxamide, 2-(2-propoxyphenyl)-pyrido[2,3-d]pyrimid-4(3H)-one, 7-methylthio-4-oxo-2-(2-propoxyphenyl)-3,4-dihydro-pyrimido[4,5-d]pyrimidine, 6-hydroxy-2(2-propoxyphenyl)-pyrimidine-4-carboxamide, 1-ethyl-3-methylimidazo[1,5a]quinoxalin-4(5H)-one, 4-phenyl-methylamino-6-chloro-2-(1-imidazoloyl)quinazoline, 5-ethyl-8-[3-(N-cyclohexyl-N-methyl-carbamoyl)-propyloxy]-4,5-dihydro-4-oxo-pyrido[3,2-e]-pyrrolo[1,2-a]pyrazine, 5′-methyl-3′-(phenylmethyl)-spiro[cyclopentane-1,7′(8′H)-(3′H)-imidazo[2,1-b]purin]4′(5′H)-one, 1-[6-chloro-4-(3,4-methylenedioxybenzyl)-aminoquinazolin-2-yl)piperidine-4-carboxylic acid, (6R,9S)-2-(4-trifluoromethyl-phenyl)methyl-5-methyl-3,4,5,6a,7,8,9,9a-octahydr ocyclopent[4,5]-imidazo[2,1-b]-purin-4-one, 1-t-butyl-3-phenylmethyl-6-(4-pyridyl)pyrazolo[3,4-d]-pyrimid-4-one, 1-cyclopentyl-3-methyl-6-(4-pyridyl)-4,5-dihydro-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimid-4-one, 2-butyl-1-(2-chlorobenzyl)-6-ethoxy-carbonylbenzimidaole, and 2-(4-carboxypiperidino)-4-(3,4-methylene-dioxybenzyl)amino-6-nitroquinazoline, and 2-phenyl-8-ethoxycycloheptimidazole. Still other type V phosphodiesterase inhibitors useful in conjunction with the present invention are IC-351 (ICOS), also referred to as tadalafil, 4-bromo-5-(pyridylmethylamino)-6-[3-(4-chlorophenyl)-propoxy]-3(2H)pyridazinone, 1-[4-[(1,3-benzodioxol-5-ylmethyl)amiono]-6-chloro-2-quinazolinyl]-4-piperidine-carboxylic acid, monosodium salt, (+)-cis-5,6a,7,9,9,9a-hexahydro-2-[4-(trifluoromethyl)-phenylmethyl-5-methyl-cyclopent-4,5]imidazo[2,1-b]purin-4(3H)one, furazlocillin, cis-2-hexyl-5-methyl-3,4,5,6a,7,8,9,9a-octahydrocyclopent[4,5]imidazo[2,1-b]purin-4-one, 3-acetyl-1-(2-chlorobenzyl)-2-propylindole-6-carboxylate, 4-bromo-5-(3-pyridylmethylamino)-6-(3-(4-chlorophenyl)-propoxy)-3-(2H)pyridazinone, 1-methyl-5-(5-morpholinoacetyl-2-n-propoxyphenyl)-3-n-propyl-1,6-dihydro-7H-pyrazolo(4,3-d)pyrimidin-7-one, 1-[4-[(1,3-benzodioxol-5-ylmethyl)amino]-6-chloro-2-quinazolinyl]-4-piperidinecarboxylic acid, monosodium salt, Pharmaprojects No. 4516 (Glaxo Wellcome) Pharmaprojects No. 5051 (Bayer), Pharmaprojects No. 5064 (Kyowa Hakko; see WO 96/26940) Pharmaprojects No. 5069 (Schering Plough), and Sch-51866. Other phosphodiesterase inhibitors are disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 6,469,016.
  • Other phosphodiesterase inhibitors that may be used in the present invention include filaminast, piclamilast, Org 20241, MCI-154, roflumilast, toborinone, posicar, pyrazolopyrimidinones (such as those disclosed in WO 98/49166), motapizone, pimobendan, zardaverine, siguazodan, CI 930, EMD 53998, imazodan, saterinone, loprinone hydrochloride, 3-pyridinecarbonitrile derivatives, albifylline, torbafylline, doxofylline, theophylline, pentoxofylline, nanterinone, cilostazol, cilostamide, MS 857, piroximone, milrinone, anrinone, tolafentrine, papaverine, E4021, thienopyrimidine derivatives (such as those disclosed in PCT Publication No. WO 98/17668), triflusal, tetrahydropiperazino[1,2-b]beta-carboline-1,4-dione derivatives (such as those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,859,006 and PCT Publication Nos. WO 97/03985 and WO 97/03675), carboline derivatives, (such as those disclosed in PCT Publication No. WO 97/43287), 2-pyrazolin-5-one derivatives (such as those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,869,516), fused pyridazine derivatives (such as those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,849,741), quinazoline derivatives (such as those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,614,627), anthranilic acid derivatives (such as those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,714,993), and imidazoquinazoline derivatives (such as those disclosed in PCT Publication No. WO 96/26940). Also included are phosphodiesterase inhibitors disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,850,941, 4,097,483, 4,193,926, 4,578,392, 4,925,849, 4,994,453, and 5,296,490, and PCT Publication Nos. WO 99/21562, and WO 99/30697.
  • Alpha-2-adrenergic Agonists
  • Alpha-2-adrenergic agonists can be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. An exemplary alpha-2-adrenergic agonist is brimonidine (5-bromo-N-(4,5-dihydro-1H-imidazil-2-yl)-6-quinoxalinamine), described in U.S. Pat. No. 3,890,319. Other alpha-2-adrenergic agonists that can be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include apraclonidine, clonidine, dexmedetomidine, guanabenz, guanfacine, medetomidine, methyldopa, oxymetazoline, tizanidine, and (±)-(R,S)-5,6-diisobutyryloxy-2-methylaminotetralin. Other alpha-2-adrenergic agonists are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 2,868,818; 3,158,648; 3,202,660; 3,632,645; 3,843,668; 3,890,319; 4,029,792; 4,486,432; 4,517,199; 4,576,954; 4,910,214; 5,021,410, 5,037,829; 5,077,292, 5,091,528; 5,112,822; 5,130,441; 5,180,721; 5,198,442; 5,204,347; 5,215,991; 5,231,096; 5,237,072; 5,252,595; 5,281,591; 5,300,504; 5,326,763; 5,373,010; 5,418,234; 5,478,858; 5,541,210; 5,552,403; 5,561,132; 5,576,437; 5,578,607; 5,580,892; 5,587,376; 5,684,156; 5,691,370; 5,703,077; 5,708,015; 5,714,966; 5,739,148; 5,756,503; 5,773,440; 5,804,587; 5,834,470; 5,856,329; 5,914,342; 5,916,900; 5,965,595; 6,066,740; 6,110,952; 6,117,871; 6,162,818; 6,172,095; 6,194,415; 6,225,331; 6,242,442; 6,248,741; 6,294,563; 6,306,877; 6,316,441; 6,316,637; 6,323,204; 6,391,878; 6,395,764; 6,403,626; 6,423,724; 6,436,978; 6,436,982; 6,465,464; 6,486,190; 6,495,583; 6,562,873; 6,627,210; 6,641,834; 6,673,337; and 6,953,813.
  • For ophthalmic uses, brimonidine is available as brimonidine tartrate ophthalmic solution 0.2%.
  • Prostaglandins
  • Prostaglandins may be used in the methods, compostions, and kits of the invention. Prostaglandins include alprostidil, dinoprostone, misoprostil, limaprost, bimatoprost, travoprost, unoprostone, latanoprost, prostaglandin E2, prostaglandin A1, prostaglandin A2, prostaglandin B1, prostaglandin B2, prostaglandin D2, prostaglandin F1α, prostaglandin F2α, prostaglandin I1, prostaglandin-ici 74205, prostaglandin F2β, 6-keto-prostaglandin F1α, prostaglandin E1 ethyl ester, prostaglandin E1 methyl ester, prostaglandin F2 methyl ester, arbaprostil, ornoprostil, 13,14-dihydroprostaglandin F2α, and prostaglandin J. Ophthalmic formulations of prostaglandins include bimatoprost 0.03%, travoprost 0.004%, unoprostone 0.15%, and latanoprost 0.005%.
  • Tetra-Substituted Pyrimidopyrimidines
  • In certain embodiments, a tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine or an adenosine activity upregulator can be used in combination with a second agent in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. By “tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine” is meant a compound having the formula (V):
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00009

    wherein each Z and each Z′ is, independently, N, O, C,
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00010
  • When Z or Z′ is O or
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00011

    then p=1, when Z or Z′ is N,
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00012

    then p=2, and when Z or Z′ is C, then p=3. In formula (V), each R1 is, independently, X, OH, N-alkyl (wherein the alkyl group has 1 to 20, more preferably 1-5, carbon atoms); a branched or unbranched alkyl group having 1 to 20, more preferably 1-5, carbon atoms; or a heterocycle, preferably as defined in formula (V). Alternatively, when p>1, two R1 groups from a common Z or Z′ atom, in combination with each other, may represent —(CY2)k— in which k is an integer between 4 and 6, inclusive. Each X is, independently, Y, CY3, C(CY3)3, CY2CY3, (CY2)1-5OY, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkane of the structure CnY2n-1, wherein n=3-7, inclusive. Each Y is, independently, H, F, Cl, Br, or I. In one embodiment, each Z is the same moiety, each Z′ is the same moiety, and Z and Z′ are different moieties.
  • By “adenosine activity upregulator” is meant adenosine and any compounds that mimic or potentiate the physiological effects of adenosine, such as adenosine receptor agonists, adenosine transport inhibitors, adenosine kinase inhibitors, and phosphodiesterase (PDE) inhibitors, as described herein.
  • Adenosine Receptor Agonists
  • Adenosine receptor agonists include adenosine hemisulfate salt, adenosine amine congener solid, N6-(4-amino-3-iodophenyl)methyl-5′-N-methylcarboxamidoadenosine (1-AB-MECA); N-((2-methylphenyl)methyl)adenosine (Metrifudil); 2-(1-hexynyl)-N-methyladenosine (HEMADO); N-(1-methyl-2-phenylethyl)adenosine (R-PIA); N6—(R-4-hydroxyphenylisopropyl) adenosine (HPIA); N6-cyclopentyladenosine (CPA); N6-cyclopentyl-2-(3-phenylaminocarbonyltriazene-1-yl)adenosine (TCPA); N-((1S,trans)-2-hydroxycyclopentyl)adenosine (GR 79236); N6-cyclohexyladenosine (CHA); 2-chloro-N-cyclopentyladenosine (CCPA); N-ethylcarboxamidoadenosine (NECA); 2-(4-(2-carboxyethyl)phenethylamino)-5′-N-ethylcarboxamidoadenosine (CGS 21680); N6-(3-iodobenzyl)-5′-N-methylcarboxamidoadenosine (IB-MECA); 2-(cyclohexylmethylidene hydrazino)adenosine (WRC 0470); 2-(4-(2-carboxyethyl)phenethylamino)-5′-N-ethylcarboxamidoadenosine (CGS 21680); N6-(2-(3,5-dimethoxyphenyl)-2-(2-methylphenyl)ethyl)adenosine (DPMA); hexynyladenosine-5′-N-ethylcarboxamide (HE-NECA); 2-[(2-aminoethyl-aminocarbonylethyl) phenylethylamino]-5′-N-ethyl-carboxamidoadenosine (APEC); 2-chloro-N6-(3-iodobenzyl)-5′-N-methylcarboxamidoadenosine (2-C-IB-MECA); 2-phenylaminoadenosine (CV 1808); 3′-Aminoadenosine-5′-uronamides; CV Therapuetics™ small molecule drugs Tecadenoson (CVT-510); Regadenoson (CVT 3146); and Carisa (CVT 3033); and Aderis Pharmaceuticals™ small drug molecules 2-[2-(4-chlorophenyl)ethoxy]adenosine (MRE 0094), 1-deoxy-1-[6-[[(iodophenyl)methyl]amino]-9H-purine-9-yl]-N-methyl-(-D-ribofuranuronamide) (CF101), Selodenoson (DTI-0009) and Binodenoson (MRE-0470). Other adenosine receptor agonists are those described or claimed in Gao et al., JPET, 298: 209-218 (2001); U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,278,150, 5,877,180, 6,232,297; U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2005/0261236, and PCT Publication No. WO/9808855, incorporated herein by reference.
  • Adenosine Transport Inhibitors
  • Adenosine transport inhibitors that can be employed in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include 3-[1-(6,7-diethoxy-2-morpholinoquinazolin-4-yl)piperidin-4-yl]-1,6-dimethyl-2,4(1H,3H)-quinazolinedione hydrochloride (KF24345); 6-(4-nitrobenzyl)-thioinosine (NBI) and 6-(2-hydroxy-5-nitrobenzyl)-thioguanosine (NBG); 6-[4-(1-cyclohexyl-1H-tetrazol-5-yl)butoxy]-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-quinolinone (Cilostazol); (2-amino-4,5-dimethyl-3-thienyl)-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]methanone (PD 81723); 3,7-dihydro-3-methyl-1-(5-oxohexyl)-7-propyl-1H-purine-2,6-dione (propentofylline); 6-[(4-nitrobenzyl)thio]-9-β-D-ribofuranosylpurine (nitrobenzylthioinosine) (NBMR); 3,4,5-trimethoxy-, (tetrahydro-1H-1,4-diazepine-1,4(5H)-diyl)di-3,1-propanediyl benzoic acid, ester (dilazep); hexobendine; dipyridamole; and adenosine transport inhibitors described in Fredholm, J. Neurochem. 62:563-573 (1994), Noji et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 300:200-205 (2002); and Crawley et al.; Neurosci Lett. 36:169-174 (1983), each of which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • Adenosine Kinase Inhibitors
  • Adenosine kinase inhibitors can be used as adenosine activity upregulators in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Adenosine kinase inhibitors are generally described as either nucleoside-like, or nonnucleoside-like.
  • Nucleoside-Like Adenosine Kinase Inhibitors
  • Nucleoside-like adenosine kinase inhibitors that can be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include 5-iodotubercidin (5IT) and 2-diaryltubercidin analogues; 5′-deoxo-5′-deoxy-5-iodotubercidin (5′d-5IT); and 5′-deoxo-5′-aminoadenosine (NH2dADO). Other nucleoside-like adenosine kinase inhibitors are described in McGaraughty et al., Current Topics in Medicinal Chemistry 5:43-58 (2005); Ugarkar, J. Med. Chem. 43:2883-2893 (2000); Ugarkar et al., J. Med. Chem. 43:2894-2905 (2000); Kaplan and Coyle, Eur. J. Pharmacol. 1:1-8 (1998); and Sinclair et al. Br. J. Pharmacol. 5:1037-1044 (2001), each of which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • Nonnucleoside-Like Adenosine Kinase Inhibitors
  • Nonnucleoside-like adenosine kinase inhibitors that can be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include 5-bromopyrrolopyrrolidine; 4-amino-5-(3-bromophenyl)-7-(6-morpholino-pyridin-3-yl)pyrido[2,3-d]pyrimidine (ABT-702). Other nonnucleoside-like AK inhibitors are described in McGaraughty et al., Current Topics in Medicinal Chemistry 5:43-58 (2005), Gomtsyan and Lee, Current Pharmaceutical Design 10:1093-1103 (2004); Jarvis et al. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther. 295:1156-1164 (2000); Kowaluk, et al. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther. 295:1165-1174 (2000); and German Patent Application DE 10141212 A1, each of which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • Phosphodiesterase Inhibitors
  • Several isozymes of phosphodiesterases act as regulatory switches by catalyzing the degradation of cAMP to adenosine-5-monophosphate (5′-AMP). Inhibitors of phosphodiesterases can lead to an increase in cAMP levels, which in turn can lead to an increase in antiinflammatory actions.
  • Type I Phosphodiesterase Inhibitors
  • Type I PDE inhibitors include (3-alpha,16-alpha)-eburnamenine-14-carboxylic acid ethyl ester (Vinpocetine); 18-methoxymethyl-3-isobutyl-1-methylxantine (MIMX); 1-carboxy-2,3,4,4a,4b,5,6,6a,6b,7,8,8a,8b,9,10,10a,14,16,17,17a,17b,18,19,19a,19b,20,21,21a,21b,22,23,23a-dotriacontahydro-14-hydroxy-8a,10a-bis(hydroxymethyl)-14-(3-methoxy-3-oxopropyl)-1,4,4a, 6,6a,17b,19b,21b-octamethyl beta-D-glucopyranosiduronic acid (Ks-505a); cis-5,6a,7,8,9,9a-hexahydro-2-(4-(trifluoromethyl)phenylmethyl)-5-methyl-cyclopent (4,5)imidazo[2,1-b]purin-4(3H)-one (SCH 51866); and 2-o-propoxyphenyl-8-azapurine-6-one (Zaprinast). Other Type I PDE inhibitors are described in U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2004/0259792 and 2005/0075795.
  • Type II Phosphodiesterase Inhibitors
  • Type II PDE inhibitors include erythro-9-(2-hydroxy-3-nonyl)adenine (EHNA); 2,3,6,7-tetrahydro-9,10-dimethoxy-3-methyl-2-((2,4,6-trimethylphenyl)imino)-4H-pyrimido(6,1-a)isoquinolin-4-one (trequinsin); ND7001 (Neuro3D Pharmaceuticals); and BAY 60-7550 (Alexis Biochemicals). Other Type II PDE inhibitors are described in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2003/0176316.
  • Type III Phosphodiesterase Inhibitors
  • Type III PDE inhibitors include 3-isobutyl-1-methylxanthine (IBMX); 6-dihydro-2-methyl-6-oxo-3,4′-bipyridine)-5-carbonitrile (milrinone) and N-cyclohexyl-4-((1,2-dihydro-2-oxo-6-quinolinyl)oxy)-N-methyl-butanamide (cilostamide). Other Type III PDE inhibitors are described in the following patents and patent applications: EP 0 653 426, EP 0 294 647, EP 0 357 788, EP 0 220 044, EP 0 326 307, EP 0 207 500, EP 0 406 958, EP 0 150 937, EP 0 075 463, EP 0 272 914, and EP 0 112 987, U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,963,561; 5,141,931, 6,897,229, and 6,156,753; U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2003/0158133, 2004/0097593, 2006/0030611, and 2006/0025463; WO 96/15117; DE 2825048; DE 2727481; DE 2847621; DE 3044568; DE 2837161; and DE 3021792.
  • Type IV Phosphodiesterase Inhibitors
  • Type IV PDE inhibitors include 4-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxyphenyl)-2-pyrrolidone (rolipram) and 4-(3-butoxy-4-methoxybenzyl)-2-imidazolidinone (Ro20-1724). Other Type IV PDE inhibitors are described in the following patents, patent applications, and references: U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,892,777, 4,193,926, 4,655,074, 4,965,271, 5,096,906, 5,124,455, 5,272,153, 6,569,890, 6,953,853, 6,933,296, 6,919,353, 6,953,810, 6,949,573, 6,909,002, and 6,740,655; U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2003/0187052, 2003/0187257, 2003/0144300, 2003/0130254, 2003/0186974, 2003/0220352, 2003/0134876, 2004/0048903, 2004/0023945, 2004/0044036, 2004/0106641, 2004/0097593, 2004/0242643, 2004/0192701, 2004/0224971, 2004/0220183, 2004/0180900, 2004/0171798, 2004/0167199, 2004/0146561, 2004/0152754, 2004/0229918, 2005/0192336, 2005/0267196, 2005/0049258, 2006/0014782, 2006/0004003, 2006/0019932, 2005/0267196, 2005/0222207, 2005/0222207, 2006/0009481; PCT Publication No. WO 92/079778; and Molnar-Kimber, K. L. et al. J. Immunol, 150:295 A (1993).
  • Type V Phosphodiesterase Inhibitors
  • Type V PDE inhibitors are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,992,192, 6,984,641, 6,960,587, 6,943,166, 6,878,711, and 6,869,950, and U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2003/0144296, 2003/0171384, 2004/0029891, 2004/0038996, 2004/0186046, 2004/0259792, 2004/0087561, 2005/0054660, 2005/0042177, 2005/0245544, and 2006/0009481.
  • Type VI Phosphodiesterase Inhibitors
  • Type VI PDE inhibitors include those described in U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2004/0259792, 2004/0248957, 2004/0242673, and 2004/0259880.
  • Type VII Phosphodiesterase Inhibitors
  • Type VII PDE inhibitors include those described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,838,559, 6,753,340, 6,617,357, and 6,852,720; U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2003/0186988, 2003/0162802, 2003/0191167, 2004/0214843, and 2006/0009481; PCT Publication WO 00/68230; and Martinez et al., J. Med. Chem. 43:683-689, 2000.
  • Tricyclic Compounds
  • Tricyclic compounds that can be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include amitriptyline, amoxapine, clomipramine, desipramine, dothiepin, doxepin, imipramine, lofepramine, maprotiline, mianserin, mirtazapine, nortriptyline, octriptyline, oxaprotiline, protriptyline, trimipramine, 10-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl)pyrido(4,3-b)(1,4)benzothiazepine; 11-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)-5H-dibenzo(b,e)(1,4)diazepine; 5,10-dihydro-7-chloro-10-(2-(morpholino)ethyl)-11H-dibenzo(b,e)(1,4)diazepin-11-one; 2-(2-(7-hydroxy-4-dibenzo(b,f)(1,4)thiazepine-11-yl-1-piperazinyl)ethoxy)ethanol; 2-chloro-11-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)-5H-dibenzo(b,e)(1,4)diazepine; 4-(11H-dibenz(b,e)azepin-6-yl)piperazine; 8-chloro-11-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)-5H-dibenzo(b,e)(1, 4)diazepin-2-ol; 8-chloro-11-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)-5H-dibenzo(b,e)(1,4)diazepine monohydrochloride; (Z)-2-butenedioate 5H-dibenzo(b,e)(1, 4)diazepine; adinazolam; amineptine; amitriptylinoxide; butriptyline; clothiapine; clozapine; demexiptiline; 11-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)-dibenz(b,f)(1,4)oxazepine; 1′-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)-2-nitro-dibenz(b,f)(1,4)oxazepine; 2-chloro-11-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)-dibenz(b,f)(1,4)oxazepine monohydrochloride; dibenzepin; 11-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)-dibenzo(b,f)(1,4)thiazepine; dimetacrine; fluacizine; fluperlapine; imipramine N-oxide; iprindole; lofepramine; melitracen; metapramine; metiapine; metralindole; mianserin; mirtazapine; 8-chloro-6-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)-morphanthridine; N-acetylamoxapine; nomifensine; norclomipramine; norclozapine; noxiptilin; opipramol; oxaprotiline; perlapine; pizotyline; propizepine; quetiapine; quinupramine; tianeptine; tomoxetine; flupenthixol; clopenthixol; piflutixol; chlorprothixene; and thiothixene. Other tricyclic compounds are described, for example, in U.S. Pat. Nos. 2,554,736; 3,046,283; 3,310,553; 3,177,209; 3,205,264; 3,244,748; 3,271,451; 3,272,826; 3,282,942; 3,299,139; 3,312,689; 3,389,139; 3,399,201; 3,409,640; 3,419,547; 3,438,981; 3,454,554; 3,467,650; 3,505,321; 3,527,766; 3,534,041; 3,539,573; 3,574,852; 3,622,565; 3,637,660; 3,663,696; 3,758,528; 3,922,305; 3,963,778; 3,978,121; 3,981,917; 4,017,542; 4,017,621; 4,020,096; 4,045,560; 4,045,580; 4,048,223; 4,062,848; 4,088,647; 4,128,641; 4,148,919; 4,153,629; 4,224,321; 4,224,344; 4,250,094; 4,284,559; 4,333,935; 4,358,620; 4,548,933; 4,691,040; 4,879,288; 5,238,959; 5,266,570; 5,399,568; 5,464,840; 5,455,246; 5,512,575; 5,550,136; 5,574,173; 5,681,840; 5,688,805; 5,916,889; 6,545,057; and 6,600,065, and phenothiazine compounds that fit Formula (I) of U.S. patent application Ser. Nos. 10/617,424 or 60/504,310.
  • Standard recommended dosages for several tricyclic compounds are provided in Table 6, below. Other standard dosages are provided, e.g., in the Merck Manual of Diagnosis & Therapy (17th Ed. M H Beers et al., Merck & Co.) and Physicians' Desk Reference 2003 (57th Ed. Medical Economics Staff et al., Medical Economics Co., 2002).
    TABLE 6
    Compound Standard Dose
    Amoxapine 200-300 mg/day
    Nortriptyline 75-150 mg/day
    Desipramine 100-200 mg/day

    Selective Serotonin Reuptake Inhibitors
  • SSRIs may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Suitable SSRIs are cericlamine (e.g., cericlamine hydrochloride); citalopram (e.g., citalopram hydrobromide); clovoxamine; cyanodothiepin; dapoxetine; escitalopram (escitalopram oxalate); femoxetine (e.g., femoxetine hydrochloride); fluoxetine (e.g., fluoxetine hydrochloride); fluvoxamine (e.g., fluvoxamine maleate); ifoxetine; indalpine (e.g., indalpine hydrochloride); indeloxazine (e.g., indeloxazine hydrochloride); litoxetine; milnacipran (e.g., minlacipran hydrochloride); paroxetine (e.g., paroxetine hydrochloride hemihydrate; paroxetine maleate; paroxetine mesylate); sertraline (e.g., sertraline hydrochloride); tametraline hydrochloride; viqualine; and zimeldine (e.g., zimeldine hydrochloride).
  • Structural analogs of cericlamine are those having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00013

    as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein R1 is a C1-C4 alkyl and R2 is H or C1-4 alkyl, R3 is H, C1-4 alkyl, C2-4 alkenyl, phenylalkyl or cycloalkylalkyl with 3 to 6 cyclic carbon atoms, alkanoyl, phenylalkanoyl or cycloalkylcarbonyl having 3 to 6 cyclic carbon atoms, or R2 and R3 form, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are linked, a heterocycle saturated with 5 to 7 chain links which can have, as the second heteroatom not directly connected to the nitrogen atom, an oxygen, a sulphur or a nitrogen, the latter nitrogen heteroatom possibly carrying a C2-4 alkyl.
  • Exemplary cericlamine structural analogs are 2-methyl-2-amino-3-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-propanol, 2-pentyl-2-amino-3-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-propanol, 2-methyl-2-methylamino-3-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-propanol, 2-methyl-2-dimethylamino-3-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-propanol, and pharmaceutically acceptable salts of any thereof.
  • Structural analogs of citalopram are those having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00014

    as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein each of R1 and R2 is independently selected from the group consisting of bromo, chloro, fluoro, trifluoromethyl, cyano and R—CO—, wherein R is C1-4 alkyl.
  • Exemplary citalopram structural analogs (which are thus SSRI structural analogs according to the invention) are 1-(4′-fluorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-bromophthalane; 1-(4′-chlorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-chlorophthalane; 1-(4′-bromophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-chlorophthalane; 1-(4′-fluorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-chlorophthalane; 1-(4′-chlorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-trifluoromethyl-phthalane; 1-(4′-bromophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-trifluoromethyl-phthalane; 1-(4′-fluorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-trifluoromethyl-phthalane; 1-(4′-fluorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-fluorophthalane; 1-(4′-chlorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-fluorophthalane; 1-(4′-chlorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-phthalancarbonitrile; 1-(4′-fluorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-phthalancarbonitrile; 1-(4′-cyanophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-phthalancarbonitrile; 1-(4′-cyanophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-chlorophthalane; 1-(4′-cyanophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-trifluoromethylphthalane; 1-(4′-fluorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-phthalancarbonitrile; 1-(4′-chlorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-ionylphthalane; 1-(4-(chlorophenyl)-1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-5-propionylphthalane; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts of any thereof.
  • Structural analogs of clovoxamine are those having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00015

    as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein Hal is a chloro, bromo, or fluoro group and R is a cyano, methoxy, ethoxy, methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, methoxyethoxy, or cyanomethyl group.
  • Exemplary clovoxamine structural analogs are 4′-chloro-5-ethoxyvalerophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-chloro-5-(2-methoxyethoxy)valerophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-chloro-6-methoxycaprophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-chloro-6-ethoxycaprophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-bromo-5-(2-methoxyethoxy)valerophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-bromo-5-methoxyvalerophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-chloro-6-cyanocaprophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-chloro-5-cyanovalerophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; 4′-bromo-5-cyanovalerophenone O-(2-aminoethyl)oxime; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts of any thereof.
  • Structural analogs of femoxetine are those having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00016

    wherein R1 represents a C1-4 alkyl or C2-4 alkynyl group, or a phenyl group optionally substituted by C1-4 alkyl, C1-4 alkylthio, C1-4 alkoxy, bromo, chloro, fluoro, nitro, acylamino, methylsulfonyl, methylenedioxy, or tetrahydronaphthyl, R2 represents a C1-4 alkyl or C2-4 alkynyl group, and R3 represents hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, C1-4alkoxy, trifluoroalkyl, hydroxy, bromo, chloro, fluoro, methylthio, or aralkyloxy.
  • Exemplary femoxetine structural analogs are disclosed in Examples 7-67 of U.S. Pat. No. 3,912,743, hereby incorporated by reference.
  • Structural analogs of fluoxetine are those compounds having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00017

    as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein each R1 is independently hydrogen or methyl; R is naphthyl or
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00018

    wherein each of R2 and R3 is, independently, bromo, chloro, fluoro, trifluoromethyl, C1-4 alkyl, C1-3 alkoxy or C3-4 alkenyl; and each of n and m is, independently, 0, 1 or 2. When R is naphthyl, it can be either α-naphthyl or β-naphthyl.
  • Exemplary fluoxetine structural analogs are 3-(p-isopropoxyphenoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine methanesulfonate, N,N-dimethyl 3-(3′,4′-dimethoxyphenoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine p-hydroxybenzoate, N,N-dimethyl 3-(α-naphthoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine bromide, N,N-dimethyl 3-(β-naphthoxy)-3-phenyl-1-methylpropylamine iodide, 3-(2′-methyl-4′,5′-dichlorophenoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine nitrate, 3-(p-t-butylphenoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine glutarate, N-methyl 3-(2′-chloro-p-tolyloxy)-3-phenyl-1-methylpropylamine lactate, 3-(2′,4′-dichlorophenoxy)-3-phenyl-2-methylpropylamine citrate, N,N-dimethyl 3-(m-anisyloxy)-3-phenyl-1-methylpropylamine maleate, N-methyl 3-(p-tolyloxy)-3-phenylpropylamine sulfate, N,N-dimethyl 3-(2′,4′-difluorophenoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine 2,4-dinitrobenzoate, 3-(o-ethylphenoxy)-3-phenylpropylamine dihydrogen phosphate, N-methyl 3-(2′-chloro-4′-isopropylphenoxy)-3-phenyl-2-methylpropylamine maleate, N,N-dimethyl 3-(2′-alkyl-4′-fluorophenoxy)-3-phenyl-propylamine succinate, N,N-dimethyl 3-(o-isopropoxyphenoxy)-3-phenyl-propylamine phenylacetate, N,N-dimethyl 3-(o-bromophenoxy)-3-phenyl-propylamine β-phenylpropionate, N-methyl 3-(p-iodophenoxy)-3-phenyl-propylamine propiolate, and N-methyl 3-(3-n-propylphenoxy)-3-phenyl-propylamine decanoate.
  • Structural analogs of fluvoxamine are those having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00019

    as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein R is cyano, cyanomethyl, methoxymethyl, or ethoxymethyl.
  • Structural analogs of indalpine are those having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00020

    or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein R1 is a hydrogen atom, a C1-C4 alkyl group, or an aralkyl group of which the alkyl has 1 or 2 carbon atoms, R2 is hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, C1-4 alkoxy or C1-4 alkylthio, chloro, bromo, fluoro, trifluoromethyl, nitro, hydroxy, or amino, the latter optionally substituted by one or two C1-4 alkyl groups, an acyl group or a C1-4alkylsulfonyl group; A represents —CO or —CH2— group; and n is 0, 1 or 2.
  • Exemplary indalpine structural analogs are indolyl-3 (piperidyl-4 methyl) ketone; (methoxy-5-indolyl-3) (piperidyl-4 methyl) ketone; (chloro-5-indolyl-3) (piperidyl-4 methyl) ketone; (indolyl-3)-1(piperidyl-4)-3 propanone, indolyl-3 piperidyl-4 ketone; (methyl-1 indolyl-3) (piperidyl-4 methyl) ketone, (benzyl-1 indolyl-3) (piperidyl-4 methyl) ketone; [(methoxy-5 indolyl-3)-2 ethyl]-piperidine, [(methyl-1 indolyl-3)-2 ethyl]-4-piperidine; [(indolyl-3)-2 ethyl]-4 piperidine; (indolyl-3 methyl)-4 piperidine, [(chloro-5 indolyl-3)-2 ethyl]-4 piperidine; [(indolyl-b 3)-3 propyl]-4 piperidine; [(benzyl-1 indolyl-3)-2 ethyl]-4 piperidine; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts of any thereof.
  • Structural analogs of indeloxazine are those having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00021

    and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein R1 and R3 each represents hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, or phenyl; R2 represents hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, C4-7 cycloalkyl, phenyl, or benzyl; one of the dotted lines means a single bond and the other means a double bond, or the tautomeric mixtures thereof.
  • Exemplary indeloxazine structural analogs are 2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-4-isopropylmorpholine; 4-butyl-2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-4-methylmorpholine; 4-ethyl-2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine, 2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-morpholine; 2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-4-propylmorpholine; 4-cyclohexyl-2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 4-benzyl-2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-morpholine; 2-(7-indenyloxymethyl)-4-phenylmorpholine; 2-(4-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 2-(3-methyl-7-indenyloxymethyl)-morpholine; 4-isopropyl-2-(3-methyl-7-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 4-isopropyl-2-(3-methyl-4-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 4-isopropyl-2-(3-methyl-5-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 4-isopropyl-2-(1-methyl-3-phenyl-6-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; 2-(5-indenyloxymethyl)-4-isopropyl-morpholine, 2-(6-indenyloxymethyl)-4-isopropylmorpholine; and 4-isopropyl-2-(3-phenyl-6-indenyloxymethyl)morpholine; as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts of any thereof.
  • Structural analogs of milnacipram are those having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00022

    as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein each R, independently, represents hydrogen, bromo, chloro, fluoro, C1-4 alkyl, C1-4 alkoxy, hydroxy, nitro or amino; each of R1 and R2, independently, represents hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, C6-12 aryl or C7-14 alkylaryl, optionally substituted, preferably in para position, by bromo, chloro, or fluoro, or R1 and R2 together form a heterocycle having 5 or 6 members with the adjacent nitrogen atoms; R3 and R4 represent hydrogen or a C1-4 alkyl group or R3 and R4 form with the adjacent nitrogen atom a heterocycle having 5 or 6 members, optionally containing an additional heteroatom selected from nitrogen, sulphur, and oxygen.
  • Exemplary milnacipram structural analogs are 1-phenyl 1-aminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-phenyl 1-dimethylaminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-phenyl 1-ethylaminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-phenyl 1-diethylaminocarbonyl 2-aminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-phenyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl N-(4′-chlorophenyl)cyclopropane carboxamide; 1-phenyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl N-(4′-chlorobenzyl)cyclopropane carboxamide; 1-phenyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl N-(2-phenylethyl)cyclopropane carboxamide; (3,4-dichloro-1-phenyl) 2-dimethylaminomethyl N,N-dimethylcyclopropane carboxamide; 1-phenyl 1-pyrrolidinocarbonyl 2-morpholinomethyl cyclopropane; 1-p-chlorophenyl 1-aminocarbonyl 2-aminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-orthochlorophenyl 1-aminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-p-hydroxyphenyl 1-aminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-p-nitrophenyl 1-dimethylaminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-p-aminophenyl 1-dimethylaminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-p-tolyl 1-methylaminocarbonyl 2-dimethylaminomethyl cyclopropane; 1-p-methoxyphenyl 1-aminomethylcarbonyl 2-aminomethyl cyclopropane; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts of any thereof.
  • Structural analogs of paroxetine are those having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00023

    and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein R1 represents hydrogen or a C1-4 alkyl group, and the fluorine atom may be in any of the available positions.
  • Structural analogs of sertraline are those having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00024

    wherein R1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and C1-4 alkyl; R2 is C1-4 alkyl; X and Y are each selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, fluoro, chloro, bromo, trifluoromethyl, C1-3 alkoxy, and cyano; and W is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, fluoro, chloro, bromo, trifluoromethyl and C1-3 alkoxy. Preferred sertraline analogs are in the cis-isomeric configuration. The term “cis-isomeric” refers to the relative orientation of the NR1R2 and phenyl moieties on the cyclohexene ring (i.e. they are both oriented on the same side of the ring). Because both the 1- and 4-carbons are asymmetrically substituted, each cis-compound has two optically active enantiomeric forms denoted (with reference to the 1-carbon) as the cis-(1R) and cis-(1S) enantiomers.
  • Particularly useful are the following compounds, in either the (1S)-enantiomeric or (1S)(1R) racemic forms, and their pharmaceutically acceptable salts: cis-N-methyl-4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-1-naphthalenamine; cis-N-methyl-4-(4-bromophenyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-1-naphthalenamine; cis-N-methyl-4-(4-chlorophenyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-1-naphthalenamine; cis-N-methyl-4-(3-trifluoromethyl-phenyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-1-naphthalenamine; cis-N-methyl-4-(3-trifluoromethyl-4-chlorophenyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-1-naphthalenamine; cis-N,N-dimethyl-4-(4-chlorophenyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-1-naphthalenamine; cis-N,N-dimethyl-4-(3-trifluoromethyl-phenyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-1-naphthalenamine; and cis-N-methyl-4-(4-chlorophenyl)-7-chloro-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-1-naphthalenamine. Of interest also is the (1R)-enantiomer of cis-N-methyl-4-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-1-naphthalenamine.
  • Structural analogs of zimeldine are those compounds having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00025

    and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein the pyridine nucleus is bound in ortho-, meta- or para-position to the adjacent carbon atom and where R1 is selected from the group consisting of H, chloro, fluoro, and bromo.
  • Exemplary zimeldine analogs are (e)- and (z)-3-(4′-bromophenyl-3-(2″-pyridyl)-dimethylallylamine; 3-(4′-bromophenyl)-3-(3″-pyridyl)-dimethylallylamine; 3-(4′-bromophenyl)-3-(4″-pyridyl)-dimethylallylamine; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts of any thereof.
  • Structural analogs of any of the above SSRIs are considered herein to be SSRI analogs and thus may be employed in any of the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention.
  • Metabolites
  • Pharmacologically active metabolites of any of the foregoing SSRIs can also be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Exemplary metabolites are didesmethylcitalopram, desmethylcitalopram, desmethylsertraline, and norfluoxetine.
  • Analogs
  • Functional analogs of SSRIs can also be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Exemplary SSRI functional analogs are provided below. One class of SSRI analogs includes SNRIs (selective serotonin norepinephrine reuptake inhibitors), which include venlafaxine, duloxetine, and 4-(2-fluorophenyl)-6-methyl-2-piperazinothieno[2,3-d]pyrimidine.
  • Structural analogs of venlafaxine are those compounds having the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00026

    as well as pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein A is a moiety of the formula:
    Figure US20070225217A1-20070927-C00027

    where the dotted line represents optional unsaturation; R1 is hydrogen or alkyl; R2 is C1-4 alkyl; R4 is hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, formyl or alkanoyl; R3 is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; R5 and R6 are, independently, hydrogen, hydroxyl, C1-4 alkyl, C1-4 alkoxy, C1-4 alkanoyloxy, cyano, nitro, alkylmercapto, amino, C1-4 alkylamino, dialkylamino, C1-4 alkanamido, halo, trifluoromethyl or, taken together, methylenedioxy; and n is 0, 1, 2, 3 or 4.
  • Structural analogs of duloxetine are those compounds described by the formula disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,956,388, hereby incorporated by reference.
  • Other SSRI analogs are 4-(2-fluorophenyl)-6-methyl-2-piperazinothieno[2,3-d]pyrimidine, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-N-methyl-4-phenyl-1-naphthylamine hydrochloride; 1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-N-methyl-4-phenyl-(E)-1-naphthylamine hydrochloride; N,N-dimethyl-1-phenyl-1-phthalanpropylamine hydrochloride; gamma-(4-(trifluoromethyl)phenoxy)-benzenepropanamine hydrochloride; BP 554; CP 53261; 0-desmethylvenlafaxine; WY 45,818; WY 45,881; N-(3-fluoropropyl)paroxetine; Lu 19005; and SNRIs described in PCT Publication No. WO04/004734.
  • Standard Recommended Dosages
  • Standard recommended dosages for exemplary SSRIs are provided in Table 7, below. Other standard dosages are provided, e.g., in the Merck Manual of Diagnosis & Therapy (17th Ed. M H Beers et al., Merck & Co.) and Physicians' Desk Reference 2003 (57th Ed. Medical Economics Staff et al., Medical Economics Co., 2002).
    TABLE 7
    Compound Standard Dose
    Fluoxetine 20-80 mg/day
    Sertraline 50-200 mg/day
    Paroxetine 20-50 mg/day
    Fluvoxamine 50-300 mg/day
    Citalopram 10-80 mg qid
    Escitalopram 10 mg qid

    Antihistamines
  • In yet another embodiment of the invention, the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention employ a histamine receptor antagonist (or analog thereof). Antihistamines are compounds that block the action of histamine. Classes of antihistamines include:
  • (1) Ethanolamines (e.g., bromodiphenhydramine, carbinoxamine, clemastine, dimenhydrinate, diphenhydramine, diphenylpyraline, and doxylamine);
  • (2) Ethylenediamines (e.g., pheniramine, pyrilamine, tripelennamine, and triprolidine);
  • (3) Phenothiazines (e.g., diethazine, ethopropazine, methdilazine, promethazine, thiethylperazine, and trimeprazine);
  • (4) Alkylamines (e.g., acrivastine, brompheniramine, chlorpheniramine, desbrompheniramine, dexchlorpheniramine, pyrrobutamine, and triprolidine);
  • (5) piperazines (e.g., buclizine, cetirizine, chlorcyclizine, cyclizine, meclizine, hydroxyzine);
  • (6) Piperidines (e.g., astemizole, azatadine, cyproheptadine, desloratadine, fexofenadine, loratadine, ketotifen, olopatadine, phenindamine, and terfenadine);
  • (7) Atypical antihistamines (e.g., azelastine, levocabastine, methapyrilene, and phenyltoxamine).
  • In the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention, both non-sedating and sedating antihistamines may be employed. Particularly desirable antihistamines for use in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention are non-sedating antihistamines such as loratadine and desloratadine. Sedating antihistamines can also be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Preferred sedating antihistamines for use in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention are azatadine, bromodiphenhydramine; chlorpheniramine; clemizole; cyproheptadine; dimenhydrinate; diphenhydramine; doxylamine; meclizine; promethazine; pyrilamine; thiethylperazine; and tripelennamine.
  • Other antihistamines suitable for use in the methods and compositions of the invention are acrivastine; ahistan; antazoline; astemizole; azelastine (e.g., azelsatine hydrochloride); bamipine; bepotastine; bietanautine; brompheniramine (e.g., brompheniramine maleate); carbinoxamine (e.g., carbinoxamine maleate); cetirizine (e.g., cetirizine hydrochloride); cetoxime; chlorocyclizine; chloropyramine; chlorothen; chlorphenoxamine; cinnarizine; clemastine (e.g., clemastine fumarate); clobenzepam; clobenztropine; clocinizine; cyclizine (e.g., cyclizine hydrochloride; cyclizine lactate); deptropine; dexchlorpheniramine; dexchlorpheniramine maleate; diphenylpyraline; doxepin; ebastine; embramine; emedastine (e.g., emedastine difumarate); epinastine; etymemazine hydrochloride; fexofenadine (e.g., fexofenadine hydrochloride); histapyrrodine; hydroxyzine (e.g., hydroxyzine hydrochloride; hydroxyzine pamoate); isopromethazine; isothipendyl; levocabastine (e.g., levocabastine hydrochloride); mebhydroline; mequitazine; methafurylene; methapyrilene; metron; mizolastine; olapatadine (e.g., olopatadine hydrochloride); orphenadrine; phenindamine (e.g., phenindamine tartrate); pheniramine; phenyltoloxamine; p-methyldiphenhydramine; pyrrobutamine; setastine; talastine; terfenadine; thenyldiamine; thiazinamium (e.g., thiazinamium methylsulfate); thonzylamine hydrochloride; tolpropamine; triprolidine; and tritoqualine.
  • Structural analogs of antihistamines may also be used in according to the invention. Antihistamine analogs include, without limitation, 10-piperazinylpropylphenothiazine; 4-(3-(2-chlorophenothiazin-10-yl)propyl)-1-piperazineethanol dihydrochloride; 1-(10-(3-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)propyl)-10H-phenothiazin-2-yl)-(9CI) 1-propanone; 3-methoxycyproheptadine; 4-(3-(2-Chloro-10H-phenothiazin-10-yl)propyl)piperazine-1-ethanol hydrochloride; 10,11-dihydro-5-(3-(4-ethoxycarbonyl-4-phenylpiperidino)propylidene)-5H-dibenzo(a,d)cycloheptene; aceprometazine; acetophenazine; alimemazin (e.g., alimemazin hydrochloride); aminopromazine; benzimidazole; butaperazine; carfenazine; chlorfenethazine; chlormidazole; cinprazole; desmethylastemizole; desmethylcyproheptadine; diethazine (e.g., diethazine hydrochloride); ethopropazine (e.g., ethopropazine hydrochloride); 2-(p-bromophenyl-(p′-tolyl)methoxy)-N,N-dimethyl-ethylamine hydrochloride; N,N-dimethyl-2-(diphenylmethoxy)-ethylamine methylbromide; EX-10-542A; fenethazine; fuprazole; methyl 10-(3-(4-methyl-1-piperazinyl)propyl)phenothiazin-2-yl ketone; lerisetron; medrylamine; mesoridazine; methylpromazine; N-desmethylpromethazine; nilprazole; northioridazine; perphenazine (e.g., perphenazine enanthate); 10-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-2-methylthio-phenothiazine; 4-(dibenzo(b,e)thiepin-6(1H)-ylidene)-1-methyl-piperidine hydrochloride; prochlorperazine; promazine; propiomazine (e.g., propiomazine hydrochloride); rotoxamine; rupatadine; Sch 37370; Sch 434; tecastemizole; thiazinamium; thiopropazate; thioridazine (e.g., thioridazine hydrochloride); and 3-(10,11-dihydro-5H-dibenzo(a,d)cyclohepten-5-ylidene)-tropane.
  • Other compounds that are suitable for use in the invention are AD-0261; AHR-5333; alinastine; arpromidine; ATI-19000; bermastine; bilastin; Bron-12; carebastine; chlorphenamine; clofurenadine; corsym; DF-1105501; DF-11062; DF-1111301; EL-301; elbanizine; F-7946T; F-9505; HE-90481; HE-90512; hivenyl; HSR-609; icotidine; KAA-276; KY-234; lamiakast; LAS-36509; LAS-36674; levocetirizine; levoprotiline; metoclopramide; NIP-531; noberastine; oxatomide; PR-881-884A; quisultazine; rocastine; selenotifen; SK&F-94461; SODAS-HC; tagorizine; TAK-427; temelastine; UCB-34742; UCB-35440; VUF-K-8707; Wy-49051; and ZCR-2060.
  • Still other compounds that are suitable for use in the invention are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,956,296; 4,254,129; 4,254,130; 4,282,833; 4,283,408; 4,362,736; 4,394,508; 4,285,957; 4,285,958; 4,440,933; 4,510,309; 4,550,116; 4,692,456; 4,742,175; 4,833,138; 4,908,372; 5,204,249; 5,375,693; 5,578,610; 5,581,011; 5,589,487; 5,663,412; 5,994,549; 6,201,124; and 6,458,958.
  • Standard Recommended Dosages
  • Standard recommended dosages for several exemplary antihistamines are shown in Table 8. Other standard dosages are provided, e.g., in the Merck Manual of Diagnosis & Therapy (17th Ed. M H Beers et al., Merck & Co.) and Physicians' Desk Reference 2003 (57th Ed. Medical Economics Staff et al., Medical Economics Co., 2002).
    TABLE 8
    Compound Standard Dose
    Desloratadine
    5 mg/once daily
    Thiethylperazine 10 mg/1-3 times daily
    Bromodiphenhydramine 12.5-25 mg/every 4-6 hours
    Promethazine
    25 mg/twice daily
    Cyproheptadine 12-16 mg/day
    Loratadine
    10 mg/once daily
    Clemizole 100 mg given as IV or IM
    Azatadine 1-2 mg/twice daily
    Cetirizine 5-10 mg/once daily
    Chlorpheniramine 2 mg/every 6 hours or 4 mg/every 6 hours
    Dimenhydramine 50-100 mg/every 4-6 hours
    Diphenydramine 25 mg/every 4-6 hours or 38 mg/every 4-6 hours *
    Doxylamine 25 mg/once daily or 12.5 mg/every four hours *
    Fexofenadine 60 mg/twice daily or 180 mg/once daily
    Meclizine 25-100 mg/day
    Pyrilamine
    30 mg/every 6 hours
    Tripelennamine 25-50 mg/every 4 to 6 hours or 100 mg/twice
    daily (extended release) *
  • Loratadine
  • Loratadine (CLARITIN) is a tricyclic piperidine that acts as a selective peripheral histamine H1-receptor antagonist. Loratadine and structural and functional analogs thereof, such as piperidines, tricyclic piperidines, histamine H1-receptor antagonists, may be used in the anti-immunoinflammatory combination of the invention for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders, transplanted organ rejection, and graft versus host disease.
  • Loratadine functional and/or structural analogs include other H1-receptor antagonists, such as AHR-11325, acrivastine, antazoline, astemizole, azatadine, azelastine, bromopheniramine, carebastine, cetirizine, chlorpheniramine, chlorcyclizine, clemastine, cyproheptadine, descarboethoxyloratadine, dexchlorpheniramine, dimenhydrinate, diphenylpyraline, diphenhydramine, ebastine, fexofenadine, hydroxyzine ketotifen, lodoxamide, levocabastine, methdilazine, mequitazine, oxatomide, pheniramine pyrilamine, promethazine, pyrilamine, setastine, tazifylline, temelastine, terfenadine, trimeprazine, tripelennamine, triprolidine, utrizine, and similar compounds (described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,956,296, 4,254,129, 4,254,130, 4,283,408, 4,362,736, 4,394,508, 4,285,957, 4,285,958, 4,440,933, 4,510,309, 4,550,116, 4,692,456, 4,742,175, 4,908,372, 5,204,249, 5,375,693, 5,578,610, 5,581,011, 5,589,487, 5,663,412, 5,994,549, 6,201,124, and 6,458,958).
  • Loratadine, cetirizine, and fexofenadine are second-generation H1-receptor antagonists that lack the sedating effects of many first generation H1-receptor antagonists. Piperidine H1-receptor antagonists include loratadine, cyproheptadine hydrochloride (PERIACTIN), and phenindiamine tartrate (NOLAHIST). Piperazine H1-receptor antagonists include hydroxyzine hydrochloride (ATARAX), hydroxyzine pamoate (VISTARIL), cyclizine hydrochloride (MAREZINE), cyclizine lactate, and meclizine hydrochloride.
  • Standard Recommended Dosages
  • Loratadine oral formulations include tablets, redi-tabs, and syrup. Loratadine tablets contain 10 mg micronized loratadine. Loratadine syrup contains 1 mg/ml micronized loratadine, and reditabs (rapidly-disintegrating tablets) contain 10 mg micronized loratadine in tablets that disintegrate quickly in the mouth. While suggested dosages will vary with a patient's condition, standard recommended dosages are provided below. Loratadine is typically administered once daily in a 10 mg dose, although other daily dosages useful in the anti-immunoinflammatory combination of the invention include 0.01-0.05 mg, 0.05-1 mg, 1-3 mg, 3-5 mg, 5-10 mg, 10-15 mg, 15-20 mg, 20-30 mg, and 30-40 mg.
  • Loratadine is rapidly absorbed following oral administration. It is metabolized in the liver to descarboethoxyloratadine by cytochrome P450 3A4 and cytochrome P450 2D6. Loratadine metabolites are also useful in the anti-immunoinflammatory combination of the invention.
  • Bufexamac
  • Bufexamac (p-butoxyphenylacetydroxamic, 4-butoxyphenylacetohydroxamic) acts as an anti-pruritic and anti-inflammatory drug.
  • Bufexamac analogs include, but are not limited to, 2-(p-propoxyphenyl)acetohydroxamic acid; 2-(4-butoxy-m-tolyl)acetohydroxamic acid; 2-(4-butoxy-3-ethylphenyl)acetohydroxamic acid; 2-(4-butoxy-3-chlorophenyl)acetohydroxamic acid.
  • The indications for bufexamac include but are not limited to eczema, dermatitis, pruritus, and hemorrhoids. Bufexamac is currently available in a cream, oral, gel, ointment, or suppository formulation. The cream is typically used 1 to 3 times daily. Creams, ointments, suppositories, and gels have a concentration of bufexamac ranging from 0.25% to 0.5%. Additionally, oral dosages of bufexamac are often given for patients afflicted with rheumatoid arthritis. In this case, a dosage of bufexamac of 250 mg is given four times a day. Clinical dosages of bufexamac up to 2.0 g per day have been given.
  • Calcium Channel Inhibitors
  • Calcium channel inhibitors may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Calcium channel inhibitors include verapamil, anipamil, bepridil, gallopamil, devapamil, falipamil, tiapamil, nifedipine, amlodipine, dazodipine, felodipine, isradipine, lanicardipine, nicardipine, nimodipine, nisoldipine, nitrendipine, ryosidie, diltiazem, cinnarizine, and flunarizine, BAY-m 4786, and diperdipine.
  • Antidyskinetics
  • Antidyskinetic compounds that may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention include D-AP5 (D(−)-2-amino-5-phosphonopentanoate), CGS19755 (4-phosphonomethyl-2-piperidine carboxylic acid), CGP37849 (D,L-(E)-2-amino-4-methylphosphono-3-pentanoic acid), LY233053 (cis-(.+−.)-4-(2H-tetrazol-5-yl)methyl-piperidine-2-carboxyl acid), AIDA (1-aminoindan-1,5(RS)-dicarboxylic acid), (s)-(+)-CBPG ((S)-(+)-2-(3′-carboxy-bicyclo(1.1.1.)pentyl)glycine), CPCCOEt (cyclopropan(b)chromen-1a-carboxylate), EGLU ((s)-(.alpha.)-ethylglutamate), LY307452 (2s,4s-2-amino-4-(4,4-diphenylbut-1-yl)pentan-1,5-dioc acid), LY341495 (2s-2-amino-2-(1s,2s-2-carboxy-cyclopropan-1-yl)-3-(xanth-9-yl)propanoic acid), PCCG-4 (2s,1′s,2′s,3′R)-2-(2′-carboxy-3′-phenylcyclo-propyl)glycine), 4-CPG (4-carboxyphenylglycine), remacemide, dextromethorphan ((+)-3-hydroxy-N-methylmorphinan), its metabolite dextrorphan ((+)-3-hydroxy-N-methylmorphinan), amantadine (1-amino adamantine), memantine (3,5 dimethylaminoadamantone), pyrroloquinoline quinone, and cis-4-(phosphonomethyl)-2-piperidinecarboxylic acid.
  • Anticoccidial Compounds
  • Anticoccidial compounds may be employed in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Such compounds include salinomycin, monensin, narasin, lasalocid, nicarbazin, maduramycin, nicarbazin and narasin in combination, diclazuril, dinitolmide, halofuginone, robenidine, amprolium and clopidol. Other anticoccidial compounds are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,582,822; 4,824,863; 5,552,386; 6,384,052; and 6,528,531.
  • Therapy
  • The invention features methods for treating an immunoinflammatory disorder. While the examples describe a two-drug combination, it is understood that the combination of multiple agents is often desirable. For example, methotrexate, hydroxychloroquine, and sulfasalazine are commonly administered for the treatment of rheumatoid arthritis, and may also be employed in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Additional therapies are described below.
  • Desirably, the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention are more effective than other methods, compositions, and kits. By “more effective” is meant that a method, composition, or kit exhibits greater efficacy, is less toxic, safer, more convenient, better tolerated, or less expensive, or provides more treatment satisfaction than another method, composition, or kit with which it is being compared.
  • Psoriasis
  • The methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of psoriasis. If desired, one or more antipsoriatic agents typically used to treat psoriasis may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Such agents include biologics (e.g. alefacept, infliximab, adalimumab, efalizumab, etanercept, and CDP-870), small molecule immunomodulators (e.g., VX 702, SCIO 469, doramapimod, RO 30201195, SCIO 323, DPC 333, pralnacasan, mycophenolate, and merimepodib), non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressants (e.g. cyclosporine, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, ABT-281, and ISAtx247), vitamin D analogs (e.g. calcpotriene, calcipotriol), psoralens (e.g. methoxsalen), retinoids (e.g. acitretin, tazarotene), DMARDs (e.g. methotrexate), anthralin, topical glucocorticosteroids (e.g. clobetasol, triamcinolone, betamethasone, hydrocortisone, halobetasol, diflorasone, mometasone, halcinonide, fluticasone), and systemic glucocorticosteroids (e.g. prednisone, dexamethasone).
  • Atopic Dermatitis
  • The methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of atopic dermatitis. If desired, one or more atopic dermatitis agents typically used to treat atopic dermatitis may be used in the methods, composition, and kits of the invention. Such agents include topical and systemic non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressants (e.g. cyclosporine, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, ABT-281, and ISAtx247), topical glucocorticosteroids (e.g. clobetasol, triamcinolone, betamethasone, hydrocortisone, halobetasol, diflorasone, mometasone, halcinonide, fluticasone), systemic glucocorticosteroids (e.g. prednisone, dexamethasone) and antihistamines (e.g. hydroxyzine, loratadine, cetirizine, diphenhydramine, cyproheptadine, fexofenadine).
  • Hand Dermatitis
  • The methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of hand dermatitis. If desired, one or more hand dermatitis agents typically used to treat hand dermatitis may be used in the methods, composition, and kits of the invention. Such agents include topical and systemic non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressants (e.g. cyclosporine, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, ABT-281, and ISAtx247), topical glucocorticosteroids (e.g. clobetasol, triamcinolone, betamethasone, hydrocortisone, halobetasol, diflorasone, mometasone, halcinonide, fluticasone), systemic glucocorticosteroids (e.g. prednisone, dexamethasone) antihistamines (e.g. hydroxyzine, loratadine, cetirizine, diphenhydramine, cyproheptadine, fexofenadine), and emollients, ointments, humectants, and lotions.
  • Actinic Keratosis
  • The methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of actinic keratosis. If desired, one or more hand dermatitis agents typically used to treat hand dermatitis may be used in the methods, composition, and kits of the invention. Such agents include chemotherapeutic agents (e.g. 5-fluorouracil, imiquimod), non-steroid inflammatory agents (e.g. diclofenac), topical retinoids (e.g. adapalene), and photodynamic therapy using topical aminolevulinic acid.
  • Basal Cell Carcinoma
  • The methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of basal cell carcinoma. If desired, one or more basal cell carcinoma agents typically used to treat basal cell carcinoma may be used in the methods, composition, and kits of the invention. Such agents include chemotherapeutic agents (e.g. 5-fluorouracil, imiquimod).
  • Chronic Obstructive Pulmonary Disease
  • In one embodiment, the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention are used for the treatment of chronic obstructive pulmonary disease (COPD). If desired, one or more agents typically used to treat COPD may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Such agents include xanthines (e.g., theophylline), anticholinergic compounds (e.g., ipratropium, tiotropium), biologics, small molecule immunomodulators, and beta receptor agonists/bronchodilators (e.g., ibuterol sulfate, bitolterol mesylate, epinephrine, formoterol fumarate, isoproteronol, levalbuterol hydrochloride, metaproterenol sulfate, pirbuterol acetate, salmeterol xinafoate, and terbutaline).
  • Inflammatory Bowel Disease
  • The methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of inflammatory bowel disease. If desired, one or more agents typically used to treat inflammatory bowel disease may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Such agents include biologics (e.g., inflixamab, adelimumab, and CDP-870), small molecule immunomodulators (e.g., VX 702, SCIO 469, doramapimod, RO 30201195, SCIO 323, DPC 333, pranalcasan, mycophenolate, and merimepodib), non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressants (e.g., cyclosporine, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, ABT-281, and ISAtx247), 5-amino salicylic acid (e.g., mesalamine, sulfasalazine, balsalazide disodium, and olsalazine sodium), DMARDs (e.g., methotrexate and azathioprine) and alosetron.
  • Rheumatoid Arthritis
  • The methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of rheumatoid arthritis. If desired, one or more agents typically used to treat rheumatoid arthritis may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Such agents include NSAIDs (e.g., naproxen sodium, diclofenac sodium, diclofenac potassium, aspirin, sulindac, diflunisal, piroxicam, indomethacin, ibuprofen, nabumetone, choline magnesium trisalicylate, sodium salicylate, salicylsalicylic acid (salsalate), fenoprofen, flurbiprofen, ketoprofen, meclofenamate sodium, meloxicam, oxaprozin, sulindac, and tolmetin), COX-2 inhibitors (e.g., rofecoxib, celecoxib, valdecoxib, and lumiracoxib), biologics (e.g., inflixamab, adelimumab, etanercept, CDP-870, rituximab, and atlizumab), small molecule immunomodulators (e.g., VX 702, SCIO 469, doramapimod, RO 30201195, SCIO 323, DPC 333, pranalcasan, mycophenolate, and merimepodib), non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressants (e.g., cyclosporine, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, ABT-281, and ISAtx247), 5-amino salicylic acid (e.g., mesalamine, sulfasalazine, balsalazide disodium, and olsalazine sodium), DMARDs (e.g., methotrexate, leflunomide, minocycline, auranofin, gold sodium thiomalate, aurothioglucose, and azathioprine), hydroxychloroquine sulfate, and penicillamine.
  • Asthma
  • The methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of asthma. If desired, one or more agents typically used to treat asthma may be used in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Such agents include beta 2 agonists/bronchodilators/leukotriene modifiers (e.g., zafirlukast, montelukast, and zileuton), biologics (e.g., omalizumab), small molecule immunomodulators, anticholinergic compounds, xanthines, ephedrine, guaifenesin, cromolyn sodium, nedocromil sodium, and potassium iodide.
  • Osteoarthritis
  • The methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of osteoarthritis, or pain, tenderness, impairment in mobility, soft tissue swelling, or bony swelling associated therewith. If desired, one or more agents typically used to treat osteoarthritis may be used as a substitute for or in addition to a corticosteroid in the methods, compositions, and kits of the invention. Such agents include NSAIDs (e.g., naproxen sodium, diclofenac sodium, diclofenac potassium, aspirin, sulindac, diflunisal, piroxicam, indomethacin, ibuprofen, nabumetone, choline magnesium trisalicylate, sodium salicylate, salicylsalicylic acid (salsalate), fenoprofen, flurbiprofen, ketoprofen, meclofenamate sodium, meloxicam, oxaprozin, sulindac, and tolmetin), COX-2 inhibitors (e.g., rofecoxib, celecoxib, valdecoxib, and lumiracoxib), biologics (e.g., inflixamab, adelimumab, etanercept, CDP-870, rituximab, and atlizumab), small molecule immunomodulators (e.g., VX 702, SCIO 469, doramapimod, RO 30201195, SCIO 323, DPC 333, pranalcasan, mycophenolate, and merimepodib), DMARDs (e.g., methotrexate, leflunomide, minocycline, auranofin, gold sodium thiomalate, aurothioglucose, and azathioprine), xanthines (e.g., theobromine, theophylline, aminophylline, and caffeine), NsIDIs (e.g., cyclosporine, tacrolimus, pimecrolimus, and ISAtx247), vitamin D analogs (e.g., calcipotriol, tacalcitol, and maxacalcitol), psoralens (e.g., methoxsalen and trioxsalen), retinoids (e.g., tretinoin, isotretinoin, and acetretin), 5-amino salicylic acids (e.g., mesalamine, sulfasalazine, balsalazide disodium, and olsalazine sodium), hydroxychloroquine sulfate, penicillamine, or analogs thereof.
  • Ophthalmic Disorders
  • The methods, compositions, and kits of the invention may be used for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders. Unless the intended purpose of use is affected adversely, the prophylactic and therapeutic medicament of the present invention may contain or may be used together with other appropriate pharmacologically effective substances, for example, dipivefrin (e.g., dipivefrin hydrochloride ophthalmic 0.1%), anti-VEGF therapies (e.g., pegaptanib (MACUGEN) ranibizumab, anecortave, and squalamine lactate), photodynamic therapy (e.g., VISUDYNE (verteporfin)), corticosteroids (e.g., dexamethasone, prednisolone), NSAIDs (e.g., diclofenac sodium, pranoprofen), antiallergic agents (e.g., tranilast, ketotifen fumarate, sodium cromoglicate), antihistamines (e.g., diphenhydramine hydrochloride), glaucoma-treating agents (e.g., pilocarpine hydrochloride, physostigmine salicylate, timolol, isopropylunoprostone), artificial tears, antibiotics (e.g., gentamycin sulfate, fradiomycin sulfate, tobramycin, sulbenicillin, cefinenoxime, erythromycin, colistin, oxytetracycline, polymyxin B, chloramphenicol, micronomicin, dibekacin, sisomicin, sulfamethizole, sulfamethoxazole, ofloxacin, norfloxacin, lomefloxacin hydrochloride, enoxacin, ciprofloxacin hydrochloride, cinoxacin, sparfloxacin, tosufloxacin tosylate, nalidixic acid, pipemidic acid trihydrate, pipemidic acid, fleroxacin, levofloxacin), antiviral agents (e.g., idoxuridine, acyclovir), and antimycotic agents (e.g., pimaricin, fluconazole, miconazole, amphotericin B, flucytosine, itraconazole).
  • Administration
  • In particular embodiments of any of the methods of the invention, the compounds are administered within 14 days of each other, within 10 days of each other, within five days of each other, within twenty-four hours of each other, or simultaneously. The compounds may be formulated together as a single composition, or may be formulated and administered separately. One or both compounds may be administered in a low dosage or in a high dosage, each of which is defined herein. It may be desirable to administer to the patient other compounds, such as a corticosteroid, humectants, NSAID (e.g., naproxen sodium, diclofenac sodium, diclofenac potassium, aspirin, sulindac, diflunisal, piroxicam, indomethacin, ibuprofen, nabumetone, choline magnesium trisalicylate, sodium salicylate, salicylsalicylic acid, fenoprofen, flurbiprofen, ketoprofen, meclofenamate sodium, meloxicam, oxaprozin, sulindac, and tolmetin), COX-2 inhibitor (e.g., rofecoxib, celecoxib, valdecoxib, and lumiracoxib), glucocorticoid receptor modulator, or DMARD. Combination therapies of the invention are especially useful for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders in combination with other agents—either biologics or small molecules—that modulate the immune response to positively affect disease. Such agents include those that deplete key inflammatory cells, influence cell adhesion, or influence cytokines involved in immune response. This last category includes both agents that mimic or increase the action of anti-inflammatory cytokines such as IL-10, as well as agents inhibit the activity of pro-inflammatory cytokines such as IL-6, IL-1, IL-2, IL-12, IL-15 or TNFα. Agents that inhibit TNFα include etanercept, adelimumab, infliximab, and CDP-870. In this example (that of agents blocking the effect of TNFα), the combination therapy reduces the production of cytokines, etanercept or infliximab act on the remaining fraction of inflammatory cytokines, providing enhanced treatment. Small molecule immunodulators include, e.g., p38 MAP kinase inhibitors such as VX 702, SCIO 469, doramapimod, RO 30201195, SCIO 323, TACE inhibitors such as DPC 333, ICE inhibitors such as pranalcasan, and IMPDH inhibitors such as mycophenolate and merimepodib.
  • Therapy according to the invention may be performed alone or in conjunction with another therapy and may be provided at home, the doctor's office, a clinic, a hospital's outpatient department, or a hospital. Treatment optionally begins at a hospital so that the doctor can observe the therapy's effects closely and make any adjustments that are needed, or it may begin on an outpatient basis. The duration of the therapy depends on the type of disease or disorder being treated, the age and condition of the patient, the stage and type of the patient's disease, and how the patient responds to the treatment. Additionally, a person having a greater risk of developing an inflammatory disease (e.g., a person who is undergoing age-related hormonal changes) may receive treatment to inhibit or delay the onset of symptoms.
  • Routes of administration for the various embodiments include, but are not limited to, topical, transdermal, nasal, and systemic administration (such as, intravenous, intramuscular, subcutaneous, inhalation, rectal, buccal, vaginal, intraperitoneal, intraarticular, ophthalmic, otic, or oral administration). As used herein, “systemic administration” refers to all nondermal routes of administration, and specifically excludes topical and transdermal routes of administration.
  • In combination therapy, the dosage and frequency of administration of each component of the combination can be controlled independently. For example, one compound may be administered three times per day, while the second compound may be administered once per day. Combination therapy may be given in on-and-off cycles that include rest periods so that the patient's body has a chance to recover from any as yet unforeseen side effects. The compounds may also be formulated together such that one administration delivers both compounds.
  • Each compound of the combination may be formulated in a variety of ways that are known in the art. For example, the first and second agents may be formulated together or separately. Desirably, the first and second agents are formulated together for the simultaneous or near simultaneous administration of the agents. Such co-formulated compositions can include the two drugs together in the same pill, ointment, cream, foam, capsule, liquid, etc. It is to be understood that, when referring to the formulation of combinations of the invention, the formulation technology employed is also useful for the formulation of the individual agents of the combination, as well as other combinations of the invention (e.g., a glucocorticoid receptor modulator in lieu of a corticosteroid combination). By using different formulation strategies for different agents, the pharmacokinetic profiles for each agent can be suitably matched.
  • The individually or separately formulated agents can be packaged together as a kit. Non-limiting examples include kits that contain, e.g., two pills, a pill and a powder, a suppository and a liquid in a vial, two topical creams, ointments, foams etc. The kit can include optional components that aid in the administration of the unit dose to patients, such as vials for reconstituting powder forms, syringes for injection, customized IV delivery systems, inhalers, etc. Additionally, the unit dose kit can contain instructions for preparation and administration of the compositions. The kit may be manufactured as a single use unit dose for one patient, multiple uses for a particular patient (at a constant dose or in which the individual compounds may vary in potency as therapy progresses); or the kit may contain multiple doses suitable for administration to multiple patients (“bulk packaging”). The kit components may be assembled in cartons, blister packs, bottles, tubes, and the like.
  • Topical Formulations
  • For the prophylaxis and/or treatment of inflammatory dermatoses, the combinations of the invention are, desirably, formulated for topical administration. Topical formulations which can be used with the combinations of the invention include, without limitation, creams, foams, lotions, gels, sticks, sprays, solutions (e.g., for soaking, as with a bath salt), and ointments.
  • Any conventional pharmacologically and cosmetically acceptable vehicles may be used. For example, the compounds may also be administered in liposomal formulations that allow compounds to enter the skin. Such liposomal formulations are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,169,637; 5,000,958; 5,049,388; 4,975,282; 5,194,266; 5,023,087; 5,688,525; 5,874,104; 5,409,704; 5,552,155; 5,356,633; 5,032,582; 4,994,213; and PCT Publication No. WO 96/40061. Examples of other appropriate vehicles are described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,877,805 and EP Publication No. 0586106A1. Suitable vehicles of the invention may also include mineral oil, petrolatum, polydecene, stearic acid, isopropyl myristate, polyoxyl 40 stearate, stearyl alcohol, or vegetable oil.
  • The formulations can include various conventional colorants, fragrances, thickeners (e.g., xanthan gum), preservatives, emollients (e.g., hydrocarbon oils, waxes, or silicones), demulcents, solubilizing excipients, dispersants, penetration enhancers, plasticizing agents, preservatives, stabilizers, demulsifiers, wetting agents, emulsifiers, moisturizers, astringents, deodorants, and the like can be added to provide additional benefits and improve the feel and/or appearance of the topical preparation.
  • Where one drug has poor solubility in water at physiological pH, one or more solubilizing excipients may be a necessary component in the topical formulations.
  • Solubilization is taken to mean an improvement in the solubility by virtue of surface-active compounds that can convert substances that are insoluble or virtually insoluble in water into clear, or opalescent, aqueous solutions without changing the chemical structure of these substances in the process.
  • The solubilizates formed are notable for the fact that the substance is present in dissolved form in the molecular associations, micelles, of the surface-active compounds, which form in aqueous solution. The resulting solutions appear optically clear to opalescent.
  • Solubilizing excipients that may be used in the formulations of the invention include, without limitation, compounds belonging to the following classes: polyethoxylated fatty acids, PEG-fatty acid diesters, PEG-fatty acid mono-ester and di-ester mixtures, polyethylene glycol glycerol fatty acid esters, alcohol-oil transesterification products, polyglycerized fatty acids, propylene glycol fatty acid esters, mixtures of propylene glycol esters and glycerol esters, mono- and diglycerides, sterol and sterol derivatives, polyethylene glycol sorbitan fatty acid esters, polyethylene glycol alkyl ethers, sugar esters, polyethylene glycol alkyl phenols, polyoxyethylene-polyoxypropylene block copolymers, sorbitan fatty acid esters, lower alcohol fatty acid esters, ionic surfactants, tocopherol esters, and sterol esters. Each of these classes of excipient are commercially available and well known to those in the field of formulations.
  • Ophthalmic Formulations
  • Ophthalmic formulations include but are not limited to ocular injections such as intravitreal, subtenons, subconjunctival, periocular, retrobulbar injections; topical ophthalmic aqueous solutions, such as suspensions, ointments, and gels; intraocular biodegradable and non-biodegradable implants; implants that are inserted through incisions made in the eye wall or sutured around the globe of the eye; tack for intraocular drug delivery; and bioadhesive ophthalmic inserts.
  • For topical ophthalmic administration the novel formulations of this invention may take the form of solutions, gels, ointments, suspensions or solid inserts, formulated so that a unit dosage comprises a therapeutically effective amount of each active component or some submultiple thereof.
  • Typical opthalmologically acceptable carriers for the novel formulations are, for example, water, mixtures of water and water-miscible solvents such as lower alkanols or aralkanols, vegetable oils, polyalkylene glycols, petroleum based jelly, ethyl cellulose, ethyl oleate, carboxymethylcellulose, polyvinylpyrrolidone, isopropyl myristate and other conventionally employed acceptable carriers. The pharmaceutical preparation may also contain non-toxic auxiliary substances such as emulsifying, preserving, wetting agents, bodying agents and the like, as for example, polyethylene glycols 200, 300, 400 and 600, carbowaxes 1,000, 1,500, 4,000, 6,000 and 10,000, antibacterial components such as quaternary ammonium compounds, phenylmercuric salts known to have cold sterilizing properties and which are non-injurious in use, thimerosal, benzalkonium chloride, methyl and propyl paraben, benzyldodecinium bromide, benzyl alcohol, phenylethanol, buffering ingredients such as sodium chloride, sodium borate, sodium acetate, or gluconate buffers, and other conventional ingredients such as sorbitan monolaurate, triethanolamine, polyoxyethylene sorbitan monopalmitylate, dioctyl sodium sulfosuccinate, monothioglycerol, thiosorbitol, ethylenediamine tetra-acetic acid, and the like. Additionally, suitable ophthalmic vehicles can be used as carrier media for the present purpose including conventional phosphate buffer vehicle systems, isotonic boric acid vehicles, isotonic sodium chloride vehicles, isotonic sodium borate vehicles and the like.
  • The formulation may also include a gum such as gellan gum at a concentration of 0.1 to 2% by weight so that the aqueous eyedrops gel on contact with the eye, thus providing the advantages of a solid ophthalmic insert as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,861,760.
  • The pharmaceutical preparation may also be in the form of a solid insert such as one which after dispensing the drug remains essentially intact as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,256,108; 4,160,452; and 4,265,874; or a bio-erodible insert that either is soluble in lacrimal fluids, or otherwise disintegrates as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,287,175 or EPO publication 0077261.
  • Other ophthalmic formulations and delivery devices are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,014,335; 4,300,557; 5,098,443; 5,188,826; 5,378,475; 5,422,116; 5,424,078; 5,466,233; 5,725,493; 5,773,019; 5,773,021; 5,776,445; 5,814,635; 5,888,493; 6,235,781; 6,297,228; 6,372,245; 6,511,660; 6,579,519; 6,582,422; 6,713,081; 6,719,750; and U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2002-0064513; 2003-0232089; and 2005-0234018.
  • Kits
  • In general, kits of the invention contain a corticosteroid and/or an NsIDI. These compounds can be provided in the kit as separate compositions, or combined into a single composition. The kits of the invention can also contain instructions for the administration of both the corticosteroid and NsIDI.
  • Kits of the invention can also contain instructions for administering an additional pharmacologically acceptable substance (e.g., dipivefrin, anti-VEGF therapies, photodynamic therapy, NSAIDs, antiallergic agents, antihistamines, glaucoma-treating agents, artificial tears, antibiotics, antiviral agents, and antimycotic agents) with a corticosteroid and/or an NsIDI. This kit may contain any combination of the corticosteroid, NsIDI, and additional pharmaceutically acceptable substance (i.e., any one, two, or three of the above compounds).
  • Dosages
  • The dosage of each compound of the claimed combinations depends on several factors, including: the administration method, the disease to be treated, the severity of the disease, whether the disease is to be treated or prevented, and the age, weight, and health of the person to be treated. Additionally, pharmacogenomic (the effect of genotype on the pharmacokinetic, pharmacodynamic or efficacy profile of a therapeutic) information about a particular patient may affect dosage used.
  • Continuous daily dosing with the combinations of the invention may not be required. A therapeutic regimen may require cycles, during which time a drug is not administered, or therapy may be provided on an as needed basis during periods of acute inflammation.
  • As described above, the compound in question may be administered orally in the form of tablets, capsules, elixirs or syrups, or rectally in the form of suppositories. The compound may also be administered topically in the form of foams, lotions, drops, creams, ointments, emollients, or gels. Parenteral administration of a compound is suitably performed, for example, in the form of saline solutions or with the compound incorporated into liposomes. In cases where the compound in itself is not sufficiently soluble to be dissolved, a solubilizer such as ethanol can be applied.
  • Conjugates
  • If desired, the drugs used in any of the combinations described herein may be covalently attached to one another to form a conjugate of formula (VII).
    (A)-(L)-(B)  (VII)
    In formula (VII), (A) is a “Drug 1” listed on Table 1A or Table 1B covalently tethered via a linker (L) to (B), the corresponding “Drug 2” listed on Table 1A or Table 1B.
  • Conjugates of the invention can be administered to a subject by any route and for the treatment of any disease described herein.
  • The conjugates of the invention can be prodrugs, releasing drug (A) and drug (B) upon, for example, cleavage of the conjugate by intracellular and extracellular enzymes (e.g., amidases, esterases, and phosphatases). The conjugates of the invention can also be designed to largely remain intact in vivo, resisting cleavage by intracellular and extracellular enzymes. The degradation of the conjugate in vivo can be controlled by the design of linker (L) and the covalent bonds formed with drug (A) and drug (B) during the synthesis of the conjugate.
  • Conjugates can be prepared using techniques familiar to those skilled in the art. For example, the conjugates can be prepared using the methods disclosed in G. Hermanson, Bioconjugate Techniques, Academic Press, Inc., 1996. The synthesis of conjugates may involve the selective protection and deprotection of alcohols, amines, ketones, sulthydryls or carboxyl functional groups of drug (A), the linker, and/or drug (B). For example, commonly used protecting groups for amines include carbamates, such as tert-butyl, benzyl, 2,2,2-trichloroethyl, 2-trimethylsilylethyl, 9-fluorenylmethyl, allyl, and m-nitrophenyl. Other commonly used protecting groups for amines include amides, such as formamides, acetamides, trifluoroacetamides, sulfonamides, trifluoromethanesulfonyl amides, trimethylsilylethanesulfonamides, and tert-butylsulfonyl amides. Examples of commonly used protecting groups for carboxyls include esters, such as methyl, ethyl, tert-butyl, 9-fluorenylmethyl, 2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy methyl, benzyl, diphenylmethyl, O-nitrobenzyl, ortho-esters, and halo-esters. Examples of commonly used protecting groups for alcohols include ethers, such as methyl, methoxymethyl, methoxyethoxymethyl, methylthiomethyl, benzyloxymethyl, tetrahydropyranyl, ethoxyethyl, benzyl, 2-napthylmethyl, O-nitrobenzyl, P-nitrobenzyl, P-methoxybenzyl, 9-phenylxanthyl, trityl (including methoxy-trityls), and silyl ethers. Examples of commonly used protecting groups for sulfhydryls include many of the same protecting groups used for hydroxyls. In addition, sulhydryls can be protected in a reduced form (e.g., as disulfides) or an oxidized form (e.g., as sulfonic acids, sulfonic esters, or sulfonic amides). Protecting groups can be chosen such that selective conditions (e.g., acidic conditions, basic conditions, catalysis by a nucleophile, catalysis by a lewis acid, or hydrogenation) are required to remove each, exclusive of other protecting groups in a molecule. The conditions required for the addition of protecting groups to amine, alcohol, sulthydryl, and carboxyl functionalities and the conditions required for their removal are provided in detail in T. W. Green and P. G. M. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis (2nd Ed.), John Wiley & Sons, 1991 and P. J. Kocienski, Protecting Groups, Georg Thieme Verlag, 1994. Additional synthetic details are provided below.
  • Linkers
  • The linker component of the invention is, at its simplest, a bond between drug (A) and drug (B), but typically provides a linear, cyclic, or branched molecular skeleton having pendant groups covalently linking drug (A) to drug (B). Thus, linking of drug (A) to drug (B) is achieved by covalent means, involving bond formation with one or more functional groups located on drug (A) and drug (B). Examples of chemically reactive functional groups which may be employed for this purpose include, without limitation, amino, hydroxyl, sulfhydryl, carboxyl, carbonyl, carbohydrate groups, vicinal diols, thioethers, 2-aminoalcohols, 2-aminothiols, guanidinyl, imidazolyl, and phenolic groups.
  • The covalent linking of drug (A) and drug (B) may be effected using a linker which contains reactive moieties capable of reaction with such functional groups present in drug (A) and drug (B). For example, an amine group of drug (A) may react with a carboxyl group of the linker, or an activated derivative thereof, resulting in the formation of an amide linking the two.
  • Examples of moieties capable of reaction with sulfhydryl groups include α-haloacetyl compounds of the type XCH2CO— (where X=Br, Cl or I), which show particular reactivity for sulfhydryl groups, but which can also be used to modify imidazolyl, thioether, phenol, and amino groups as described by Gurd, Methods Enzymol. 11:532 (1967). N-Maleimide derivatives are also considered selective towards sulfhydryl groups, but may additionally be useful in coupling to amino groups under certain conditions. Reagents such as 2-iminothiolane (Traut et al., Biochemistry 12:3266 (1973)), which introduce a thiol group through conversion of an amino group, may be considered as sulfhydryl reagents if linking occurs through the formation of disulphide bridges.
  • Examples of reactive moieties capable of reaction with amino groups include, for example, alkylating and acylating agents. Representative alkylating agents include:
  • (i) α-haloacetyl compounds, which show specificity towards amino groups in the absence of reactive thiol groups and are of the type XCH2CO— (where X=Cl, Br or I), for example, as described by Wong Biochemistry 24:5337 (1979);
  • (ii) N-maleimide derivatives, which may react with amino groups either through a Michael type reaction or through acylation by addition to the ring carbonyl group, for example, as described by Smyth et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 82:4600 (1960) and Biochem. J. 91:589 (1964);
  • (iii) aryl halides such as reactive nitrohaloaromatic compounds;
  • (iv) alkyl halides, as described, for example, by McKenzie et al., J. Protein Chem. 7:581 (1988);
  • (v) aldehydes and ketones capable of Schiff's base formation with amino groups, the adducts formed usually being stabilized through reduction to give a stable amine;
  • (vi) epoxide derivatives such as epichlorohydrin and bisoxiranes, which may react with amino, sulfhydryl, or phenolic hydroxyl groups;
  • (vii) chlorine-containing derivatives of s-triazines, which are very reactive towards nucleophiles such as amino, sufhydryl, and hydroxyl groups;
  • (viii) aziridines based on s-triazine compounds detailed above, e.g., as described by Ross, J. Adv. Cancer Res. 2:1 (1954), which react with nucleophiles such as amino groups by ring opening;
  • (ix) squaric acid diethyl esters as described by Tietze, Chem. Ber. 124:1215 (1991); and
  • (x) α-haloalkyl ethers, which are more reactive alkylating agents than normal alkyl halides because of the activation caused by the ether oxygen atom, as described by Benneche et al., Eur. J. Med. Chem. 28:463 (1993).
  • Representative amino-reactive acylating agents include:
  • (i) isocyanates and isothiocyanates, particularly aromatic derivatives, which form stable urea and thiourea derivatives respectively;
  • (ii) sulfonyl chlorides, which have been described by Herzig et al., Biopolymers 2:349 (1964);
  • (iii) acid halides;
  • (iv) active esters such as nitrophenylesters or N-hydroxysuccinimidyl esters;
  • (v) acid anhydrides such as mixed, symmetrical, or N-carboxyanhydrides;
  • (vi) other useful reagents for amide bond formation, for example, as described by M. Bodansky, Principles of Peptide Synthesis, Springer-Verlag, 1984;
  • (vii) acylazides, e.g. wherein the azide group is generated from a preformed hydrazide derivative using sodium nitrite, as described by Wetz et al., Anal. Biochem. 58:347 (1974); and
  • (viii) imidoesters, which form stable amidines on reaction with amino groups, for example, as described by Hunter and Ludwig, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 84:3491 (1962).
  • Aldehydes and ketones may be reacted with amines to form Schiff's bases, which may advantageously be stabilized through reductive amination. Alkoxylamino moieties readily react with ketones and aldehydes to produce stable alkoxamines, for example, as described by Webb et al., in Bioconjugate Chem. 1:96 (1990).
  • Examples of reactive moieties capable of reaction with carboxyl groups include diazo compounds such as diazoacetate esters and diazoacetamides, which react with high specificity to generate ester groups, for example, as described by Herriot, Adv. Protein Chem. 3:169 (1947). Carboxyl modifying reagents such as carbodiimides, which react through O-acylurea formation followed by amide bond formation, may also be employed.
  • It will be appreciated that functional groups in drug (A) and/or drug (B) may, if desired, be converted to other functional groups prior to reaction, for example, to confer additional reactivity or selectivity. Examples of methods useful for this purpose include conversion of amines to carboxyls using reagents such as dicarboxylic anhydrides; conversion of amines to thiols using reagents such as N-acetylhomocysteine thiolactone, S-acetylmercaptosuccinic anhydride, 2-iminothiolane, or thiol-containing succinimidyl derivatives; conversion of thiols to carboxyls using reagents such as α-haloacetates; conversion of thiols to amines using reagents such as ethylenimine or 2-bromoethylamine; conversion of carboxyls to amines using reagents such as carbodiimides followed by diamines; and conversion of alcohols to thiols using reagents such as tosyl chloride followed by transesterification with thioacetate and hydrolysis to the thiol with sodium acetate.
  • So-called zero-length linkers, involving direct covalent joining of a reactive chemical group of drug (A) with a reactive chemical group of drug (B) without introducing additional linking material may, if desired, be used in accordance with the invention.
  • Most commonly, however, the linker will include two or more reactive moieties, as described above, connected by a spacer element. The presence of such a spacer permits bifunctional linkers to react with specific functional groups within drug (A) and drug (B), resulting in a covalent linkage between the two. The reactive moieties in a linker may be the same (homobifunctional linker) or different (heterobifunctional linker, or, where several dissimilar reactive moieties are present, heteromultifunctional linker), providing a diversity of potential reagents that may bring about covalent attachment between drug (A) and drug (B).
  • Spacer elements in the linker typically consist of linear or branched chains and may include a C1-10 alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl, C2-10 alkynyl, C2-6 heterocyclyl, C6-12 aryl, C7-14 alkaryl, C3-10 alkheterocyclyl, or C1-10 heteroalkyl.
  • In some instances, the linker is described by formula (VIII):
    G1-(Z1)o-(Y1)u-(Z2)s-(R30)-(Z3)t-(Y2)v-(Z4)p-G2  (VIII)
  • In formula (VIII), G1 is a bond between drug (A) and the linker; G2 is a bond between the linker and drug (B); Z1, Z2, Z3, and Z4 each, independently, is selected from O, S, and NR31; R31 is hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, C2-4 alkenyl, C2-4 alkynyl, C2-6 heterocyclyl, C6-12 aryl, C7-14 alkaryl, C3-10 alkheterocyclyl, or C1-7 heteroalkyl; Y1 and Y2 are each, independently, selected from carbonyl, thiocarbonyl, sulphonyl, or phosphoryl; o, p, s, t, u, and v are each, independently, 0 or 1; and R30 is a C1-10 alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl, C2-10 alkynyl, C2-6 heterocyclyl, C6-12 aryl, C7-14 alkaryl, C3-10 alkheterocyclyl, or C1-10 heteroalkyl, or a chemical bond linking G1-(Z1)o-(Y1)u-(Z2)s- to -(Z3)t-(Y2)v-(Z4)p-G2. Examples of homobifunctional linkers useful in the preparation of conjugates of the invention include, without limitation, diamines and diols selected from ethylenediamine, propylenediamine and hexamethylenediamine, ethylene glycol, diethylene glycol, propylene glycol, 1,4-butanediol, 1,6-hexanediol, cyclohexanediol, and polycaprolactone diol.
  • Additional Applications
  • The compounds of the invention can be employed in immunomodulatory or mechanistic assays to determine whether other combinations, or single agents, are as effective as the combination in inhibiting secretion or production of proinflammatory cytokines or modulating immune response using assays generally known in the art, examples of which are described herein. After a suitable time, the cells are examined for cytokine secretion or production or other suitable immune response. The relative effects of the combinations versus each other, and versus the single agents are compared, and effective compounds and combinations are identified.
  • The combinations of the invention are also useful tools in elucidating mechanistic information about the biological pathways involved in inflammation. Such information can lead to the development of new combinations or single agents for inhibiting inflammation caused by proinflammatory cytokines. Methods known in the art to determine biological pathways can be used to determine the pathway, or network of pathways affected by contacting cells stimulated to produce proinflammatory cytokines with the compounds of the invention. Such methods can include, analyzing cellular constituents that are expressed or repressed after contact with the compounds of the invention as compared to untreated, positive or negative control compounds, and/or new single agents and combinations, or analyzing some other metabolic activity of the cell such as enzyme activity, nutrient uptake, and proliferation. Cellular components analyzed can include gene transcripts, and protein expression. Suitable methods can include standard biochemistry techniques, radiolabeling the compounds of the invention (e.g., 14C or 3H labeling), and observing the compounds binding to proteins, e.g. using 2d gels, gene expression profiling. Once identified, such compounds can be used in in vivo models to further validate the tool or develop new anti-inflammatory agents.
  • The following examples are to illustrate the invention. They are not meant to limit the invention in any way.
  • EXAMPLE 1
  • The effects of test compound combinations on TNFα secretion were assayed in white blood cells from human buffy coat stimulated with lipopolysaccharide or phorbol 12-myristate 13-acetate (PMA) and ionomycin as follows. The results from these experiments are set forth in FIGS. 1A-1MM.
  • Lipopolysaccharide (LPS)
  • A 100 μl suspension of diluted human white blood cells contained within each well of a polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc) was stimulated to secrete TNFα by treatment with a final concentration of 2 μg/mL lipopolysaccharide (Sigma L-4130). Various concentrations of each test compound were added at the time of stimulation. After 16-18 hours of incubation at 37° C. in a humidified incubator, the plate was centrifuged and the supernatant transferred to a white opaque polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc, Maxisorb) coated with an anti-TNFα antibody (PharMingen, #551220). After a two-hour incubation, the plate washed (Tecan PowerWasher 384) with PBS containing 0.1% Tween 20 and incubated for an additional one hour with another anti-TNFα antibody that was biotin labeled (PharMingen, #554511) and HRP coupled to strepavidin (PharMingen, # 13047E). After the plate washed with 0.1% Tween 20/PBS, an HRP-luminescent substrate was added to each well and light intensity measured using a LJL Analyst plate luminometer.
  • PMA/Ionomycin
  • A 100 μl suspension of diluted human white blood cells contained within each well of a polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc) was stimulated to secrete TNFα by treatment with a final concentration of 10 ng/mL phorbol 12-myristate 13-acetate (Sigma, P-1585) and 750 ng/mL ionomycin (Sigma, I-0634). Various concentrations of each test compound were added at the time of stimulation. After 16-18 hours of incubation at 37° C. in a humidified incubator, the plate was centrifuged and the supernatant transferred to a white opaque polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc, Maxisorb) coated with an anti-TNFα antibody (PharMingen, #551220). After a two-hour incubation, the plate washed (Tecan PowerWasher 384) with PBS containing 0.1% Tween 20 and incubated for an additional one hour with another anti-TNFα antibody that was biotin labeled (PharMingen, #554511) and HRP coupled to strepavidin (PharMingen, #13047E). After the plate washed with 0.1% Tween 20/PBS, an HRP-luminescent substrate was added to each well and light intensity measured using a LJL Analyst plate luminometer.
  • EXAMPLE 2
  • Both corticosteroids and NsIDIs suppress cytokine production in cell culture models of immune function. We tested the effect of the combination of various concentrations of NsIDIs and corticosteroids on cytokine production in a cell culture model of immune function. We propose that combinations that demonstrate synergistic or superaddative effects can be used to treat ophthalmic disorders at concentrations low enough to avoid undesired side effects.
  • Assay for Proinflammatory Cytokine-Suppressing Activity
  • Compound dilution matrices were assayed for the suppression of IFNγ, IL-2, and TNFα, as described below. The results from these experiments are set forth in FIGS. 2A-2LL.
  • IFNγ
  • A 100 μL suspension of diluted human white blood cells contained within each well of a polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc) was stimulated to secrete IFNγ by treatment with a final concentration of 10 ng/mL phorbol 12-myristate 13-acetate (Sigma, P-1585) and 750 ng/mL ionomycin (Sigma, I-0634). Various concentrations of each test compound were added at the time of stimulation. After 16-18 hours of incubation at 37° C. in a humidified incubator, the plate was centrifuged and the supernatant transferred to a white opaque polystyrene 384 well plate (NalgeNunc, Maxisorb) coated with an anti-IFNγ antibody (Endogen, #M-700A-E). After a two-hour incubation, the plate washed (Tecan PowerWasher 384) with phosphate buffered saline (PBS) containing 0.1% Tween 20 (polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurate) and incubated for an additional one hour with another anti-IFNγ antibody that was biotin labeled (Endogen, M701B) and horseradish peroxidase (HRP) coupled to strepavidin (PharMingen, #13047E). After the plate washed with 0.1% Tween 20/PBS, an HRP-luminescent substrate was added to each well and light intensity measured using a LJL Analyst plate luminometer.
  • IL-2
  • A 100 μL suspension of diluted human white blood cells contained within each well of a polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc) was stimulated to secrete IL-2 by treatment with a final concentration of 10 ng/mL phorbol 12-myristate 13-acetate (Sigma, P-1585) and 750 ng/mL ionomycin (Sigma, I-0634). Various concentrations of each test compound were added at the time of stimulation. After 16-18 hours of incubation at 37° C. in a humidified incubator, the plate was centrifuged and the supernatant transferred to a white opaque polystyrene 384 well plate (NalgeNunc, Maxisorb) coated with an anti-IL-2 antibody (PharMingen, #555051). After a two-hour incubation, the plate washed (Tecan PowerWasher 384) with PBS containing 0.1% Tween 20 and incubated for an additional one hour with another anti-IL-2 antibody that was biotin labeled (Endogen, M600B) and HRP coupled to strepavidin (PharMingen, #13047E). After the plate washed with 0.1% Tween 20/PBS, an HRP-luminescent substrate was added to each well and light intensity measured using a LJL Analyst plate luminometer.
  • TNFα
  • The effects of test compound combinations on TNFα secretion were assayed in white blood cells from human buffy coat stimulated with phorbol 12-myistate 13-acetate as follows. Human white blood cells from buffy coat were diluted 1:50 in media (RPMI; Gibco BRL, #11875-085), 10% fetal bovine serum (Gibco BRL, #25140-097), 2% penicillin/streptomycin (Gibco BRL, #15140-122)) and 50 μL of the diluted white blood cells was placed in each well of the assay plate. Drugs were added to the indicated concentration. After 16-18 hours of incubation at 37° C. with 5% CO2 in a humidified incubator, the plate was centrifuged and the supernatant transferred to a white opaque polystyrene 384-well plate (NalgeNunc, Maxisorb) coated with an anti-TNFα antibody (PharMingen, #551220). After a two-hour incubation, the plate washed (Tecan Powerwasher 384) with PBS containing 0.1% Tween 20 and incubated for one additional hour with biotin labeled anti-TNFα antibody (PharMingen, #554511) and HRP coupled to streptavidin (PharMingen, #13047E). The plate was then washed again with 0.1% Tween 20/PBS. An HRP-luminescent substrate was added to each well, and the light intensity of each well was measured using a plate luminometer.
  • Percent Inhibition
  • The percent inhibition (% I) for each well was calculated using the following formula:
    % I=[(avg. untreated wells−treated well)/(avg. untreated wells)]×100
    The average untreated well value (avg. untreated wells) is the arithmetic mean of 40 wells from the same assay plate treated with vehicle alone. Negative inhibition values result from local variations in treated wells as compared to untreated wells.
    Preparation of Compounds
  • The stock solution containing cyclosporin A was made at a concentration of 1.2 mg/ml in DMSO. The stock solution of tacrolimus was made at a concentration of 0.04 mg/ml in DMSO. Stock solutions containing a corticosteroid were made in dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) at a final concentration of between 0 and 40 μM. Master plates were prepared to contain dilutions of the stock solutions of the compounds described above. Master plates were sealed and stored at −20° C. until ready for use.
  • The final single agent plates were generated by transferring 1 μL of stock solution from the specific master plate to a dilution plate containing 100 μL of media (RPMI; Gibco BRL, #11875-085), 10% fetal bovine serum (Gibco BRL, #25140-097), 2% Penicillin/Streptomycin (Gibco BRL, #15140-122)) using the Packard Mini-Trak liquid handler. This dilution plate was then mixed and a 5 mL aliquot transferred to the final assay plate, which had been pre-filled with 50 mL/well RPMI media containing the appropriate stimulant to activate IFNγ, IL-2, or TNFα secretion.
  • Other Embodiments
  • Various modifications and variations of the described methods and compositions of the invention will be apparent to those skilled in the art without departing from the scope and spirit of the invention. Although the invention has been described in connection with specific desired embodiments, it should be understood that the invention as claimed should not be unduly limited to such specific embodiments. Indeed, various modifications of the described modes for carrying out the invention that are obvious to those skilled in the fields of medicine, immunology, pharmacology, endocrinology, or related fields are intended to be within the scope of the invention.
  • All publications mentioned in this specification are herein incorporated by reference to the same extent as if each independent publication was specifically and individually incorporated by reference.

Claims (30)

1. A composition comprising a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3 in amounts that together are sufficient to treat an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level when administered to a patient in need thereof.
2. The composition of claim 1, wherein said drug pair is selected from: antihistamine and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; antihistamine and SSRI; antihistamine and tricyclic compound; antinfective and anticoccidial compound; corticosteroid and antihistamine; corticosteroid and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; corticosteroid and prostaglandin; NsIDI and alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonist; NsIDI and antihistamine; NsIDI and NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic; NsIDI and prostaglandin; NsIDI and sympathomimetic; prostaglandin and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; prostaglandin and tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine; sympathomimetic and NMDA antagonist/antidyskinetic; sympathomimetic and prostaglandin; sympathomimetic and tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine; sympathomimetic and tricyclic compound; tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine and phosphodiesterase inhibitor; tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine and SSRI; tetra-substituted pyrimidopyrimidine and tricyclic compound; tricyclic compound and calcium channel blocker.
3. The composition of claim 1, wherein one or both drugs in said pair are present in said composition in a low dosage.
4. The composition of claim 1, wherein one or both drugs in said pair are is present in said composition in a high dosage.
5. The composition of claim 1, wherein said composition is formulated for topical administration.
6. The composition of claim 1, wherein said composition is formulated for systemic administration.
7. The composition of claim 1, wherein said composition is formulated for ophthalmic administration.
8. A method for treating a patient diagnosed with an immunoinflammatory disorder, said method comprising administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3, wherein the first and second drug of said drug pair are administered simultaneously or within 14 days of each other in amounts that together are sufficient to treat said patient.
9. The method of claim 8, wherein said immunoinflammatory disorder is rheumatoid arthritis, Crohn's disease, ulcerative colitis, asthma, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, polymylagia rheumatica, giant cell arteritis, systemic lupus erythematosus, atopic dermatitis, multiple sclerosis, myasthenia gravis, psoriasis, ankylosing spondylitis, or psoriatic arthritis.
10. The method of claim 8, further comprising administering to said patient an NSAID, corticosteroid, COX-2 inhibitor, biologic, DMARD, small molecule immunomodulator, xanthine, anticholinergic compound, beta receptor agonist, bronchodilator, non-steroidal immunophilin-dependent immunosuppressant, vitamin D analog, psoralen, retinoid, or 5-amino salicylic acid.
11. A method for treating a patient diagnosed with an ophthalmic disorder, said method comprising administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3, wherein the first and second drug of said drug pair are administered simultaneously or within 14 days of each other in amounts that together are sufficient to treat said patient.
12. The method of claim 11, wherein said ophthalmic disorder is age related macular degeneration; alkaline erosive keratoconjunctivitis; allergic conjunctivitis; allergic keratitis; anterior uveitis; Behcet's syndrome; blepharitis; chorioiditis; chronic uveitis; conjunctivitis; contact lens-induced keratoconjunctivitis; corneal trauma; corneal ulcer; crystalline retinopathy; cystoid macular edema; dacryocystitis; diabetic keratophathy; diabetic macular edema; diabetic retinopathy; dry eye disease; dry age-related macular degeneration; episcleritis; exudative macular edema; Fuchs' Dystrophy; giant cell arteritis; giant papillary conjunctivitis; glaucoma; glaucoma surgery failure; graft rejection; herpes zoster; inflammation after cataract surgery; iridocorneal endothelial syndrome; iritis; keratoconjunctiva sicca; keratoconjunctival inflammatory disease; keratoconus; lattice dystrophy; map-dot-fingerprint dystrophy; necrotic keratitis; neovascular diseases involving the retina, uveal tract or cornea such as neovascular glaucoma, corneal neovascularization; neuroparalytic keratitis; non-infectious uveitisocular herpes; ocular rosacea; ophthalmic infections; ophthalmic pemphigoid; optic neuritis; panuveitis; papillitis; pars planitis; persistent macular edema; phacoanaphylaxis; posterior uveitis; post-operative inflammation; proliferative diabetic retinopathy; proliferative sickle cell retinopathy; proliferative vitreoretinopathy; retinal artery occlusion; retinal detachment; retinal vein occlusion; retinitis pigmentosa; retinopathy of prematurity; rubeosis iritis; scleritis; Stevens-Johnson syndrome; sympathetic ophthalmia; temporal arteritis; uveitis; vernal conjunctivitis; vitamin A insufficiency-induced keratomalacia; vitreitis; or wet age-related macular degeneration.
13. The method of claim 11, further comprising administering to said patient an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, or antimycotic agent.
14. A method for treating pain associated with a musculoskeletal disorder, said method comprising administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3, wherein the drugs are administered simultaneously or within fourteen days of each other in amounts sufficient to treat said patient.
15. A method for treating a musculoskeletal disorder, said method comprising administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3, wherein the drugs are administered simultaneously or within fourteen days of each other in amounts sufficient to treat said patient.
16. A method for treating periodontal disease, said method comprising administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3, wherein the drugs are administered in amounts and for a duration that together are sufficient to treat periodontal disease.
17. A method for reducing the serum C-reactive protein (CRP) level in a patient in need thereof, said method comprising administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3, wherein the drugs are administered in amounts and for a duration that together are sufficient to reduce the serum CRP level in said patient.
18. A method for treating a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level in a patient in need thereof, said method comprising administering to the patient a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3, wherein the drugs are administered in amounts and for a duration that together are sufficient to reduce the serum CRP level in said patient.
19. The method of any one of claims 8, 11, and 14-18, wherein one or both drugs in said pair are administered in a low dosage.
20. The method of any one of claims 8, 11, and 14-18, wherein one or both drugs in said pair are administered in a high dosage.
21. The method of any one of claims 8, 11, and 14-18, wherein said first drug and said second drug are administered within 10 days of each other.
22. The method of claim 21, wherein said first drug and said second drug are administered within five days of each other.
23. The method of claim 22, wherein said said first drug and said second drug are administered within twenty-four hours of each other.
24. The method of claim 23, wherein said first drug and said second drug are administered simultaneously.
25. A composition comprising (i) drug listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) a second compound selected from the group consisting of an anti-VEGF compound, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, or antimycotic agent.
26. A kit, comprising: (i) a composition comprising a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) instructions for administering said composition to a patient diagnosed with or at risk of developing an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
27. A kit, comprising: (i) a first drug from a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3; (ii) a second drug from said drug pair; and (iii) instructions for administering said first drug and said second drug to a patient diagnosed with or at risk of developing an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
28. A kit comprising (i) a first drug from a drug pair selected from the pairs listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) instructions for administering said first drug and a second drug from said drug pair to a patient diagnosed with or at risk of developing an immunoinflammatory disorder, an ophthalmic disorder, a musculoskeletal disorder or pain associated therewith, a periodontal disease, or a disease or condition associated with an increased serum CRP level.
29. A kit, comprising: (i) a first drug listed on Table 1A or Table 3; (ii) a second drug selected from an anti-VEGF compound, photodynamic therapy, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, and antimycotic agent; and (iii) instructions for administering said first drug and said second drug to a patient diagnosed with an ophthalmic disorder.
30. A kit comprising (i) a first drug listed on Table 1A or Table 3; and (ii) instructions for administering said first drug and a second drug selected from an anti-VEGF compound, photodynamic therapy, corticosteroid, NSAID, antiallergic agent, antihistamine, glaucoma-treating agent, antibiotic, antiviral agent, and antimycotic agent to a patient diagnosed with an ophthalmic disorder.
US11/594,436 2005-11-09 2006-11-08 Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of medical conditions Abandoned US20070225217A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US11/594,436 US20070225217A1 (en) 2005-11-09 2006-11-08 Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of medical conditions

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US73598905P 2005-11-09 2005-11-09
US11/594,436 US20070225217A1 (en) 2005-11-09 2006-11-08 Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of medical conditions

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/543,991 Continuation-In-Part US20120003311A9 (en) 2004-03-26 2006-10-06 Method for controlled release of an acid-unstable physiologically active substance

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20070225217A1 true US20070225217A1 (en) 2007-09-27

Family

ID=38023959

Family Applications (4)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/594,436 Abandoned US20070225217A1 (en) 2005-11-09 2006-11-08 Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of medical conditions
US11/594,428 Expired - Fee Related US8067433B2 (en) 2005-11-09 2006-11-08 Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders
US13/305,391 Expired - Fee Related US8258153B2 (en) 2005-11-09 2011-11-28 Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders
US13/597,996 Abandoned US20120322746A1 (en) 2005-11-09 2012-08-29 Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders

Family Applications After (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/594,428 Expired - Fee Related US8067433B2 (en) 2005-11-09 2006-11-08 Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders
US13/305,391 Expired - Fee Related US8258153B2 (en) 2005-11-09 2011-11-28 Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders
US13/597,996 Abandoned US20120322746A1 (en) 2005-11-09 2012-08-29 Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders

Country Status (18)

Country Link
US (4) US20070225217A1 (en)
EP (2) EP2218442A1 (en)
JP (2) JP2009514969A (en)
KR (1) KR20080065704A (en)
CN (1) CN101355876B (en)
AR (1) AR058182A1 (en)
AU (1) AU2006311577B2 (en)
BR (1) BRPI0618643A2 (en)
CA (1) CA2628570A1 (en)
HK (1) HK1128593A1 (en)
IL (2) IL191283A (en)
MX (1) MX2008006076A (en)
NO (1) NO20082473L (en)
NZ (1) NZ568694A (en)
RU (1) RU2008122978A (en)
TW (1) TWI435729B (en)
WO (1) WO2007056457A2 (en)
ZA (3) ZA200804550B (en)

Cited By (29)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20050165079A1 (en) * 2004-01-22 2005-07-28 Shanler Stuart D. Method and therapeutic/cosmetic topical compositions for the treatment of rosacea and skin erythema using a1-adrenoceptor agonists
US20070105761A1 (en) * 2005-11-09 2007-05-10 Combinatorx, Incorporated Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of opthalmic disorders
US20090130027A1 (en) * 2007-11-16 2009-05-21 Aspect Pharmaceuticals Llc Compositions and methods for treating purpura
WO2010025266A1 (en) * 2008-08-27 2010-03-04 University Of Iowa Research Foundation Inhibitors of phosphodiesterase type 5a for treating or preventing muscle disease or the symptoms thereof in a patient
US20100105738A1 (en) * 2006-10-06 2010-04-29 Mitsuru Mizuno Extended release formulations of a proton pump inhibitor
US20100285134A1 (en) * 2008-02-15 2010-11-11 Bone Therepeutics Pharmaceutical composition for use in the treatment and/or the prevention of osteoarticular diseases
US20100304416A1 (en) * 2007-09-11 2010-12-02 Puymirat Jack Prostaglandin e2 modulation and uses thereof
US20110027236A1 (en) * 2008-02-15 2011-02-03 Bone Therapeutics Pharmaceutical composition for use in the treatment or prevention of osteoarticular diseases
WO2011047256A1 (en) * 2009-10-16 2011-04-21 Duke University Compositions and methods for the treatment of drug-induced hand-foot syndrome
US20110104083A1 (en) * 2009-10-30 2011-05-05 Intratus, Inc. Methods and cosmetic preparations for the sustained delivery of therapeutic agents to the eye
US8277459B2 (en) 2009-09-25 2012-10-02 Tarsus Medical Inc. Methods and devices for treating a structural bone and joint deformity
WO2012149285A1 (en) * 2011-04-28 2012-11-01 Claire Mitchell Method for treatment of macular degeneration by modulating p2y12 or p2x7 receptors
WO2013169315A1 (en) * 2012-05-09 2013-11-14 Hill David W Method for treating macular degeneration
US8652141B2 (en) 2010-01-21 2014-02-18 Tarsus Medical Inc. Methods and devices for treating hallux valgus
US8696719B2 (en) 2010-06-03 2014-04-15 Tarsus Medical Inc. Methods and devices for treating hallux valgus
WO2014074995A1 (en) * 2012-11-09 2014-05-15 Scidose, Llc Enema composition for treatment of ulcerative colitis having long term stability
WO2014117117A1 (en) * 2013-01-28 2014-07-31 The Johns Hopkins University Chronic nsaid treatment for fuchs endothelial corneal dystrophy
US8870876B2 (en) 2009-02-13 2014-10-28 Tarsus Medical Inc. Methods and devices for treating hallux valgus
US20150246966A1 (en) * 2010-02-25 2015-09-03 Schepens Eye Research Institute Therapeutic Compositions for the Treatment of Dry Eye Disease
US20160326255A1 (en) * 2007-07-26 2016-11-10 Osaka University Therapeutic agents for ocular inflammatory disease comprising interleukin 6 receptor inhibitor as active ingredient
US9901580B2 (en) 2013-03-12 2018-02-27 O.D. Ocular Discovery Ltd. Methods of eye treatment using therapeutic compositions containing dipyridamole
US10064877B2 (en) 2003-08-29 2018-09-04 Therapeutic Research, Llc Materials and methods for treatment and diagnosis of disorders associated with oxidative stress
US20190008920A1 (en) * 2017-05-19 2019-01-10 Ocugen, Inc. Ophthalmic compositions and methods of use
US10208049B2 (en) 2009-12-08 2019-02-19 Case Western Reserve University Compounds and methods of treating ocular disorders
US10322129B2 (en) 2015-06-08 2019-06-18 O.D. Ocular Discovery Ltd. Therapeutic compositions containing dipyridamole, treatment packs and kits including such compositions and methods for producing same
US20200123201A1 (en) * 2015-05-01 2020-04-23 Onl Therapeutics, Inc. Peptide compositions and methods of use
US20210008042A1 (en) * 2009-12-11 2021-01-14 Medregen, Llc Treatment methods utilizing stem cell mobilizers and immunosuppressive agents
WO2022094422A1 (en) * 2020-10-30 2022-05-05 The Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University Drugs targeting inflammation for the treatment of osteoarthritis and other inflammatory diseases
EP3843721A4 (en) * 2018-08-29 2022-10-12 Ocugen, Inc. Ophthalmic compositions and methods of use

Families Citing this family (37)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7691811B2 (en) * 2006-05-25 2010-04-06 Bodor Nicholas S Transporter-enhanced corticosteroid activity and methods and compositions for treating dry eye
US20080146497A1 (en) * 2006-07-25 2008-06-19 Graham Richard S Cyclosporin Compositions
US9561178B2 (en) 2006-07-25 2017-02-07 Allergan, Inc. Cyclosporin compositions
US20100081681A1 (en) * 2006-08-16 2010-04-01 Blagosklonny Mikhail V Methods and compositions for preventing or treating age-related diseases
AU2008310956B2 (en) 2007-10-08 2014-08-07 Aurinia Pharmaceuticals Inc. Ophthalmic compositions comprising calcineurin inhibitors or mTOR inhibitors
MX2011000247A (en) * 2008-07-10 2011-03-30 Inspire Pharmaceuticals Inc Method of treating blepharitis.
WO2010048264A2 (en) * 2008-10-23 2010-04-29 Combinatorx, Incorporated Methods and compositions for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders
WO2010085572A1 (en) * 2009-01-23 2010-07-29 Inspire Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method of treating dry eye disease with azithromycin
FR2942138A1 (en) * 2009-02-16 2010-08-20 Galderma Res & Dev ASSOCIATION OF COMPOUNDS FOR THE TREATMENT OR PREVENTION OF DERMATOLOGICAL DISEASES
CN102612564B (en) * 2009-04-10 2015-08-26 齐海燕 New anti-ageing reagent and discrimination method thereof
US20110009339A1 (en) * 2009-04-14 2011-01-13 Allergan, Inc Method of treating blurred vision and other conditions of the eye with cyclosporin compositions
WO2010125416A1 (en) * 2009-04-27 2010-11-04 Raouf Rekik Drug delivery to the anterior and posterior segments of the eye
WO2010127301A1 (en) * 2009-05-01 2010-11-04 Allergan, Inc. Method of treating allergic conjunctivitis with cyclosporin compositions
US20120114637A1 (en) * 2009-05-04 2012-05-10 Santen Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Mtor pathway inhibitors for treating ocular disorders
CN102458370A (en) * 2009-06-09 2012-05-16 卢克斯生物科技公司 Topical drug delivery systems for ophthalmic use
GB0915319D0 (en) * 2009-09-03 2009-10-07 Sharma Anant Combination medicament
DE202009017772U1 (en) * 2009-12-10 2011-04-21 Orthogen Ag Combination preparations with cytokine antagonist and corticosteroid
US20140147413A1 (en) * 2011-02-28 2014-05-29 Dong Feng Chen Therapies That Target Autoimmunity For Treating Glaucoma And Optic Neuropathy
EP2809319B1 (en) * 2012-02-02 2018-04-18 The University of Sydney Improvements in tear film stability
JP6231857B2 (en) * 2012-11-13 2017-11-15 徳人 ▲高▼村 Ophthalmic combination that enhances the effect of drugs with binding affinity for albumin in aqueous humor
GB201222455D0 (en) * 2012-12-13 2013-01-30 Perioc Ltd Novel pharmaceutical formulations and their use in the treatment of periodontaldisease
IL225179A (en) * 2013-03-12 2017-01-31 Rogosnitzky Moshe Compositions for use in treating eye disorders using dipyridamole
US9254289B2 (en) 2013-03-13 2016-02-09 Remedeye Inc. Methods for treating eye disorders using dipyridamole
WO2015187997A1 (en) * 2014-06-04 2015-12-10 Tersus Pharmaceuticals, LLC METHODS OF TREATING CHRONIC DRY EYE DISEASE USING C16:1n7 PALMITOLEATE AND DERIVATIVES THEREOF
US9980976B2 (en) * 2015-02-17 2018-05-29 Northwestern University Use of REDD1 inhibitors to dissociate therapeutic and adverse atrophogenic effects of glucocorticoid receptor agonists
CN108271374B (en) 2015-07-07 2021-09-21 科德克希思公司 Novel P450-BM3 variants with improved activity
AU2016290197B2 (en) 2015-07-08 2021-07-22 Axerovision, Inc. Pharmaceutical compositions comprising an integrin alpha4 antagonist for use in treating ocular inflammatory conditions
US20190224275A1 (en) 2017-05-12 2019-07-25 Aurinia Pharmaceuticals Inc. Protocol for treatment of lupus nephritis
RU2019143602A (en) * 2017-05-24 2021-06-24 Конинклейке Филипс Н.В. DIAGNOSTICS OF GINGIVITIS BASED ON IL-1BETA AND HEPATOCYTES GROWTH FACTOR IN SALIVA
CA3067332A1 (en) 2017-06-16 2018-12-20 The Doshisha Mtor-inhibitor-containing medicine for treating or preventing ophthalmic symptoms, disorders, or diseases, and application thereof
US20200121652A1 (en) * 2017-06-16 2020-04-23 The Doshisha Compounds having caspase inhibitory activity, pharmaceutical agent containing said compounds and for treating or preventing corneal endothelial symptoms, disorders, or diseases, and application of said pharmaceutical agent
WO2019173744A1 (en) * 2018-03-09 2019-09-12 Portola Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods of use and pharmaceutical compositions of a selective syk inhibitor
RU2668713C1 (en) * 2018-03-16 2018-10-02 Федеральное государственное бюджетное учреждение "Московский научно-исследовательский институт глазных болезней имени Гельмгольца" Министерства здравоохранения Российской Федерации Method of treatment of central corneal ulcers of bacterial and herpetic etiology
CN109119165A (en) * 2018-08-27 2019-01-01 珠海为凡医疗信息技术有限公司 A kind of prevalence of cataract risk checking method, device and electronic equipment
CA3116577A1 (en) * 2018-10-19 2020-04-23 Medicinova, Inc. Methods of treating ophthalmic disease/disorder or injury with ibudilast
MX2022013665A (en) 2020-05-01 2022-11-30 Ripple Therapeutics Corp Heterodimer compositions and methods for the treatment of ocular disorders.
EP4213827A1 (en) * 2020-09-21 2023-07-26 Antares Pharma, Inc. Aqueous pharmaceutical formulation of hydrocortisone sodium phosphate and monothioglycerol

Citations (27)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4512978A (en) * 1980-01-24 1985-04-23 Inwood Louis R Dermatological composition useful in the treatment of psoriasis
US4569935A (en) * 1983-03-17 1986-02-11 University Of Tennessee Research Corp. Topical treatment of psoriasis with imidazole antibiotics
US4839342A (en) * 1987-09-03 1989-06-13 University Of Georgia Research Foundation, Inc. Method of increasing tear production by topical administration of cyclosporin
US5411952A (en) * 1987-09-03 1995-05-02 University Of Georgia Research Foundation, Inc. Ocular cyclosporine composition
US5474979A (en) * 1994-05-17 1995-12-12 Allergan, Inc. Nonirritating emulsions for sensitive tissue
US5981607A (en) * 1998-01-20 1999-11-09 Allergan Emulsion eye drop for alleviation of dry eye related symptoms in dry eye patients and/or contact lens wearers
US6254860B1 (en) * 1999-04-13 2001-07-03 Allergan Sales, Inc. Ocular treatment using cyclosporin-A derivatives
US6331313B1 (en) * 1999-10-22 2001-12-18 Oculex Pharmaceticals, Inc. Controlled-release biocompatible ocular drug delivery implant devices and methods
US6369116B1 (en) * 1995-06-02 2002-04-09 Oculex Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Composition and method for treating glaucoma
US20030216431A1 (en) * 2002-05-17 2003-11-20 Rajeev Raut Ophthalmic pharmaceutical compositions and methods for treating ocular inflammation
US6677304B2 (en) * 2000-04-07 2004-01-13 Laboratorie Medidom S.A. Ophthalmic formulations
US20040151754A1 (en) * 2002-12-20 2004-08-05 Control Delivery Systems, Inc. Steroid suspensions for intraocular use
US20040152664A1 (en) * 1998-09-02 2004-08-05 Allergan, Inc. Prednisolone compositions
US20040180868A1 (en) * 2003-03-12 2004-09-16 Mullally John P. Composition and method for treating inflammations by reducing C-reactive protein
US6809077B2 (en) * 2001-10-12 2004-10-26 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Cyclosporin analogs for the treatment of autoimmune diseases
US20040259863A1 (en) * 2001-10-31 2004-12-23 Hans-Michael Eggenweiler Type 4 phosphodiesterase inhibitors and uses thereof
US20050059583A1 (en) * 2003-09-15 2005-03-17 Allergan, Inc. Methods of providing therapeutic effects using cyclosporin components
US6872705B2 (en) * 2001-07-13 2005-03-29 Allergan, Inc. Use of antimicrobial peptides as preservatives in ophthalmic preparations, including solutions, emulsions, and suspensions
US20050112069A1 (en) * 2002-03-06 2005-05-26 Rolf Beume Pharmaceutical composition of a pde4 or pde 3/4 inhibitor and histamine receptor antagonist
US20050112199A1 (en) * 2003-09-24 2005-05-26 Mahesh Padval Therapeutic regimens for administering drug combinations
US20050192261A1 (en) * 2003-09-15 2005-09-01 Jost-Price Edward R. Methods and reagents for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders
US20050256081A1 (en) * 2004-02-26 2005-11-17 Peyman Gholam A Tetracycline derivatives for the treatment of ocular pathologies
US20050277584A1 (en) * 2004-06-09 2005-12-15 Allergan, Inc. Pharmaceutical compositions comprising cyclosporins
US20060003982A1 (en) * 2004-03-29 2006-01-05 William Williams Pyridyl-substituted porphyrin compounds and methods of use thereof
US20060002963A1 (en) * 2004-07-02 2006-01-05 Laura Rabinovich-Guilatt Use of emulsions for intra and periocular injections
US20060122152A1 (en) * 2004-12-03 2006-06-08 Peyman Gholam A Heparin for the treatment of ocular pathologies
US20060148686A1 (en) * 2004-12-30 2006-07-06 Bausch & Lomb Incorporated Ophthalmic compositions comprising steroid and cyclosporine for dry eye therapy

Family Cites Families (365)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3282942A (en) 1966-11-01 Substituted cycloalkanoindoles
US532248A (en) 1895-01-08 powell
US2554736A (en) 1951-05-29 Tertiary aminoalkyl-iminodibenzyls
US2868818A (en) 1953-12-15 1959-01-13 Merck & Co Inc Alpha methyl phenylalanines
US3046283A (en) 1957-08-19 1962-07-24 Merck & Co Inc 10-(omega-aminoalkylidene)-thioxanthenes
NL110232C (en) 1958-12-06
US3409640A (en) 1959-07-22 1968-11-05 Schering Corp 5-(3'-dimethylamino-2'-methyl-propyl)dibenzocycloheptenes
NL256049A (en) 1959-09-22
NL274885A (en) 1960-09-16
US3454554A (en) 1960-10-14 1969-07-08 Colgate Palmolive Co Aminoalkyliminodibenzyl compounds
FR1332145A (en) 1961-06-08 1963-12-16
US3158648A (en) 1962-04-09 1964-11-24 Merck & Co Inc Direct resolution of alpha-methyl-3, 4-dihydroxyphenylalanine
US3202660A (en) 1961-10-09 1965-08-24 Boehringer Sohn Ingelheim Process for the preparation of 3-arylamino-1, 3-diazacycloalkenes
BE674185A (en) 1961-10-10
CH426833A (en) 1962-03-27 1966-12-31 Dumex Ltd As Process for the preparation of the N-oxide of N- (3-dimethylamino-propyl) -iminodibenzyl or its salts
US3205264A (en) 1962-06-15 1965-09-07 Merck & Co Inc Process for the preparation of 10, 11-dihydro-5-(gamma-methyl-and dimethyl-amino propylidene)-5h-dibenzo[a, d] cycloheptene
US3271451A (en) 1962-07-03 1966-09-06 Merck & Co Inc Process for preparing 5-(3-methylaminopropyl)-5h-dibenzo [a, d] cycloheptenes
US3244748A (en) 1962-07-03 1966-04-05 Merck & Co Inc 5h-dibenzo [a, d] cycloheptenes
US3922305A (en) 1962-08-09 1975-11-25 Merck & Co Inc Chemical compounds
BE636717A (en) 1962-08-31
US3310553A (en) 1962-09-25 1967-03-21 Pfizer & Co C Alkylated thioxathenesulfonamides
GB991651A (en) 1963-02-20 1965-05-12 Dumex Ltd As Dibenzocycloheptadiene derivatives
US3389139A (en) 1963-06-14 1968-06-18 Wander Ag Dr A 6-homopiperazino and piperazinomorphanthridines
FR88751E (en) 1963-07-09 1967-06-07
US3981917A (en) 1963-07-25 1976-09-21 Merck & Co., Inc. Chemical compounds
US3978121A (en) 1963-07-25 1976-08-31 Merck & Co., Inc. 5H Dibenzo[a,d]cycloheptene derivatives
US3963778A (en) 1965-11-10 1976-06-15 Bayer Aktiengesellschaft Basic oximes and their preparation
US3505321A (en) 1965-11-24 1970-04-07 Bayer Ag Basically substituted oximes of 5h-dibenzo-(a,d)10,11-dihydro-cycloheptenylidene and their preparation
NL129434C (en) 1966-03-12
GB1192812A (en) 1966-05-20 1970-05-20 American Cyanamid Co 2-Chloro-11-(1-Piperazinyl)Dibenz[b,f]-[1,4]Oxazepine, Non-Toxic Acid Addition Salts thereof, and Therapeutic Compositions containing said Oxazepine or Salts
FR1532301A (en) 1967-01-18 1968-07-12 Rhone Poulenc Sa New derivatives of dibenzazepine and their preparation
US3539573A (en) 1967-03-22 1970-11-10 Jean Schmutz 11-basic substituted dibenzodiazepines and dibenzothiazepines
GB1177525A (en) 1967-04-13 1970-01-14 Leo Ab New Heterocyclic Aminoketones of Therapeutic Interest
CH479559A (en) 1967-09-26 1969-10-15 Wander Ag Dr A Process for the preparation of acylguanidines
US3892777A (en) 1968-05-01 1975-07-01 Hoffmann La Roche Substituted benzylethylenedicarbamates
US3758528A (en) 1970-03-13 1973-09-11 Science Union & Cie Tricyclic compounds
US4045580A (en) 1971-02-23 1977-08-30 Ciba-Geigy Corporation Pharmaceutical preparation using 9-(2-hydroxy-3-amino-propyl)-9,10-dihydro-9,10-ethano-anthracenes as antidepressants
US4017542A (en) 1971-02-23 1977-04-12 Ciba-Geigy Corporation 9-(2-Hydroxy-3-amino-propyl)-9,10-dihydro-9,10-ethano-anthracenes and salts thereof
US4250094A (en) 1971-04-28 1981-02-10 The Upjohn Company 1-(Aminoalkyl) substituted-6-phenyl-4H-s-triazolo[4,3-a][1,4]benzodiazepines
BE795970A (en) 1972-02-29 1973-08-27 Pfizer NEW DERIVATIVES OF QUINOLEINE, QUINOXALINE AND QUINAZOLINE ER PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION CONTAINING THEM
US4029792A (en) 1972-02-29 1977-06-14 Pfizer Inc. (2-Imidazolin-2-ylamino) substituted -quinoxalines and -quinazolines as antihypertensive agents
JPS5229318B2 (en) 1972-03-30 1977-08-01
CH570401A5 (en) 1972-05-09 1975-12-15 Wander Ag Dr A
GB1422263A (en) 1973-01-30 1976-01-21 Ferrosan As 4-phenyl-piperidine compounds
US4020096A (en) 1974-02-01 1977-04-26 Merck & Co., Inc. 10,11,Dihydro-N-alkoxycarbonyl-10,10,11,11-tetrafluoro-5H-dibenzo[a,d]cycloheptene-5-methylamines
US4193926A (en) 1974-03-20 1980-03-18 Schering Aktiengesellschaft 4-(Polyalkoxy phenyl)-2-pyrrolidones
US4097483A (en) 1974-11-01 1978-06-27 Kyorin Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Pyrazolo 1,5-a!pyridines
US4017621A (en) 1974-12-09 1977-04-12 Sumitomo Chemical Company, Limited 2-Morpholinyl tricyclic dibenzazepine compounds
US3956296A (en) 1974-12-11 1976-05-11 A. H. Robins Company, Incorporated 1-Substituted-4-benzylpiperidines
US4224344A (en) 1974-12-13 1980-09-23 Sumitomo Chemical Company, Limited Organic tricyclic compounds
US4358620A (en) 1974-12-13 1982-11-09 Sumitomo Chemical Company, Limited 9-Formyl-9,10-dihydro-9,10-methanoanthracene
NL189199C (en) 1975-04-05 1993-02-01 Akzo Nv PROCESS FOR THE PREPARATION OF PHARMACEUTICAL PREPARATIONS WITH ACTION ON THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM BASED ON BENZ (ARYL) AZEPINE DERIVATIVES, THE PHARMACEUTICAL PREPARATIONS OBTAINED, AND METHOD FOR PREPARING THE PRODUCT TO BE USED.
US4048223A (en) 1975-04-11 1977-09-13 Merck & Co., Inc. 3-Dimethylsulfamoyl-5-[amino(alkyl or alkylidene)]-5H-dibenzo [a,d]cycloheptenes
US4014335A (en) 1975-04-21 1977-03-29 Alza Corporation Ocular drug delivery device
JPS527972A (en) 1975-07-07 1977-01-21 Sumitomo Chem Co Ltd Process for preparing novel morpholine derivatives
FR2319333A1 (en) 1975-07-28 1977-02-25 Roussel Uclaf NEW DERIVATIVES OF 7-AMINO 6,7-DIHYDRO / 5H / BENZOCYCLOHEPTENE AND THEIR SALTS, PROCESS FOR THE PREPARATION AND APPLICATION AS MEDICINAL PRODUCTS OF THESE PRODUCTS
US4128641A (en) 1975-07-31 1978-12-05 Hzi Research Center Inc. Tetracyclic psychotropic drug
GB1531278A (en) 1975-12-15 1978-11-08 Shionogi & Co 9,10-dihydro-9,10-methanoanthracene n-oxide derivatives and the production thereof
US4088647A (en) 1976-02-04 1978-05-09 Glushkov Robert Georgievich Pyrazino (1,2,3-ab)-β-carboline derivatives and salts thereof and method of preparing same
NL7610942A (en) 1976-10-02 1978-04-04 Akzo Nv PROCESS FOR PREPARING 1,4-DIAZEPINE DERIVATIVES.
US4160452A (en) 1977-04-07 1979-07-10 Alza Corporation Osmotic system having laminated wall comprising semipermeable lamina and microporous lamina
US4256108A (en) 1977-04-07 1981-03-17 Alza Corporation Microporous-semipermeable laminated osmotic system
IE46852B1 (en) 1977-06-10 1983-10-05 Otsuka Pharma Co Ltd Novel carbostyril derivatives
DE2727481A1 (en) 1977-06-18 1979-01-11 Basf Ag THERAPEUTICAL AGENTS CONTAINING DIHYDROPYRIDAZONE AND DIHYDROPYRIDAZONE
CA1114379A (en) 1977-11-03 1981-12-15 Pfizer Corporation Piperidino-phthalazines
SE445174B (en) 1978-03-07 1986-06-09 Sandoz Ag PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION CONTAINING A CYCLOSPORIN AND A HEALING SUBSTANCE
NL171194C (en) 1978-05-23 1983-02-16 Giesen Metaalgieterij HOT WATER BOILER FOR EXAMPLE, A CENTRAL HEATING BOILER.
US4287175A (en) 1978-06-22 1981-09-01 Merck & Co., Inc. Contact lens wetting agents
DE2837161A1 (en) 1978-08-25 1980-03-06 Thomae Gmbh Dr K 5-Alkyl:pyridazinyl substd. benzimidazole derivs. - useful as cardiovascular agents, antivirals, interferon inducers and ulcer inhibitors
NL7809726A (en) 1978-09-26 1980-03-28 Akzo Nv NEW TETRACYCLIC CONNECTIONS.
PH16099A (en) 1979-03-06 1983-06-24 Yamanouchi Pharma Co Ltd Guanidinothiazole compounds,process for preparing them and medical composition containing them
JPS6056143B2 (en) 1979-08-02 1985-12-09 山之内製薬株式会社 Amidine derivatives and their production method
US4254130A (en) 1979-04-10 1981-03-03 Richardson-Merrell Inc. Piperidine derivatives
US4285958A (en) 1979-04-10 1981-08-25 Richardson-Merrell Inc. 1-Piperidine-alkylene ketones, pharmaceutical compositions thereof and method of use thereof
US4254129A (en) 1979-04-10 1981-03-03 Richardson-Merrell Inc. Piperidine derivatives
US4285957A (en) 1979-04-10 1981-08-25 Richardson-Merrell Inc. 1-Piperidine-alkanol derivatives, pharmaceutical compositions thereof, and method of use thereof
NZ193935A (en) 1979-06-18 1985-05-31 Richardson Merrell Inc 4-aroyl-imidazol-2-one derivatives;pharmaceutical compositions
NZ195564A (en) 1979-11-26 1983-09-30 Sterling Drug Inc 5-pyridinyl-2(1h)-pyridinones pharmaceutical compositions intermediate pyridine compounds
US4300557A (en) 1980-01-07 1981-11-17 The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Department Of Health And Human Services Method for treating intraocular malignancies
DE3009034A1 (en) 1980-03-08 1981-09-24 Basf Ag, 6700 Ludwigshafen 10-SUBSTITUTED 5-CYANMETHYLENE DIBENZO (A, D) -CYCLOHEPTNE
US4265874A (en) 1980-04-25 1981-05-05 Alza Corporation Method of delivering drug with aid of effervescent activity generated in environment of use
US4394508A (en) 1980-06-07 1983-07-19 Bristol-Myers Company Chemical compounds
US4316885A (en) 1980-08-25 1982-02-23 Ayerst, Mckenna And Harrison, Inc. Acyl derivatives of rapamycin
EP0056782B1 (en) 1981-01-09 1984-08-01 Sandoz Ag Novel cyclosporins
US4513002A (en) 1981-01-16 1985-04-23 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Cycloheptene derivatives
US4510309A (en) 1981-03-03 1985-04-09 Bristol-Myers Company Histamine H2 -antagonists
US4877805A (en) 1985-07-26 1989-10-31 Kligman Albert M Methods for treatment of sundamaged human skin with retinoids
JPS5851853A (en) 1981-09-18 1983-03-26 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co Ltd Emulsifier for food
PT75625B (en) 1981-10-08 1985-12-09 Merck & Co Inc Process for preparing biosoluble ocular insert
US4517199A (en) 1981-11-20 1985-05-14 Alcon Laboratories, Inc. Method for lowering intraocular pressure using phenylimino-imidazoles
US4486432A (en) 1982-09-30 1984-12-04 Eli Lilly And Company Quinoxalinedione leukotriene release inhibitors
DE3241102A1 (en) 1982-11-06 1984-05-10 A. Nattermann & Cie GmbH, 5000 Köln IMIDAZOLYLALKYLTHIENYL TETRAHYDROPYRIDAZINE AND METHOD FOR THE PRODUCTION THEREOF
FR2541680B1 (en) 1983-02-24 1985-06-14 Rhone Poulenc Sante NEW AMINO-5 DITHIOLE-1,2 ONE-3 DERIVATIVES, THEIR PREPARATION AND THE MEDICINAL COMPOSITIONS CONTAINING THEM
JPS59167590A (en) 1983-03-14 1984-09-21 Kyorin Pharmaceut Co Ltd Pyrazolo(1,5-a)pyridine derivative, its preparation and remedy containing the same
US4440933A (en) 1983-03-16 1984-04-03 Bristol-Myers Company Process for preparing 1,2,5-thiadiazoles
US5169637A (en) 1983-03-24 1992-12-08 The Liposome Company, Inc. Stable plurilamellar vesicles
CA1237671A (en) 1983-08-01 1988-06-07 Michael W. Fountain Enhancement of pharmaceutical activity
GB8321157D0 (en) 1983-08-05 1983-09-07 Fordonal Sa Piperidine derivatives
GB8400863D0 (en) 1984-01-13 1984-02-15 Smith Kline French Lab Chemical compounds
US4894366A (en) 1984-12-03 1990-01-16 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Company, Ltd. Tricyclo compounds, a process for their production and a pharmaceutical composition containing the same
US5639724A (en) 1984-07-24 1997-06-17 Sandoz Ltd. Cyclosporin galenic forms
US4582822A (en) 1984-10-09 1986-04-15 Eli Lilly And Company Antibiotic A80190, pharmaceutical compositions containing same and method of use
US5254562A (en) 1984-12-03 1993-10-19 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Company, Ltd. Tricyclo compounds, a process for their production and a pharmaceutical composition containing the same
GB8509276D0 (en) 1985-04-11 1985-05-15 Smith Kline French Lab Pyridine derivatives
US4824863A (en) 1985-05-28 1989-04-25 Eli Lilly And Company Antibiotic A80438
US4975282A (en) 1985-06-26 1990-12-04 The Liposome Company, Inc. Multilamellar liposomes having improved trapping efficiencies
US5409704A (en) 1985-06-26 1995-04-25 The Liposome Company, Inc. Liposomes comprising aminoglycoside phosphates and methods of production and use
JPS625963A (en) 1985-07-02 1987-01-12 Mitsui Toatsu Chem Inc Isoquinoline derivative
US4655074A (en) 1985-08-12 1987-04-07 The Babcock & Wilcox Company Self-zeroing pressure transmitter with automatic pressure manifold
FR2588189B1 (en) 1985-10-03 1988-12-02 Merck Sharp & Dohme LIQUID-GEL PHASE TRANSITION PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION
ZW20586A1 (en) 1985-10-17 1988-05-25 Smith Kline French Lab Chemical compounds
US4650803A (en) 1985-12-06 1987-03-17 University Of Kansas Prodrugs of rapamycin
US5023087A (en) 1986-02-10 1991-06-11 Liposome Technology, Inc. Efficient method for preparation of prolonged release liposome-based drug delivery system
GB8607684D0 (en) 1986-03-27 1986-04-30 Ici America Inc Thiazepine compounds
US4742175A (en) 1986-05-07 1988-05-03 Merrell Dow Pharmaceuticals Inc. Preparation of polymorphically pure terfenadine
IE60901B1 (en) 1986-08-21 1994-08-24 Vestar Inc Improved treatment of systemic fungal infections with phospholipid particles encapsulating polyene antifungal antibiotics
US5049388A (en) 1986-11-06 1991-09-17 Research Development Foundation Small particle aerosol liposome and liposome-drug combinations for medical use
NZ222843A (en) 1986-12-22 1989-10-27 Ortho Pharma Corp Benzoxazinyl- and benzothiazinyl-tetrahydropyridazinones and intermediates, and medicaments
US4956388A (en) 1986-12-22 1990-09-11 Eli Lilly And Company 3-aryloxy-3-substituted propanamines
US4965271A (en) 1986-12-31 1990-10-23 Hoechst Roussel Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method of inhibiting the activity of leukocyte derived cytokines
US5096906A (en) 1986-12-31 1992-03-17 University Of Virginia Alumni Patents Foundation Method of inhibiting the activity of leukocyte derived cytokines
US5272153A (en) 1986-12-31 1993-12-21 Hoechst-Roussel Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method of inhibiting the activity of leukocyte derived cytokines
US5032582A (en) 1987-02-27 1991-07-16 Liposome Technology, Inc. Method for treating fungal infections with amphotericin B/cholesterol sulfate composition
US4798823A (en) 1987-06-03 1989-01-17 Merck & Co., Inc. New cyclosporin analogs with modified "C-9 amino acids"
JP2577049B2 (en) 1987-06-04 1997-01-29 三共株式会社 Cyclosporine preparation
AU614965B2 (en) 1987-06-06 1991-09-19 Merck Patent Gesellschaft Mit Beschrankter Haftung Thiadiazinones
US4925849A (en) 1987-06-15 1990-05-15 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Company, Ltd. Pharmaceutically useful pyrazolopyridines
GB2206880B (en) 1987-07-16 1991-04-24 Farmos Oy Optical isomers of an imidazole derivative
US5227467A (en) 1987-08-03 1993-07-13 Merck & Co., Inc. Immunosuppressive fluorinated cyclosporin analogs
US4833138A (en) 1987-10-23 1989-05-23 Washington University Phenothiazinealkaneamines for treatment of neurotoxic injury
EP0326307B1 (en) 1988-01-23 1994-08-17 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd. Novel pyridazinone derivatives and pharmaceutical preparations containing them
US5188826A (en) 1988-02-08 1993-02-23 Insite Vision Incorporated Topical ophthalmic suspensions
JP2717687B2 (en) 1988-02-13 1998-02-18 日本曹達株式会社 Pyridazinone derivative and method for producing the same
US5238959A (en) 1988-04-08 1993-08-24 Eli Lilly And Company 3-phenyloxy-3-phenyl propanamines
US5314875A (en) 1988-05-02 1994-05-24 Eli Lilly And Company Method for treating swine dysentery with the derivatives of the antibiotic A82810
US4994213A (en) 1988-05-17 1991-02-19 Liposome Technology, Inc. Method of preparing lipid structures
GB2222770B (en) 1988-09-16 1992-07-29 Sandoz Ltd Pharmaceutical compositions containing cyclosporins
US6007840A (en) 1988-09-16 1999-12-28 Novartis Ag Pharmaceutical compositions comprising cyclosporins
US5342625A (en) 1988-09-16 1994-08-30 Sandoz Ltd. Pharmaceutical compositions comprising cyclosporins
US4908372A (en) 1988-10-13 1990-03-13 Merrell Dow Pharmaceuticals Inc. Antihistaminic piperidinyl benzimidazoles
CA2003198C (en) 1988-11-29 1995-03-21 Anthony J. Dziabo, Jr. Aqueous ophthalmic solutions and method for preserving same
GB8827820D0 (en) 1988-11-29 1988-12-29 Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv (1h-azol-1-ylmethyl)substituted quinoline derivatives
US5098443A (en) 1989-03-23 1992-03-24 University Of Miami Method of implanting intraocular and intraorbital implantable devices for the controlled release of pharmacological agents
US5281591A (en) 1989-05-22 1994-01-25 Allergan, Inc. Combinations of selective alpha-adrenergic agonists and antagonists useful in lowering intraocular pressure
US5021410A (en) 1989-05-22 1991-06-04 Allergan, Inc. Combinations of selective alpha-adrenergic agonists and antagonists useful in lowering intraocular pressure
US5180721A (en) 1989-05-22 1993-01-19 Allergan, Inc. Combinations of selective alpha-adrenergic agonists and antagonists useful in lowering intraocular pressure
NZ234186A (en) 1989-07-07 1991-10-25 Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv Imidazo quinazolin-one derivatives and pharmaceutical compositions
US5284826A (en) 1989-07-24 1994-02-08 Sandoz Ltd. 0-hydroxyethyl and acyloxyethyl derivatives of [ser]8 cyclosporins
US5194266A (en) 1989-08-08 1993-03-16 Liposome Technology, Inc. Amphotericin B/cholesterol sulfate composition and method
US5198442A (en) 1989-10-12 1993-03-30 Allergan, Inc. (2-imidazolin-2-ylamino) quinoxaline derivatives and methods for using same
US5231096A (en) 1989-10-12 1993-07-27 Allergan, Inc. Methods for using (2-imidazolin-2-ylamino) quinoxaline derivatives
US5326763A (en) 1989-10-12 1994-07-05 Allergan, Inc. Methods for using (2-imidazolin-2-ylamino) quinoxaline derivatives
US5112822A (en) 1989-10-12 1992-05-12 Allergan, Inc. (2-imidazolin-2-ylamino) quinoxaline derivatives and methods for using same
US5077292A (en) 1989-10-12 1991-12-31 Allergan, Inc. (2-imidazolin-2-ylamino) tetrahydroquinoxalines and methods for using same
US5204347A (en) 1989-10-12 1993-04-20 Allergan, Inc. Methods for using (2-imidazolin-2-ylamino) tetrahydroquinoxalines
US5356633A (en) 1989-10-20 1994-10-18 Liposome Technology, Inc. Method of treatment of inflamed tissues
US5208228A (en) 1989-11-13 1993-05-04 Merck & Co., Inc. Aminomacrolides and derivatives having immunosuppressive activity
US5215991A (en) 1990-01-26 1993-06-01 Allergan, Inc. Combination of selective alpha-adrenergic agonists and Na+ /H+ ex
US5237072A (en) 1990-02-06 1993-08-17 Allergan, Inc. Method for producing amino-2-imidazoline derivatives
US5130441A (en) 1990-02-06 1992-07-14 Allergan, Inc. Method for producing amino-2-imidazoline derivatives
US5122511A (en) 1990-02-27 1992-06-16 Merck & Co., Inc. Immunosuppressive cyclosporin analogs with modified amino acids at position-8
US5252595A (en) 1990-02-28 1993-10-12 Allergan, Inc. Method for reducing or maintaining intraocular pressure in the mammalian eye by administering pharmaceutical compositions containing 2-(2-alkylphenylamino)-oxazolines, 2-(2-alkylphenylamino)-thiazolines and 2-(2-alkylphenylamino)-imidazolines
US4963561A (en) 1990-02-28 1990-10-16 Sterling Drug Inc. Imidazopyridines, their preparation and use
US5124455A (en) 1990-08-08 1992-06-23 American Home Products Corporation Oxime-carbamates and oxime-carbonates as bronchodilators and anti-inflammatory agents
US5091528A (en) 1990-09-12 1992-02-25 Allergan, Inc. 6- or 7- (2-imino-2-imidazolidine)-1,4-benzoxazines as α adrenergic agents
PT98990A (en) 1990-09-19 1992-08-31 American Home Prod PROCESS FOR THE PREPARATION OF CARBOXYLIC ACID ESTERS OF RAPAMICIN
US5143918A (en) 1990-10-11 1992-09-01 Merck & Co., Inc. Halomacrolides and derivatives having immunosuppressive activity
DE4034218A1 (en) 1990-10-27 1992-04-30 Merck Patent Gmbh METHOD FOR PRODUCING CAREBASTIN
US5141931A (en) 1991-01-03 1992-08-25 Sterling Winthrop Inc. 5-Quinolinylpyridinones, cardiotonic compositions and methods
US5378475A (en) 1991-02-21 1995-01-03 University Of Kentucky Research Foundation Sustained release drug delivery devices
US5120842A (en) 1991-04-01 1992-06-09 American Home Products Corporation Silyl ethers of rapamycin
US5100883A (en) 1991-04-08 1992-03-31 American Home Products Corporation Fluorinated esters of rapamycin
US5118678A (en) 1991-04-17 1992-06-02 American Home Products Corporation Carbamates of rapamycin
ATE139439T1 (en) 1991-04-19 1996-07-15 Nexstar Pharmaceuticals Inc PHARMACEUTICAL FORMULATION AND PHARMACEUTICAL PROCESS
US5162334A (en) 1991-05-13 1992-11-10 Merck & Co., Inc. Amino O-alkyl, O-alkenyl and O-alkynlmacrolides having immunosuppressive activity
US5262533A (en) 1991-05-13 1993-11-16 Merck & Co., Inc. Amino O-aryl macrolides having immunosuppressive activity
US5250678A (en) 1991-05-13 1993-10-05 Merck & Co., Inc. O-aryl, O-alkyl, O-alkenyl and O-alkynylmacrolides having immunosuppressive activity
US5120727A (en) 1991-05-29 1992-06-09 American Home Products Corporation Rapamycin dimers
US5120725A (en) 1991-05-29 1992-06-09 American Home Products Corporation Bicyclic rapamycins
IL102236A0 (en) 1991-06-27 1993-01-14 Ltt Inst Co Ltd Topical preparations containing cyclosporin
US5169851A (en) 1991-08-07 1992-12-08 American Home Products Corporation Rapamycin analog as immunosuppressants and antifungals
US5202332A (en) 1991-08-07 1993-04-13 American Home Products Corporation Rapamycin analog as immunosuppressant
US5512575A (en) 1991-08-15 1996-04-30 Zeneca Limited Methanoanthraceneyl methyl piperidinyl compounds
GB9216298D0 (en) 1991-08-15 1992-09-16 Ici Plc Piperidine derivatives
GB9216297D0 (en) 1991-08-15 1992-09-16 Ici Plc Therapeutic agents
US5189042A (en) 1991-08-22 1993-02-23 Merck & Co. Inc. Fluoromacrolides having immunosuppressive activity
US5208241A (en) 1991-09-09 1993-05-04 Merck & Co., Inc. N-heteroaryl, n-alkylheteroaryl, n-alkenylheteroaryl and n-alkynylheteroarylmacrolides having immunosuppressive activity
US5151413A (en) 1991-11-06 1992-09-29 American Home Products Corporation Rapamycin acetals as immunosuppressant and antifungal agents
US5770592A (en) 1991-11-22 1998-06-23 Alcon Laboratories, Inc. Prevention and treatment of ocular neovascularization using angiostatic steroids
US5278150A (en) 1992-04-24 1994-01-11 Whitby Research, Inc. 2-hydrazoadenosines and their utility for the treatmeat of vascular conditions
JP3631490B2 (en) * 1992-05-13 2005-03-23 ノバルティス ファーマ株式会社 Cyclosporine-containing ophthalmic composition
US5284840A (en) 1992-06-12 1994-02-08 Merck & Co., Inc. Alkylidene macrolides having immunosuppressive activity
EP0701443B2 (en) 1992-08-03 2000-11-22 Sepracor, Inc. Terfenadine metabolites and their optically pure isomers for treating allergic disorders
GR1002207B (en) 1992-08-06 1996-03-27 Johnson & Johnson Consumer Skin care compositions containing imidazoles.
US5258389A (en) 1992-11-09 1993-11-02 Merck & Co., Inc. O-aryl, O-alkyl, O-alkenyl and O-alkynylrapamycin derivatives
US5552155A (en) 1992-12-04 1996-09-03 The Liposome Company, Inc. Fusogenic lipsomes and methods for making and using same
MY113268A (en) 1992-12-29 2002-01-31 Insite Vision Incorporated Plasticized bioerodible controlled delivery system
US5504091A (en) 1993-04-23 1996-04-02 American Home Products Corporation Biotin esters of rapamycin
GB9311920D0 (en) 1993-06-09 1993-07-28 Pfizer Ltd Therapeutic agents
ES2129130T3 (en) 1993-06-24 1999-06-01 Albany Molecular Res Inc PIPERIDINE DERIVATIVES AND PROCESS FOR ITS PRODUCTION.
US5965595A (en) 1993-07-01 1999-10-12 The Procter & Gamble Company 2-Imidazolinylamino heterocyclic compounds useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
US5614627A (en) 1993-09-10 1997-03-25 Eisai Co., Ltd. Quinazoline compounds
DE69431880T2 (en) 1993-10-13 2003-09-18 Allergan Inc USE OF (2-IMIDAZOLIN-2-YL-AMINO) QUINOXALINE DERIVATIVES
US6323204B1 (en) 1993-10-13 2001-11-27 Allergan Methods for using (2-imidazolin-2-ylamino) quinoxaline derivatives
US6022852A (en) 1993-10-22 2000-02-08 Hexal Ag Pharmaceutical composition containing cyclosporin A
US5580892A (en) 1993-10-22 1996-12-03 Allergan Method for using 2-(2-alkylphenylamino)-oxazolines as adrenergic agents
KR100327264B1 (en) 1993-10-29 2002-07-02 요시히로 미와 Indole derivatives, salts thereof and therapeutic agents for heart diseases containing the same
US5464840A (en) 1993-12-06 1995-11-07 Schering Corporation Tricyclic derivatives, compositions and methods of use
US5574173A (en) 1993-12-06 1996-11-12 Schering Corporation Tricyclic derivatives, compositions and methods of use
US5478858A (en) 1993-12-17 1995-12-26 The Procter & Gamble Company 5-(2-imidazolinylamino) benzimidazole compounds useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
US6117871A (en) 1993-12-17 2000-09-12 The Procter & Gamble Company 6-(2-imidazolinylamino)quinoxaline compounds useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
DK0736020T3 (en) 1993-12-17 2000-08-07 Procter & Gamble 6- (2-imidazolinylamino) quinoline compounds suitable as alpha-2-adrenoceptor agonists
US5578607A (en) 1993-12-17 1996-11-26 The Procter & Gamble Company 6-(2-imidazolinylamino)quinoline compounds useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
US5576437A (en) 1993-12-17 1996-11-19 The Procter & Gamble Company 7-(2-imidazolnylamino) quinoline compounds useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
CZ175496A3 (en) 1993-12-17 1996-11-13 Procter & Gamble 6-(2-imidazolinylamino)quinoxaline compounds usable as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
GB9514465D0 (en) 1995-07-14 1995-09-13 Glaxo Lab Sa Chemical compounds
GB9401090D0 (en) 1994-01-21 1994-03-16 Glaxo Lab Sa Chemical compounds
DK0693055T3 (en) 1994-02-08 1997-12-15 Alcon Lab Inc Hitherto unknown method for preparing clonidine derivatives
CH687062A5 (en) 1994-02-14 1996-09-13 Cerbios Pharma Sa Concentrated injection solution of alkali metal salts of reduced folates.
US5422116A (en) 1994-02-18 1995-06-06 Ciba-Geigy Corporation Liquid ophthalmic sustained release delivery system
US5773021A (en) 1994-03-14 1998-06-30 Vetoquinol S.A. Bioadhesive ophthalmic insert
US5466233A (en) 1994-04-25 1995-11-14 Escalon Ophthalmics, Inc. Tack for intraocular drug delivery and method for inserting and removing same
IL114193A (en) 1994-06-20 2000-02-29 Teva Pharma Ophthalmic pharmaceutical compositions based on sodium alginate
US5877180A (en) 1994-07-11 1999-03-02 University Of Virginia Patent Foundation Method for treating inflammatory diseases with A2a adenosine receptor agonists
CA2196792A1 (en) 1994-08-04 1996-02-15 Yoon T. Jeon Novel benzimidazole derivatives
WO1996005176A1 (en) 1994-08-09 1996-02-22 Eisai Co., Ltd. Fused pyridazine compound
US5693648A (en) 1994-09-30 1997-12-02 Merck & Co., Inc. O-aryl, O-alkyl, O-alkenyl and O-alkynyl-macrolides having immunosuppressive activity
US5545504A (en) 1994-10-03 1996-08-13 Xerox Corporation Ink jettable toner compositions and processes for making and using
US6294563B1 (en) 1994-10-27 2001-09-25 Allergan Sales, Inc. Combinations of prostaglandins and brimonidine or derivatives thereof
US5856480A (en) 1994-11-11 1999-01-05 Nippon Soda Co., Ltd. Optically active compound
GB9423910D0 (en) 1994-11-26 1995-01-11 Pfizer Ltd Therapeutic agents
US5725493A (en) 1994-12-12 1998-03-10 Avery; Robert Logan Intravitreal medicine delivery
US5693647A (en) 1994-12-22 1997-12-02 Ligand Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Steroid receptor modulator compounds and methods
CA2189355A1 (en) 1995-03-01 1996-09-06 Yasuo Onoda Imidazoquinazoline derivatives
DE19518082A1 (en) 1995-05-17 1996-11-21 Merck Patent Gmbh 4 (-Arylaminomethylene) -2,4-dihydropyrazol-3-one
AU5938996A (en) 1995-06-07 1996-12-30 Nexstar Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method for encapsulating pharmaceutical materials
US5914342A (en) 1995-06-07 1999-06-22 The Procter & Gamble Company 2-imidazolinylamino heterocyclic compounds useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
US5856329A (en) 1995-06-28 1999-01-05 Allergan Method of using (2-imidazolin-2-ylamino) quinoxalines in treating ocular neural injury
US6194415B1 (en) 1995-06-28 2001-02-27 Allergan Sales, Inc. Method of using (2-imidazolin-2-ylamino) quinoxoalines in treating neural injury
US5916900A (en) 1995-06-29 1999-06-29 The Procter & Gamble Company 7-(2-imidazolinylamino)quinoline compounds useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
US5804587A (en) 1995-06-29 1998-09-08 The Procter & Gamble Company 6-(2-imidazolinylamino) quinolines useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
GB9514464D0 (en) 1995-07-14 1995-09-13 Glaxo Lab Sa Medicaments
US5773019A (en) 1995-09-27 1998-06-30 The University Of Kentucky Research Foundation Implantable controlled release device to deliver drugs directly to an internal portion of the body
DE19537012A1 (en) 1995-10-04 1997-04-10 Dietl Hans Pharmaceutical preparation containing cyclosporin (s) for oral administration and process for its preparation
US6201124B1 (en) 1995-12-21 2001-03-13 Albany Molecular Research, Inc. Process for production of piperidine derivatives
US6153754A (en) 1995-12-21 2000-11-28 Albany Molecular Research, Inc. Process for production of piperidine derivatives
YU49898A (en) 1996-05-10 2000-03-21 Icos Corporation Chemical compounds
US5709797A (en) 1996-06-05 1998-01-20 Poli Industria Chimica S.P.A. Method of isolating cyclosporins
US5789416B1 (en) 1996-08-27 1999-10-05 Cv Therapeutics Inc N6 mono heterocyclic substituted adenosine derivatives
ATE234831T1 (en) 1996-10-04 2003-04-15 Novo Nordisk As 1,4-DISUBSTITUTED PIPERAZINE
DE19644228A1 (en) 1996-10-24 1998-04-30 Merck Patent Gmbh Thienopyrimidines
RU2194700C2 (en) 1996-11-25 2002-12-20 Дзе Проктер Энд Гэмбл Компани Guanidyl heterocyclic compounds using as agonists of alpha-2 adrenoceptors
US6306877B1 (en) 1999-08-09 2001-10-23 The Procter & Gamble Co. Guanidinylamino heterocycle compounds useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
BR9713537A (en) 1996-11-25 2000-03-21 Procter & Gamble as alpha-2-adrenoreceptor agonists
US6172095B1 (en) 1996-11-25 2001-01-09 The Procter & Gamble Company Guanidinylamino heterocycle compounds useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
KR100395356B1 (en) 1996-11-25 2003-08-21 더 프록터 앤드 갬블 캄파니 2-Imidazolinylaminoindole compounds useful as alpha-2 adrenoceptor agonists
US5888493A (en) 1996-12-05 1999-03-30 Sawaya; Assad S. Ophthalmic aqueous gel formulation and related methods
US5837713A (en) * 1997-02-26 1998-11-17 Mayo Foundation For Medical Education And Research Treatment of eosinophil-associated pathologies by administration of topical anesthetics and glucocorticoids
US6495583B1 (en) 1997-03-25 2002-12-17 Synaptic Pharmaceutical Corporation Benzimidazole derivatives
ID22834A (en) 1997-04-25 1999-12-09 Pfizer PIRAZOLOPIMIDINONA FOR SEXUAL ARRANGEMENT
US6342507B1 (en) 1997-09-05 2002-01-29 Isotechnika, Inc. Deuterated rapamycin compounds, method and uses thereof
ES2256959T3 (en) 1997-10-08 2006-07-16 Isotechnika,Inc. DEUTERED AND NON-DEUTERATED CYCLOSPORINE ANALOGS AND ITS USE AS IMMUNOMODULATING AGENTS.
CA2306837C (en) 1997-10-28 2007-05-08 Asivi, Llc. Treatment of female sexual dysfunction
US6156753A (en) 1997-10-28 2000-12-05 Vivus, Inc. Local administration of type III phosphodiesterase inhibitors for the treatment of erectile dysfunction
PL340711A1 (en) 1997-11-24 2001-02-26 Procter & Gamble Derivatives of 5-(2-imidazolinamino)-benzimidazole, their production and application of them as antagonists of alpha-adrenergic receptors of improved metabolic stability
US6066740A (en) 1997-11-25 2000-05-23 The Procter & Gamble Company Process for making 2-amino-2-imidazoline, guanidine and 2-amino-3,4,5,6-tetrahydropyrimidine derivatives
WO1999030697A2 (en) 1997-12-16 1999-06-24 Pfizer Products Inc. Combination effective for the treatment of impotence
US6372779B1 (en) 1997-12-29 2002-04-16 Ortho Pharmaceutical Corporation Anti-inflammatory compounds
US6506766B1 (en) 1998-02-13 2003-01-14 Abbott Laboratories Glucocortiocoid-selective antinflammatory agents
US6380207B2 (en) 1998-02-13 2002-04-30 Abbott Laboratories Glucocortiocoid-selective antiinflammatory agents
WO1999042104A1 (en) 1998-02-23 1999-08-26 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Use of macrolide compounds for treating glaucoma
DE59913617D1 (en) 1998-04-28 2006-08-03 Elbion Ag Indole derivatives and their use as inhibitors of phosphodiesterase 4.
US6235781B1 (en) 1998-07-14 2001-05-22 Alcon Laboratories, Inc. Prostaglandin product
WO2004073708A1 (en) 1998-12-17 2004-09-02 Dean Thomas R Brinzolamide and brimonidine for treating ocular conditions
EP1142880A4 (en) 1998-12-24 2002-02-27 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co Benzimidazole derivatives
US6232297B1 (en) 1999-02-01 2001-05-15 University Of Virginia Patent Foundation Methods and compositions for treating inflammatory response
UA74145C2 (en) 1999-04-30 2005-11-15 Пфайзер Продактс Інк. Glucocorticoid receptor modulators
US20010053780A1 (en) 1999-04-30 2001-12-20 Whitaker John S. Daily treatment for erectile dysfunction using a PDE5 inhibitor
US6943166B1 (en) 1999-04-30 2005-09-13 Lilly Icos Llc. Compositions comprising phosphodiesterase inhabitors for the treatment of sexual disfunction
CA2372850C (en) 1999-05-04 2011-01-18 Ulrich Kilian Synergistic combination comprising roflumilast and a pde-3 inhibitor
AU4589800A (en) 1999-05-05 2000-11-21 Darwin Discovery Limited 9-(1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphthalen-1-yl)-1,9-dihydropurin-6-one derivatives as pde7inhibitors
IT1313583B1 (en) 1999-07-30 2002-09-09 Chiesi Farma Spa 2-AMINOTETRALINIC DERIVATIVES FOR GLAUCOMA THERAPY.
US6593480B2 (en) 1999-09-01 2003-07-15 Abbott Laboratories Glucocorticoid receptor antagonists for treatment of diabetes
US7323496B2 (en) 1999-11-08 2008-01-29 Theracos, Inc. Compounds for treatment of inflammation, diabetes and related disorders
CA2390100C (en) 1999-11-12 2010-01-05 Tesfaye Biftu Diaryl piperidyl pyrrole derivatives as antiprotozoal agents
AU1590501A (en) 1999-11-12 2001-06-06 Merck & Co., Inc. Aliphatic hydroxy substituted piperidyl diaryl pyrrole derivatives as antiprotozoal agents
TWI227143B (en) 1999-12-15 2005-02-01 Guo-Jiun Sung In situ gel formation for ophthalmic delivery by combining Pluronic/Carbopol medic composition and its preparing method
US6258833B1 (en) 1999-12-23 2001-07-10 Icos Corporation Cyclic AMP-specific phosphodiesterase inhibitors
US6372777B1 (en) 1999-12-23 2002-04-16 Icos Corporation Cyclic AMP-specific phosphodiesterase inhibitors
PT1252157E (en) 2000-01-31 2004-10-29 Pfizer Prod Inc USEFUL PYRIMIDINE CARBOXAMIDES AS ISOZIMAS INHIBITORS PDE4
EP2258689A1 (en) 2000-03-16 2010-12-08 Biolipox AB Benzylated PDE4 inhibitors
US6919337B2 (en) 2000-04-07 2005-07-19 Novartis, Ag 8-Quinolinxanthine and 8-isoquinolinxanthine derivatives as PDE 5 inhibitors
US7019136B2 (en) 2000-04-07 2006-03-28 Novartis, Ag 8-quinolinxanthine and 8-isoquinolinxanthine derivatives as PDE 5 inhibitors
GB0008694D0 (en) 2000-04-07 2000-05-31 Novartis Ag Organic compounds
JP2003535850A (en) 2000-06-05 2003-12-02 アルタナ ファルマ アクチエンゲゼルシャフト Compounds effective as β-2-adrenergic receptors and PDE4-inhibitors
PL360707A1 (en) 2000-07-14 2004-09-20 Allergan Inc. Compositions containing alpha-2-adrenergic agonist components
CA2416169C (en) 2000-07-14 2008-09-23 Allergan, Inc. Compositions containing therapeutically active components having enhanced solubility
DE60138628D1 (en) 2000-08-11 2009-06-18 Ono Pharmaceutical Co Piperidin derivatives and medicaments containing these derivatives as an active ingredient
ATE547080T1 (en) 2000-08-30 2012-03-15 Univ Johns Hopkins DEVICES FOR INTRAOCULAR DRUG DELIVERY
US6579519B2 (en) 2000-09-18 2003-06-17 Registrar, University Of Delhi Sustained release and long residing ophthalmic formulation and the process of preparing the same
US6545057B2 (en) 2000-09-26 2003-04-08 The Brigham And Women's Hospital Inc. Tricyclic antidepressants and their analogues as long-acting local anesthetics and analgesics
TWI262920B (en) 2000-10-27 2006-10-01 Elbion Ag New 7-azaindoles, their use as inhibitors of phosphodiesterase 4, and a method for synthesizing them
IL180679A0 (en) 2000-10-27 2009-02-11 Pfizer Prod Inc Process for the preparation of non-steroidal glucocorticoid receptor modulators
ES2262612T3 (en) 2000-10-28 2006-12-01 Pfizer Products Inc. GLUCOCORTICOID RECEPTOR MODULADPRES.
JP4107421B2 (en) 2000-11-06 2008-06-25 リリー アイコス リミテッド ライアビリティ カンパニー Indole derivatives as PDE5 inhibitors
JP4101054B2 (en) 2000-11-08 2008-06-11 リリー アイコス リミテッド ライアビリティ カンパニー Chemical compound
PL362980A1 (en) 2000-11-17 2004-11-02 Warner-Lambert Company Llc Treatment of sexual dysfunction
CN1527830A (en) 2001-01-31 2004-09-08 �Ʒ� Ether derivatives useful as inhibitors of PDE4 isozymes
US7250518B2 (en) 2001-01-31 2007-07-31 Pfizer Inc. Nicotinamide acids, amides, and their mimetics active as inhibitors of PDE4 isozymes
SK8792003A3 (en) 2001-01-31 2004-09-08 Pfizer Prod Inc Nicotinamide biaryl derivatives useful as inhibitors of PDE4 isozymes and pharmaceutical composition containing them
PL365443A1 (en) 2001-01-31 2005-01-10 Pfizer Products Inc. Thiazolyl-, oxazolyl-, pyrrolyl-, and imidazolyl-acid amide derivatives useful as inhibitors of pde4 isozymes
US6583180B2 (en) 2001-02-14 2003-06-24 Abbott Laboratories Glucocorticoid receptor modulators
HUP0303193A3 (en) 2001-02-15 2007-08-28 Altana Pharma Ag Phthalayinone-piperidino-derivatives as pde4 inhibitors and pharmaceutical compositions containing them
US6617357B2 (en) 2001-03-06 2003-09-09 Smithkline Beecham Corporation Compounds and their use as PDE inhibitors
US6713081B2 (en) 2001-03-15 2004-03-30 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Ocular therapeutic agent delivery devices and methods for making and using such devices
WO2002076953A1 (en) 2001-03-21 2002-10-03 Warner-Lambert Company Llc New spirotricyclic derivatives and their use as phosphodiesterase-7 inhibitors
US6958328B2 (en) 2001-04-18 2005-10-25 Ortho-Mcneil Pharmaceutical, Inc Arylindenopyridines and related therapeutic and prophylactic methods
MXPA03010679A (en) 2001-05-23 2004-03-02 Tanabe Seiyaku Co Compositions for promoting healing of bone fracture.
JP4510383B2 (en) 2001-05-23 2010-07-21 田辺三菱製薬株式会社 Composition for repairing cartilage disease
CA2445460A1 (en) 2001-06-05 2002-12-12 Lilly Icos Llc Carboline derivatives as pde-5 inhibitors
CA2448298A1 (en) 2001-06-15 2002-12-27 Yamanouchi Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Phenylpyridine carbonyl piperazine derivative
EP1397142A4 (en) 2001-06-19 2004-11-03 Bristol Myers Squibb Co Pyrimidine inhibitors of phosphodiesterase (pde) 7
PE20030008A1 (en) 2001-06-19 2003-01-22 Bristol Myers Squibb Co DUAL INHIBITORS OF PDE 7 AND PDE 4
GB0115181D0 (en) * 2001-06-20 2001-08-15 Glaxo Group Ltd Novel use
MXPA03011167A (en) 2001-06-21 2004-02-26 Lilly Icos Llc Carboline derivatives as pdev inhibitors.
CA2450686A1 (en) 2001-06-27 2003-01-09 Merck Frosst Canada & Co./Merck Frosst Canada & Cie Substituted 8-arylquinoline pde4 inhibitors
US20030158133A1 (en) 2001-08-01 2003-08-21 Movsesian Matthew A. Isoform-selective inhibitors and activators of PDE3 cyclic nucleotide phosphodiesterases
DE10141212A1 (en) 2001-08-22 2003-03-06 Bayer Ag New 4-aminofuropyrimidines and their use
US20030176316A1 (en) 2001-08-24 2003-09-18 Whitehead Clark M. Methods for treatment of rheumatoid arthritis
US6582422B2 (en) 2001-10-03 2003-06-24 Bausch & Lomb Incorporated Ophthalmic delivery device
EP1304321A3 (en) 2001-10-17 2003-07-30 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Process for preparing 3-Hydroxyesters from epoxide derivatives
FR2832711B1 (en) 2001-11-26 2004-01-30 Warner Lambert Co TRIAZOLO [4,3-A] PYRIDO [2,3-D] PYRIMIDIN-5-ONES DERIVATIVES, COMPOSITIONS CONTAINING SAME, PROCESS FOR PREPARATION AND USE
EP1467730A4 (en) 2002-01-22 2010-03-10 Univ California Non-steroidal ligands for the glucocorticoid receptor, compositions and uses thereof
CA2475377A1 (en) 2002-02-07 2003-08-14 Pfizer Inc. Use of pde5 inhibitors such as sildenafil in the treatment of polycystic ovary syndrome
DE60317466T2 (en) 2002-02-11 2008-03-06 Pfizer Inc. Nicotinamide derivatives which can be used as PDE4 inhibitors
CA2477044A1 (en) 2002-02-22 2003-09-04 Pharmacia Corporation Ophthalmic formulation with gum system
US6962940B2 (en) 2002-03-20 2005-11-08 Celgene Corporation (+)-2-[1-(3-Ethoxy-4-methoxyphenyl)-2-methylsulfonylethyl]-4-acetylaminoisoindoline-1,3-dione: methods of using and compositions thereof
EP1348433A1 (en) 2002-03-28 2003-10-01 Warner-Lambert Company LLC Thiazol-2-yl-imine compounds as PDE-7 inhibitors
EP1348701A1 (en) 2002-03-28 2003-10-01 Warner-Lambert Company LLC (2,4-disubstituted-thiazol-5-yl) amine compounds as PDE7 inhibitors
AU2003255712B2 (en) 2002-07-10 2007-03-15 Arachnova Therapeutics Ltd. 4-(2-fluorophenyl)-6-methyl-2(1-piperazinyl)thieno(2,3-D) pyrimidine in the treatment of functional bowel disorder
JP4254263B2 (en) * 2002-08-22 2009-04-15 日産自動車株式会社 Gas flow measuring device and gas flow measuring method
WO2004021987A2 (en) 2002-09-06 2004-03-18 Merck & Co., Inc. Treatment of rheumatoid arthritis by inhibition of pde4
US20040053939A1 (en) 2002-09-16 2004-03-18 Gamache Daniel A. PDE IV inhibitors to treat angiogenesis
WO2004054501A2 (en) 2002-11-18 2004-07-01 Celgene Corporation Methods of usig and compositions comprising (-)-3-(3,4-dimethoxy-phenyl)-3-(1-oxo-1,3-dihydro-isoindol-2-yl)-propionamide
US6909002B2 (en) 2002-11-22 2005-06-21 Merck & Co., Inc. Method of preparing inhibitors of phosphodiesterase-4
CA2513731A1 (en) 2003-02-10 2004-08-19 Novartis Ag Pharmaceutical combinations comprising corticoids and immunosuppressants for treating corticoid- and/or calcineurin inhibitors-resistant diseases
US20040186046A1 (en) 2003-03-17 2004-09-23 Pfizer Inc Treatment of type 1 diabetes with PDE5 inhibitors
WO2004087906A1 (en) 2003-03-31 2004-10-14 Pfizer Products Inc. Crystal structure of 3',5'-cyclic nucleotide phosphodiesterase 1b (pde1b) and uses thereof
MXPA05010373A (en) 2003-04-01 2005-12-05 Applied Research Systems Inhibitors of phosphodiesterases in infertility.
WO2004094411A1 (en) 2003-04-18 2004-11-04 Memory Pharmaceuticals Corporation Pyrazole derivatives as phosphodiesterase 4 inhibitors
DE10318610A1 (en) 2003-04-24 2004-11-11 Elbion Ag 7-azaindoles and their use as therapeutic agents
DE10318611A1 (en) 2003-04-24 2004-11-11 Elbion Ag 4-, 6- or 7-hydroxyindoles with N-oxide groups and their use as therapeutic agents
ES2269858T3 (en) 2003-04-28 2007-04-01 Biofrontera Bioscience Gmbh USE OF RILUZOL COMBINED WITH SUITABLE AUXILIARY SUBSTANCES AND ADDITIVES FOR THE TREATMENT OF DISEASES, CHARACTERIZED A HYPERPROLIFERATION OF KERATINOCITS, IN PARTICULAR NEURODERMITIS AND PSORIASIS.
WO2004103959A2 (en) 2003-05-16 2004-12-02 Ambit Biosciences Corporation Heterocyclic compounds and uses thereof
US20050042177A1 (en) 2003-07-23 2005-02-24 Elan Pharma International Ltd. Novel compositions of sildenafil free base
US7572799B2 (en) 2003-11-24 2009-08-11 Pfizer Inc Pyrazolo[4,3-d]pyrimidines as Phosphodiesterase Inhibitors
MY141255A (en) 2003-12-11 2010-03-31 Memory Pharm Corp Phosphodiesterase 4 inhibitors, including n-substituted diarylamine analogs
EP1737448A1 (en) 2004-03-22 2007-01-03 Myogen, Inc. (s) - enoximone sulfoxide and its use in the treatment of pde-iii mediated diseases
EP1737447A1 (en) 2004-03-22 2007-01-03 Myogen, Inc. (r)-enoximone sulfoxide and its use in the treatment of pde-iii mediated diseases
US20050234018A1 (en) 2004-04-15 2005-10-20 Allergan, Inc. Drug delivery to the back of the eye
EP1746885A4 (en) 2004-05-03 2010-09-08 Univ Virginia Agonists of a2a adenosine receptors for treatment of diabetic nephropathy
US7459451B2 (en) 2004-07-05 2008-12-02 Astellas Pharma Inc. Pyrazolopyridine derivatives
US20080269239A1 (en) * 2004-11-11 2008-10-30 Argenta Discovery Ltd. Pyrimidine Compounds as Histamine Modulators
EP2218442A1 (en) 2005-11-09 2010-08-18 CombinatoRx, Inc. Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders
CN103664873B (en) 2009-12-30 2016-06-15 深圳信立泰药业股份有限公司 As 3-(3-amino piperidine-1-yl)-5-oxo-1 of DPP IV (DPP-IV) inhibitor, 2,4-pyrrolotriazine derivatives

Patent Citations (27)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4512978A (en) * 1980-01-24 1985-04-23 Inwood Louis R Dermatological composition useful in the treatment of psoriasis
US4569935A (en) * 1983-03-17 1986-02-11 University Of Tennessee Research Corp. Topical treatment of psoriasis with imidazole antibiotics
US4839342A (en) * 1987-09-03 1989-06-13 University Of Georgia Research Foundation, Inc. Method of increasing tear production by topical administration of cyclosporin
US5411952A (en) * 1987-09-03 1995-05-02 University Of Georgia Research Foundation, Inc. Ocular cyclosporine composition
US5474979A (en) * 1994-05-17 1995-12-12 Allergan, Inc. Nonirritating emulsions for sensitive tissue
US6369116B1 (en) * 1995-06-02 2002-04-09 Oculex Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Composition and method for treating glaucoma
US5981607A (en) * 1998-01-20 1999-11-09 Allergan Emulsion eye drop for alleviation of dry eye related symptoms in dry eye patients and/or contact lens wearers
US20040152664A1 (en) * 1998-09-02 2004-08-05 Allergan, Inc. Prednisolone compositions
US6254860B1 (en) * 1999-04-13 2001-07-03 Allergan Sales, Inc. Ocular treatment using cyclosporin-A derivatives
US6331313B1 (en) * 1999-10-22 2001-12-18 Oculex Pharmaceticals, Inc. Controlled-release biocompatible ocular drug delivery implant devices and methods
US6677304B2 (en) * 2000-04-07 2004-01-13 Laboratorie Medidom S.A. Ophthalmic formulations
US6872705B2 (en) * 2001-07-13 2005-03-29 Allergan, Inc. Use of antimicrobial peptides as preservatives in ophthalmic preparations, including solutions, emulsions, and suspensions
US6809077B2 (en) * 2001-10-12 2004-10-26 Enanta Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Cyclosporin analogs for the treatment of autoimmune diseases
US20040259863A1 (en) * 2001-10-31 2004-12-23 Hans-Michael Eggenweiler Type 4 phosphodiesterase inhibitors and uses thereof
US20050112069A1 (en) * 2002-03-06 2005-05-26 Rolf Beume Pharmaceutical composition of a pde4 or pde 3/4 inhibitor and histamine receptor antagonist
US20030216431A1 (en) * 2002-05-17 2003-11-20 Rajeev Raut Ophthalmic pharmaceutical compositions and methods for treating ocular inflammation
US20040151754A1 (en) * 2002-12-20 2004-08-05 Control Delivery Systems, Inc. Steroid suspensions for intraocular use
US20040180868A1 (en) * 2003-03-12 2004-09-16 Mullally John P. Composition and method for treating inflammations by reducing C-reactive protein
US20050059583A1 (en) * 2003-09-15 2005-03-17 Allergan, Inc. Methods of providing therapeutic effects using cyclosporin components
US20050192261A1 (en) * 2003-09-15 2005-09-01 Jost-Price Edward R. Methods and reagents for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders
US20050112199A1 (en) * 2003-09-24 2005-05-26 Mahesh Padval Therapeutic regimens for administering drug combinations
US20050256081A1 (en) * 2004-02-26 2005-11-17 Peyman Gholam A Tetracycline derivatives for the treatment of ocular pathologies
US20060003982A1 (en) * 2004-03-29 2006-01-05 William Williams Pyridyl-substituted porphyrin compounds and methods of use thereof
US20050277584A1 (en) * 2004-06-09 2005-12-15 Allergan, Inc. Pharmaceutical compositions comprising cyclosporins
US20060002963A1 (en) * 2004-07-02 2006-01-05 Laura Rabinovich-Guilatt Use of emulsions for intra and periocular injections
US20060122152A1 (en) * 2004-12-03 2006-06-08 Peyman Gholam A Heparin for the treatment of ocular pathologies
US20060148686A1 (en) * 2004-12-30 2006-07-06 Bausch & Lomb Incorporated Ophthalmic compositions comprising steroid and cyclosporine for dry eye therapy

Cited By (60)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US10064877B2 (en) 2003-08-29 2018-09-04 Therapeutic Research, Llc Materials and methods for treatment and diagnosis of disorders associated with oxidative stress
US20110034423A1 (en) * 2004-01-22 2011-02-10 Vicept Therapeutics, Inc. Method and therapeutic/cosmetic topical compositions for the treatment of rosacea and skin erythema using a1-adrenoceptor agonists
US20110027201A1 (en) * 2004-01-22 2011-02-03 Vicept Therapeutics, Inc. Method and therapeutic/cosmetic topical compositions for the treatment of rosacea and skin erythema using a1-adrenoceptor agonists
US20050165079A1 (en) * 2004-01-22 2005-07-28 Shanler Stuart D. Method and therapeutic/cosmetic topical compositions for the treatment of rosacea and skin erythema using a1-adrenoceptor agonists
US8877793B2 (en) 2004-01-22 2014-11-04 Allergan, Inc. Method and therapeutic/cosmetic topical compositions for the treatment of rosacea and skin erythema using α1-adrenoceptor agonists
US8420688B2 (en) 2004-01-22 2013-04-16 Allergan, Inc. Method and therapeutic/cosmetic topical compositions for the treatment of rosacea and skin erythema using α1-adrenoceptor agonists
US20100233109A1 (en) * 2004-01-22 2010-09-16 Vicept Therapeutics, Inc. Method and therapeutic/cosmetic topical compositions for the treatment of rosacea and skin erythema using a1-adrenoceptor agonists
US8815929B2 (en) 2004-01-22 2014-08-26 Allergan, Inc. Method and therapeutic/cosmetic topical compositions for the treatment of rosacea and skin erythema using α1-adrenoceptor agonists
US7812049B2 (en) 2004-01-22 2010-10-12 Vicept Therapeutics, Inc. Method and therapeutic/cosmetic topical compositions for the treatment of rosacea and skin erythema using α1-adrenoceptor agonists
US20070105761A1 (en) * 2005-11-09 2007-05-10 Combinatorx, Incorporated Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of opthalmic disorders
US8258153B2 (en) 2005-11-09 2012-09-04 Zalicus, Inc. Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders
US8067433B2 (en) 2005-11-09 2011-11-29 Zalicus Inc. Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of ophthalmic disorders
US8828966B2 (en) 2006-10-03 2014-09-09 Claire Mitchell Method for treatment of macular degeneration by modulating P2Y12 or P2X7 receptors
US20100105738A1 (en) * 2006-10-06 2010-04-29 Mitsuru Mizuno Extended release formulations of a proton pump inhibitor
US20160326255A1 (en) * 2007-07-26 2016-11-10 Osaka University Therapeutic agents for ocular inflammatory disease comprising interleukin 6 receptor inhibitor as active ingredient
US8546077B2 (en) 2007-09-11 2013-10-01 UNIVERSITé LAVAL Prostaglandin E2 modulation and uses thereof
US20100304416A1 (en) * 2007-09-11 2010-12-02 Puymirat Jack Prostaglandin e2 modulation and uses thereof
US8114898B2 (en) 2007-11-16 2012-02-14 Allergan, Inc. Compositions and methods for treating purpura
US20090130027A1 (en) * 2007-11-16 2009-05-21 Aspect Pharmaceuticals Llc Compositions and methods for treating purpura
WO2009065116A1 (en) * 2007-11-16 2009-05-22 Aspect Pharmaceuticals Llc Compositions and methods for treating purpura
US8673953B2 (en) 2007-11-16 2014-03-18 Allergan, Inc. Compositions and methods for treating purpura
US9265761B2 (en) 2007-11-16 2016-02-23 Allergan, Inc. Compositions and methods for treating purpura
KR101577471B1 (en) * 2007-11-16 2015-12-14 알러간, 인코포레이티드 Compositions and methods for treating purpura
US20110027236A1 (en) * 2008-02-15 2011-02-03 Bone Therapeutics Pharmaceutical composition for use in the treatment or prevention of osteoarticular diseases
US9872876B2 (en) 2008-02-15 2018-01-23 Bone Therapeutics Pharmaceutical composition for use in the treatment and/or the prevention of osteoarticular diseases
US9446065B2 (en) 2008-02-15 2016-09-20 Bone Therapeutics Pharmaceutical composition for use in the treatment and/or the prevention of osteoarticular diseases
US9415036B2 (en) 2008-02-15 2016-08-16 Bone Therapeutics Pharmaceutical composition for use in the treatment or prevention of osteoarticular diseases
US20100285134A1 (en) * 2008-02-15 2010-11-11 Bone Therepeutics Pharmaceutical composition for use in the treatment and/or the prevention of osteoarticular diseases
WO2010025266A1 (en) * 2008-08-27 2010-03-04 University Of Iowa Research Foundation Inhibitors of phosphodiesterase type 5a for treating or preventing muscle disease or the symptoms thereof in a patient
US8870876B2 (en) 2009-02-13 2014-10-28 Tarsus Medical Inc. Methods and devices for treating hallux valgus
US8795286B2 (en) 2009-09-25 2014-08-05 Tarsus Medical Inc. Methods and devices for treating a structural bone and joint deformity
US8277459B2 (en) 2009-09-25 2012-10-02 Tarsus Medical Inc. Methods and devices for treating a structural bone and joint deformity
US9220713B2 (en) 2009-10-16 2015-12-29 Duke University Compositions and methods for the treatment of drug-induced hand-foot syndrome
WO2011047256A1 (en) * 2009-10-16 2011-04-21 Duke University Compositions and methods for the treatment of drug-induced hand-foot syndrome
US9629845B2 (en) 2009-10-16 2017-04-25 Duke University Compositions and methods for the treatment of drug-induced hand-foot syndrome
US20110104083A1 (en) * 2009-10-30 2011-05-05 Intratus, Inc. Methods and cosmetic preparations for the sustained delivery of therapeutic agents to the eye
US10208049B2 (en) 2009-12-08 2019-02-19 Case Western Reserve University Compounds and methods of treating ocular disorders
US20210008042A1 (en) * 2009-12-11 2021-01-14 Medregen, Llc Treatment methods utilizing stem cell mobilizers and immunosuppressive agents
US8652141B2 (en) 2010-01-21 2014-02-18 Tarsus Medical Inc. Methods and devices for treating hallux valgus
US10179160B2 (en) 2010-02-25 2019-01-15 Schepens Eye Research Institute Therapeutic compositions for the treatment of dry eye disease
US10940179B2 (en) 2010-02-25 2021-03-09 Schepens Eye Research Institute Therapeutic compositions for the treatment of dry eye disease
US20150246966A1 (en) * 2010-02-25 2015-09-03 Schepens Eye Research Institute Therapeutic Compositions for the Treatment of Dry Eye Disease
US8696719B2 (en) 2010-06-03 2014-04-15 Tarsus Medical Inc. Methods and devices for treating hallux valgus
WO2012149285A1 (en) * 2011-04-28 2012-11-01 Claire Mitchell Method for treatment of macular degeneration by modulating p2y12 or p2x7 receptors
WO2013169315A1 (en) * 2012-05-09 2013-11-14 Hill David W Method for treating macular degeneration
WO2014074995A1 (en) * 2012-11-09 2014-05-15 Scidose, Llc Enema composition for treatment of ulcerative colitis having long term stability
US8809308B2 (en) 2012-11-09 2014-08-19 Scidose, Llc Enema composition for treatment of ulcerative colitis having long term stability
AU2013342069B2 (en) * 2012-11-09 2018-05-31 Haz Two, Llc Enema composition for treatment of ulcerative colitis having long term stability
WO2014117117A1 (en) * 2013-01-28 2014-07-31 The Johns Hopkins University Chronic nsaid treatment for fuchs endothelial corneal dystrophy
US10973758B2 (en) 2013-03-12 2021-04-13 O.D. Ocular Discovery Ltd. Methods of eye treatment using therapeutic compositions containing dipyridamole
US10357453B2 (en) 2013-03-12 2019-07-23 O.D. Ocular Discovery Ltd. Methods of eye treatment using therapeutic compositions containing dipyridamole
US10226420B2 (en) 2013-03-12 2019-03-12 O.D. Ocular Discovery Ltd Methods of eye treatment using therapeutic compositions containing dipyridamole
US9901580B2 (en) 2013-03-12 2018-02-27 O.D. Ocular Discovery Ltd. Methods of eye treatment using therapeutic compositions containing dipyridamole
US20200123201A1 (en) * 2015-05-01 2020-04-23 Onl Therapeutics, Inc. Peptide compositions and methods of use
US10829518B2 (en) * 2015-05-01 2020-11-10 Onl Therapeutics. Inc. Peptide compositions and methods of use
US11597749B2 (en) 2015-05-01 2023-03-07 The Regents Of The University Of Michigan Peptide compositions and methods of use
US10322129B2 (en) 2015-06-08 2019-06-18 O.D. Ocular Discovery Ltd. Therapeutic compositions containing dipyridamole, treatment packs and kits including such compositions and methods for producing same
US20190008920A1 (en) * 2017-05-19 2019-01-10 Ocugen, Inc. Ophthalmic compositions and methods of use
EP3843721A4 (en) * 2018-08-29 2022-10-12 Ocugen, Inc. Ophthalmic compositions and methods of use
WO2022094422A1 (en) * 2020-10-30 2022-05-05 The Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University Drugs targeting inflammation for the treatment of osteoarthritis and other inflammatory diseases

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
ZA200903604B (en) 2012-06-27
JP5490292B2 (en) 2014-05-14
TWI435729B (en) 2014-05-01
CA2628570A1 (en) 2007-05-18
AU2006311577B2 (en) 2013-02-07
IL191283A (en) 2015-03-31
JP2013231047A (en) 2013-11-14
RU2008122978A (en) 2009-12-20
US20120077756A1 (en) 2012-03-29
CN101355876A (en) 2009-01-28
MX2008006076A (en) 2008-12-16
JP2009514969A (en) 2009-04-09
WO2007056457A2 (en) 2007-05-18
EP1956906A4 (en) 2009-12-30
BRPI0618643A2 (en) 2011-09-06
WO2007056457A3 (en) 2007-09-13
US8067433B2 (en) 2011-11-29
ZA201201391B (en) 2014-07-30
US20120322746A1 (en) 2012-12-20
AU2006311577A1 (en) 2007-05-18
NZ568694A (en) 2011-09-30
CN101355876B (en) 2012-09-05
KR20080065704A (en) 2008-07-14
TW200803887A (en) 2008-01-16
US20070105761A1 (en) 2007-05-10
ZA200804550B (en) 2009-08-26
EP2218442A1 (en) 2010-08-18
EP1956906A2 (en) 2008-08-20
HK1128593A1 (en) 2009-11-06
NO20082473L (en) 2008-08-06
US8258153B2 (en) 2012-09-04
AR058182A1 (en) 2008-01-23
IL233634A0 (en) 2014-08-31

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
AU2006311577B2 (en) Methods, compositions, and kits for the treatment of medical conditions
US20050192261A1 (en) Methods and reagents for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders
ZA200603116B (en) Methods and reagents for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders
US20070213296A1 (en) Compositions and methods for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders
US20040224876A1 (en) Combination therapy for the treatment of immunoinflammatory disorders
EP2375900B1 (en) Methods for treating multiple sclerosis using tetracyclic pyrazinoindoles
US20050112199A1 (en) Therapeutic regimens for administering drug combinations
US20080003213A1 (en) Methods and compositions for the treatment of diseases or conditions associated with increased C-reactive protein, interleukin-6, or interferon-gamma levels
EP1675550A2 (en) Therapeutic regimens for administering drug combinations

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: ZALICUS INC., MASSACHUSETTS

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:AUSPITZ, BENJAMIN A.;CHAPPELL, TODD W.;JOST-PRICE, EDWARD ROYDON;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20101116 TO 20101215;REEL/FRAME:025616/0229

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION

AS Assignment

Owner name: THERAOPTICS, FRANCE

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:ZALICUS INC.;REEL/FRAME:033788/0233

Effective date: 20140715